INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE INC
S-1, 1996-11-08
JEWELRY STORES
Previous: HOST FUNDING INC, 8-K/A, 1996-11-08
Next: PURE ATRIA CORP, 8-K/A, 1996-11-08



As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on September 5, 1996
Registration No.333-5268





                   SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                         Washington, D.C. 20549

                             AMENDMENT NO. 1
                                   TO
                                FORM S-1
                         REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                  Under
                       THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
                                                 
                      INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
         (Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

        North Carolina                            5122                    
 (State or Jurisdiction of                        (Primary Standard Industrial
incorporation or organization)                    Classification Code Number)
                                 56-1921093
                  (I.R.S. Employer Identification Number)


                          2626 Glenwood Avenue
                                Suite 200
                      Raleigh, North Carolina 27608
                             (919) 571-4646
   (Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area
           code, of Registrant's principal executive offices)

                           Stanley H. VanEtten
                             President & CEO
                          2626 Glenwood Avenue
                                Suite 200
                      Raleigh, North Carolina 27608
                             (919) 571-4646
      (Name and address, including zip code, and telephone number,
               including area code, of agent for service)

                                                

Georgina Marie Mollick, Esq.          Richard S. Heller, Esq.
Wood & Francis, PLLC                  Shustak Jalil Sanders & Heller
P.O. Box 164                          545 Madison Avenue
Raleigh, North Carolina 27602         New York, New York 1002
(919) 828-0801                        (212) 688-5900

                                                
    Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the public:  As
soon as practicable after the effective date of this Registration
Statement.

                                               
If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on
a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities act
of 1933, check the following box


                     CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE

Title of each class of securities Amount to be registered  
to be registered                                                          
Common Stock, $0.001                                   
par value ...........             2,500,000        shares
proposed maximum    		Proposed minimum    
offering price per  		aggregate offering   
share                           price                              
$10.00(1)           		$5,000,000.00           

Proposed maximum     		Amount of registration fee
aggregate offering
price
$25,000,000.00           	$8,620.00

(1) Estimated solely for the purpose of computing the amount of the
registration fee pursuant to Rule 457(a)

The Registrant amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as
may be necessary to delay its effective date until the registrant shall
file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration
Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a)
of the Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration

Statement shall become effective on such date as the Commission, acting
pursuant to such Section 8(a), may determine.
						INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.

Cross-Reference Sheet Showing Location in Prospectus of Information
Required by Items of Form S-1

          Form S-1 Registration
          Statement Item and Heading                 Location in Prospectus

1.  Forepart of the Registration Statement and Outside
    Front Cover Page of Prospectus . . . . . . . . . Outside Front Cover Page

2.  Inside Front and Outside Back Cover Pages of
    Prospectus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Inside Front Cover Page;
                             . . . . . . . . . . . . Outside Back Cover Page

3.  Summary Information, Risk Factors. . . . . . . . Prospectus Summary; 
                                                     Risk Factors

4.  Use of Proceeds. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Prospectus Summary; 
                                                     Use of Proceeds

5.  Determination of Offering Price. . . . . . . . . Outside Front Cover Page

6.  Dilution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Dilution

7.  Plan of Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Front Cover Page; 
                                                     Plan of Distribution

8.  Description of Securities to be Registered . . . Prospectus Summary;
                               . . . . . . . . . . . Capitalization; 
                                                     Description of
                                                     Capital Stock

9.  Interests of Named Experts and Counsel . . . . . Experts

10. Information with Respect to the Registrant . . . Front Cover Page; 
                                                     Prospectus

     SUBJECT TO COMPLETION, DATED_____________, 1996 PROSPECTUS
     
    	                     2,500,000 SHARES
 	    
     MINIMUM SIZE OF OFFERING REQUIRED TO CLOSE: $5,000,000 (500,000 SHARES)
           MINIMUM INVESTMENT AMOUNT: $500 (50 SHARES)
     
                   INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                           Common Stock
                         $0.001 Par Value
     
          INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC., a North Carolina corporation (the
          "Company"), hereby offers on the terms set forth herein (See
         "Terms of Offering") up to 2,500,000 shares (the "Shares") of the
          Company's Common Stock, $.001 par value (the "Common Stock") at a
          per share price of $10.00, with a minimum of $5,000,000 (500,000
          shares) required to close to be held by the Escrow Agent
          Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company.  The Company has
          applied for listing on the NASDAQ National Market System.
     
          The Company was incorporated on April 28, 1995 to sell high
     quality jewelry and fine collectibles through a network marketing
     system of distribution.  The Company has just completed its first full
     year of operations.  The Company is principally engaged in the direct
     sale of fine gold and precious stone jewelry and fine collectibles
     from manufacturers located around the world.  The Company utilizes a
     network marketing distribution system which is essentially a
     non-storefront means of selling products through a network of
     Independent Retail Sales Representatives ("IRSRs"), independent
     contractors who purchase products from the Company and resell them to
     the public or consume them themselves.  In addition, IRSRs may
     supervise or manage one or more additional sales representatives who
     purchase products from the Company for personal consumption or resale
     to the public.  The Company currently has over 25,000 Independent
     Retail Sales Representatives in 48 states and the provinces of
     Alberta, British Columbia and Ontario, Canada.
     
     The Common Stock offered hereby involves a high degree of risk.  See
     "Risk Factors".

     THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE
     SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION
     NOR HAS THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES
     COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS.
     ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
     
        Price to Public   Underwritten Discounts        Proceeds to Company
Per Share       $10.00                  $.90                       $9.10
Total Minimum(1) $5,000,000        $450,000                 $4,550,000(2)
Total Maxmimum  $25,000,000      $2,250,000                $22,750,000(2)
    
     
     (1) Until at least 500,000 shares of Common Stock are sold the
     proceeds of the offering will be held in escrow by Continental Stock
     Transfer & Trust Company.  If at least 500,000 shares of Common Stock
     are not sold within 90 days from the date of this Prospectus, such
     proceeds will be returned to subscribers, without interest or
     deductions.
     
     (2) Before deducting offering expenses payable by the Company of
     approximately $135,509 in the case of the minimum and $157,405 in the
     case of the maximum.
     
          The Common Stock is offered on behalf of the Issuer by the
     Underwriter WIN Capital Corporation on a "best efforts" basis, subject
     to prior sale, when, as and if delivered to and accepted by the
     Underwriter, and subject to their right to reject any order, in whole
     or in part and certain other conditions.
     
                     WIN Capital Corporation
          The date of this Prospectus is _________, 1996
                        PROSPECTUS SUMMARY

     The following summary is qualified in its entirety by, and should be
read in conjunction with, the more detailed information appearing elsewhere
in this Prospectus.

                           THE COMPANY

     The Company was incorporated on April 28, 1995 and has just completed
its first full year of operations.  The Company is principally engaged in
the direct sale of fine 14K, 18K and 24K gold jewelry, precious stone
jewelry and fine collectibles from some of the most prestigious
manufacturers around the world.  The fine collectible products are from
manufacturers such as Waterford (crystal), Lalique (crystal), Lenox
(crystal, china and silver), Mark Hopkins (bronze sculptures), Sorrento
(Italian, hand-made music boxes), Mont Blanc (writing instruments), Lladro
(Spanish porcelain), Coach Leather (handbags, briefcases, luggage,
accessories), Chilmark (bronze sculptures), Marlene's Collection (Canadian
collectible dolls), Swarovski (crystal) and Reed & Barton (silver &
flatware).  Some of these products are premium products that are not sold
to the general public, but are available only to sales representatives of
the Company as an incentive award.  The Company utilizes a network
marketing distribution system which is essentially a non-storefront means
of selling products through a network of Independent Retail Sales
Representatives ("IRSRs"), independent contractors who purchase products
from the Company and resell them to the public or consume them themselves.
In addition, IRSRs may supervise or manage one or more additional sales
representatives who purchase products from the Company for personal
consumption or resale to the public.  The Company currently has over 25,000
Independent Retail Sales Representatives in 48 states, the U.S. territories
and the provinces of Alberta, British Columbia and Ontario, Canada.

     The Company's wholly owned subsidiary, International Heritage of
Canada, Inc., engages in similar direct retail sales of jewelry and fine
collectibles in the Canadian provinces of Alberta, British Columbia and
Ontario.  See Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition
and Results of Operations and Business.

     The Company's principal executive offices are located at 2626 Glenwood
Avenue, Suite 200, Raleigh, North Carolina 27608, its telephone number is
(919) 571-4646, and its fax number is (919) 571-4620.

     The Company's Canadian corporate offices are located at 885 West
Georgia Street, Suite 1370, Vancouver, B.C., Canada V6C 3E8, its telephone
number is (604) 602-1275 and its fax number is (604) 602-1285.

Prospective purchasers should carefully consider the factors discussed
under Risk Factors.
  	                           The Offering

Common Stock offered:

By the Company . . . . . . . . . . . . . 500,000 shares minimum
     . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2,500,000 shares maximum

Common Stock to be outstanding 
     after the offering . . . . . . . . 10,993,540 shares if the minimum 
                                        number of shares offered hereby 
                                        are sold
     . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .12,993,540 shares if the maximum 
                                        number of shares offered hereby 
                                        are sold

Use of Proceeds.  .  .  .  .  .  .      The net proceeds from the offering
                                        of the Common Stock, after deducting
                                        estimated offering expenses of
                                        $135,509,and commissions of $450,000
                                        are estimated to be $4,414,491 if the
                                        minimum number of shares offered hereby
                                        are sold; and after deducting estimated
                                        offering expenses of $157,405 and
                                        commissions of $2,250,000 are estimated
                                        to be $22,592,595 if the maximum number
                                        of shares offered hereby are sold.  If
                                        the minimum number of shares offered
                                        hereby are sold the Company plans to use
                                        the funds for working capital.  If the
                                        maximum number of shares offered hereby
                                        are sold the Company plans to use the
                                        funds for working capital purposes and
                                        additionally, shall use funds to:  fund
                                        further international expansion into
                                        other provinces of Canada and Mexico and
                                        to develop its own product fulfillment
                                        center.  In addition, the Company is
                                        registering shares for future employee
                                        compensation.  Pending such uses, the
                                        Company intends to invest the net
                                        proceeds from this offering in
                                        short-term interest bearing securities.

Summary Financial and Operating Information

     The following table presents summary selected consolidated financial
data derived from the audited consolidated financial statements for the
period from April 28, 1995 (inception) to the year ended December 31, 1995
and the audited consolidated financial statements of the Company for the
seven months ended July 31, 1996, included elsewhere in the prospectus.
All financial statements have been prepared according to generally accepted
accounting principals.

                            		April 28, 1995    Seven Months                 
		                            (Inception) to    Ended                    
        		                    December 31, 1995 July 31, 1996
     
Consolidated Statements of Operations:
        Revenue       			      $4,852,242        $19,079,496
        Gross Income (Loss)                     ($66,095)        $3,121,961 

        Selling and Administrative Expenses   
                                             $1,863,728         $3,712,754
        Net Income (Loss)                   ($1,929,823)         ($590,793)
        Weighted Average Number of Common
    Shares  Outstanding                         877,446          7,495,387
       Net Loss Per Shares at Period Ended    
                                                ($2.20)            ($0.08)

Consolidated Balance Sheets:

        Cash                                   $454,671           $274,797 
        Current Assets                       $1,033,481         $1,760,286
        Current Liabilities                  $2,951,210         $3,806,017
        Total Assets                         $2,278,993         $3,207,500
        Long-Term Debt, 
        less current Maturities                              
                                             $0                    $12,447
        Stockholders' Deficit                 
                                             ($672,217)        ($610,964)

                           RISK FACTORS

     An investment in the shares being offered by this Prospectus involves
a high degree of risk.  In addition to the other information contained in
this Prospectus, prospective investors should carefully consider the
following risk factors before purchasing shares offered by this Prospectus.

Lack of Prior Management Experience

     The Company's officers and managers have had limited experience in
managing companies as large and as rapidly growing as the Company.  The
Company's strategy of continuing its growth and expansion will place
additional demands upon the Company's current management and other
resources and will require additional working capital, information systems,
and management, operational, and other financial resources.  The continued
growth of the Company will depend on various factors, including, among
others, compensation to Representatives, the capacity of the Company's
computer systems to handle the growing number of Representatives and the
increasing sales, the ability of the Company's suppliers to fulfill orders,
the ability of the Company to provide adequate Representative training and
to open new markets in other countries.  Not all of the foregoing factors
are within the control of the Company.  The Company's ability to manage
growth successfully will require the Company to continue to enhance its
operational, management, financial, and information systems and controls.
No assurance can be given that the Company will be able to manage its
expanding operations and, if the Company's management is unable to manage
growth effectively, the Company's business, operating results, and
financial condition could be materially adversely affected.  Furthermore,
there can be no assurance that the growth experienced by the Company in the
past will continue.  See Business and Management.

History of Operating Losses; Uncertainty of Future Profitability

     The Company was incorporated on April 28, 1995, and from that date
until June 21, 1995, the Company's operations consisted primarily of
raising capital, developing and implementing business policies and
administrative activities.  During this development stage, the Company
incurred losses of approximately $225,000.  From the date of inception
through July 31, 1996, the Company had accumulated losses of $2,520,616.
In addition, the Company had a stockholders' deficit of $610,964 as of July
31, 1996, and its current liabilities exceed its current assets by
$2,045,731 (as of July 31, 1996).  This situation has been caused by the
nature of the Company's business (deferred revenue and commissions are the
highest at the opening and subsequent building of the business) and the
fact that it has taken more capital to establish an international direct
sales company than was originally anticipated.  The Company's ability to
continue as a going concern is dependent on its ability to maintain future
profitability through cutting corporate expenses and successfully obtaining
additional working capital and realizing the effectiveness of the Company's
changes in cash-out policy.

     On June 15, 1996, the Company ceased making exceptions to its existing
cash-out policy limiting the time an IRSR has to cash-out to sixty (60)
days.  Adherence to the policy is effective immediately.  Effective July 1,
1996, the Board of Directors of the Company approved a change in policy
such that those IRSRs who enter the business of the Company by opening and
certifying more than one (1) Retail Business Center will not be eligible to
cash-out.  Prior to July 1, 1996, all IRSRs could cash-out for sixty (60)
days.  This change will be implemented prospectively and all current IRSRs
who have more than one (1) Retail Business Center will be able to cash-out
through July 10, 1996.  However, the Company still maintains a one hundred
percent (100%) money back guarantee for all Retail Business Career Kit and
product purchases.  In addition, any IRSR may seek a refund or cash-out
from a Retail Business Agreement if they open and certify only one (1)
Retail Business Center.  This policy is consistent with the industry and
conforms with regulations in the states in which the Company conducts
business.(1) This new policy is designed to encourage potential IRSRs to
weigh their options carefully prior to entering the business.  The Company
believes that these changes will substantially reduce the current level of
cash-outs, thereby improving future cash flow and results of operations.
In addition, with this change in policy, the Company is attempting to
discourage Representatives from opening multiple Retail Business Centers.

(1) There are some states which, by statute, require longer periods for
refunds, returns or "cash-out." For those states, the Company has made
the necessary addendums to its policy.

    As of July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995, net income, retained
earnings and cash would have been increased by approximately $3,023,000 and
$492,000 respectively if all IRSRs who joined the Company with three (3) or
seven (7) Retail Business Centers were ineligible for cash-out.  See
Financial Statements.

    On June 20, 1996, the Board of Directors of the Company authorized a
special meeting of shareholders to vote on increasing the authorized shares
of common stock to 25,000,000 shares, and upon passage of the same, the
effectuation of a ten for one (10:1) stock split.  The shareholders
approved the measure to increase the authorized shares.  The Amended
Articles of Incorporation were filed July 2, 1996, and thereafter the ten
for one (10:1) stock split was made effective.

    The consolidated financial statements contained herein do not include
any adjustments that might be necessary should the Company be unable to
continue as a going concern.  See Management's Discussion and Analysis of
Financial Condition and Results of Operations and Financial Statements.

Dependence on Independent Retail Sales Representatives

    The Company's success depends in significant part upon its ability to
attract, maintain, and motivate a large base of Independent Retail Sales
Representatives ("IRSRs") who, in turn, recruit other IRSRs all of whom
solicit purchasers for the Company's products.  Significant turnover among
IRSRs, which the Company believes is typical of direct selling, requires
the sponsoring of new IRSRs by existing IRSRs in order to maintain or
increase the overall Representative sales force.  For the year ended
December 31, 1995, the Company experienced an attrition rate of
approximately 9.3% for IRSRs (which, using the method of measuring
attrition used by the Direct Selling Association, is calculated by dividing
the number of IRSRs who leave the Company during the year by the sum of the
IRSRs at the beginning of the year plus the new IRSRs who sign up during
the year).  Activities of the IRSRs in obtaining new IRSRs are particularly
impacted by changes in the level of motivation, which in turn can be
positively or negatively affected by general economic conditions,
modifications to the pay-out under the IHI Bi-Lateral Compensation Plan,
the availability of training and leadership conferences and a number of
intangible factors.  The Company's ability to attract IRSRs could be
negatively affected by adverse publicity relating to the network marketing
industry, the Company or its products or its operations, as well as
competition with other network marketing companies who may recruit the
Company's IRSRs to become salesmen for their own networks.  Because of the
number of factors that impact the recruiting of IRSRs the Company cannot
predict when or to what extent such increases or decreases in the level of
IRSRs retention will occur.  In addition, the number of IRSRs (as a
percentage of the population) may reach levels that become difficult to
exceed due to the finite number of persons inclined to pursue an
independent direct selling business opportunity.  There can be no assurance
that the number or productivity of IRSRs will be sustained at current
levels or will increase in the future.

    The Company's products are marketed exclusively through a network of
IRSRs. The Company encourages IRSRs to offer the IHI business opportunity
to purchasers with whom the IRSRs have an ongoing relationship as a result
of being a family member, friend, business associate, neighbor, or
otherwise.  This network marketing system has been selected by the Company
because the Company believes it reduces net marketing costs, purchaser
acquisition costs, and purchaser attrition.  The Company believes that
purchasers will be more likely to remain with the Company because they have
been enrolled with the Company by someone with whom they have an ongoing
relationship, and that this relationship will foster training and
leadership development by IRSRs who sponsor other IRSRs. The Company also
believes that its network marketing system will continue to build a base of
potential purchasers for additional products.  The Company's network
marketing system is particularly attractive to potential IRSRs because of
the potential for supplemental income and because the IRSRs are not
required to purchase any inventory, have no monthly sales quotas or account
collection issues, have minimal paperwork, have a flexible work schedule
and can get started in the business for a minimal cost of $75.00 (the
actual cost of the Retail Business Career Kit which contains all the
information necessary for a potential representative to start his or her
business with the Company).

Future Capital Needs

    Although the Company has reduced its loss since December 1995, and the
proceeds of this offering are anticipated to fund continued growth, there
may be some unforeseen event which will require the Company to seek
additional capital in the future.  The extent and timing of such
requirements will depend upon many factors, including, but not limited to,
economic conditions, the level of product sales, competition and cash flow
levels.  The Company believes that the funds generated by this offering,
together with existing resources and cash generated from operations, will
be sufficient to fund its operations.  However, no assurances can be given
that unforeseen circumstances will not alter the Company's capital
requirements, or that adequate funds will be available on acceptable terms,
if at all.  The Company's shareholders will have no obligation to provide
any such funds that may be required in the future.

Dilution

    The offering price is substantially higher than the book value per
share of the Common Stock.  Therefore, investors purchasing Shares will
incur immediate, substantial book value dilution of 97% or $9.65 per share
if the minimum number of shares offered hereby are sold and 83% or $8.30
per share if the maximum number of shares offered hereby are sold.  See
Dilution.

Absence of Dividends

    The Company has not paid any cash dividends in the past and does not
anticipate paying any in the foreseeable future.  See Dividend Policy.

Arbitrary Determination of Offering Price

    The offering price for the Shares has been determined arbitrarily by
the Company and does not necessarily indicate the current value of the
Shares and should not be regarded as an indication of any future market
price of the Company's Common Stock.


Control by Current Shareholders

    Upon consummation of this offering, Stanley H. Van Etten, the Company's
President and CEO, together with John D. Brothers, the Company's Secretary,
and the directors of the Company will beneficially own an aggregate of
approximately 39.48% of the Company's Common Stock.  The aforementioned
officers and directors, along with Derrick L. Rodgers, a principal
shareholder, own an aggregate of approximately 44.98% of the Company's
Common Stock.  The officers, directors and others who may be deemed control
parties of the Company will own 42.93% of the Company's issued and
outstanding stock if the minimum number of shares offered hereby are sold
and 36.32% of the Company's issued and outstanding stock if the maximum
number of shares offered hereby are sold.  In addition, options convertible
into more than 3,100,000 shares of Common Stock are held by officers,
directors and others who may be deemed control persons of the Company.
(The exact number of shares cannot be determined since options granted to
the original Board of Directors are for 5% of the issued and outstanding
shares at the date of exercise).  If exercised, this group would own
approximately 55.73% of the Company's issued and outstanding stock if the
minimum number of shares offered hereby are sold and 48.83% of the
Company's issued and outstanding stock if the maximum number of shares
offered hereby are sold.  (These percentages include stock and stock
granted upon exercise of all outstanding options readily convertible into a
known number of shares).  As a result, this group may be able to control
the Company, elect all of the Company's directors, cause an increase in the
authorized capital stock or the dissolution, merger or sale of the assets
of the Company and generally, to direct the affairs of the Company.
Accordingly, it is likely that investors in this offering will have little
or no effective voice in the direction of the Company's operation.  See
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.

Experience of Management; Dependence Upon Key Personnel

    The Company is dependent upon key personnel, including its President
and CEO, Stanley H. Van Etten, and upon recruiting and retaining skilled
IRSRs. In addition, the Company's other personnel have a greater than usual
importance to the Company because of the complexity of a network
marketing/independent contractor based business.  Any loss of or failure to
retain key personnel could have a material adverse effect upon the Company.
See Business.

Competition

    The Company operates in a highly competitive business.  The Company
competes with a number of established network marketing companies,
including some that also sell jewelry.  In addition, the Company competes
with other retail sellers of fine jewelry and fine collectibles, many of
which are typically located in shopping malls and other more traditional
retail outlets.  Some of the Company's competitors may have substantially
greater financial resources than the Company.  The Company's future success
will depend to a significant extent upon its ability to remain competitive
in the areas of cost control, service responsiveness and reliability, and
marketing.  See Business.

Prior Transactions With Affiliates

    The Company has in the past entered into and may in the future enter
into transactions and agreements with its shareholders and certain
partnerships and/or corporations and/or other entities controlled by its
shareholders.  While the Company believes that the terms of the
transactions and agreements have been no less favorable to the Company than
could have been obtained from unaffiliated, third parties, no assurance can
be given that unaffiliated, third parties would not have offered terms more
advantageous to the Company.  See Related Party Transactions.

    All future material affiliated transactions and loans will be made or
entered into on terms that are no less favorable to the Company than those
that can be obtained from unaffiliated third parties.  In addition, it is
the Company's policy that all material affiliated transactions and loans,
and any forgiveness of loans, should be approved by a majority of the
Company's Board of Directors who do not have an interest in the particular
transaction(s).

Network Marketing Industry and Government Regulation

    Regulations regarding network marketing companies are a complexity of
overlapping laws which vary from jurisdiction to jurisdiction.  Network
sales programs are affected by combinations of business opportunity
statutes, franchise and securities statutes, anti-pyramid statutes, network
distribution statutes, and state lottery statutes, as well as, U.S. Post
Office lottery and Federal Trade Commission fraud regulations, among
others.  In addition, some regulatory officials seem to have a negative
bias toward the legality of network marketing as a means of merchandising.
Many network marketing programs have been targeted for prosecution and
litigation under a variety of laws, though enforcement of these statutes
and regulations has often appeared selective.  Failure to comply with the
laws of any jurisdiction can result in the loss of the Company's ability to
operate therein for indefinite periods of time, and could possibly affect
its ability to operate in other jurisdictions as well.  From time to time,
the Company has, in the past, received inquiries from various state
regulators regarding various aspects of the Company's business.  The
Company's practice is to promptly respond to all such inquiries, and to
provide whatever information is requested.  The Company is aware of no
currently outstanding inquiries to which it has not responded, or other
actions by any state or federal regulatory authority.  However, no
assurances can be given that such responses will be deemed dispositive of
any particular matter.  From its inception, the Company has invested a
substantial amount of money to seek the advice of legal counsel in the
areas of corporate, network marketing and securities law in order to
structure itself in accordance with the multiplicity of laws that govern
its operations.  Though it can give no assurances, the Company believes it
has taken reasonable steps to comply with the various laws that would apply
to it in the jurisdictions in which it currently operates.  In addition,
the Company has adopted certain policies and procedures designed to assure
compliance with the various laws that govern its business, and it devotes
significant efforts to policing its operations and sales force.  See
Business.

Key-Man Life Insurance; Management Contracts

    The Company maintains a $1,500,000 key-man life insurance policy on its
President and CEO, Stanley H. Van Etten.  The Company currently carries no
key-man life insurance on any other members of its management.  All members
of management have entered into confidentiality and non-competition
agreements with the Company.  The Company has entered into a long-term
employment contract with its President.  The loss of any members of
management, especially the current President, could significantly adversely
affect the Company's ability to maintain operations.

Primary Dependence on One Supplier

    The Company currently uses a single primary supplier to provide the
jewelry products that it markets (A&A Jewelers, Inc.-Canada/E.B. Harvey,
Inc.-USA (collectively "E.B Harvey")).  In addition, the Company's current
access to the fine collectibles products it offers to the public, is
maintained through E.B. Harvey and the agreements that this supplier has
with the individual fine collectibles suppliers.  Any interruption of the
supply of products from E.B. Harvey could adversely affect the Company's
ability to fill customer's orders.  Such an interruption could lead to the
loss of retail customers and to the loss of IRSRs. The Company is pursuing
relationships with other vendors of similar products in order to reduce its
sole supplier dependence.  The Company believes there are several suppliers
who could provide the same products to the Company if necessary.  See
Operations.

Dependence on Consumer Spending

    The success of the Company's operations depends upon a number of
factors relating to consumer spending, including, but not limited to,
future economic conditions affecting disposable consumer income such as
employment, business conditions, interest rates and taxation.  There can be
no assurance that consumer spending will not decline in response to
economic conditions, thereby adversely affecting the Company's growth, net
sales and profitability.

Management Has Broad Discretion to Allocate Proceeds

    Management shall have broad discretion to allocate the proceeds of this
offering in the event the minimum or maximum number of shares offered
hereby are sold.  A significant portion of the proceeds are to be used to
fund working capital.  See Use of Proceeds.

Absence of Public Market; Possible Volatility of Stock Price

    Prior to the Offering, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock and there can be no assurance that an active trading market will
develop or be sustained after the offering.  Further, there can be no
assurance that the underwriter, or members of the proposed selling group,
if any, will make a market in the Company's securities or that the
underwriter, or members of the proposed selling group, if any, will be able
to establish an active trading market in the Company's securities.

    The Company has applied for a listing of the Common Stock on the NASDAQ
National Market.  There can be no assurance that the Common Stock will be
approved for listing.  After completion of the Offering, the market price
of the Common Stock could be subject to significant fluctuations in
response to various factors and events, including the liquidity of the
market for the shares of Common Stock, variations in the Company's
operating results, new statutes or regulations or changes in the
interpretation of existing statutes or regulations affecting the network
marketing industry.  In addition, the stock market in recent years has
experienced broad price and volume fluctuations that often have been
unrelated to the operating performance of particular companies.  These
market fluctuations also may adversely affect the market price of the share
of Common Stock.  See Plan of Distribution.

Litigation of Certain Insiders

    Although the Company is not involved in any material legal proceedings,
the Company's officers, Stanley H. Van Etten and John D. Brothers are
involved in proceedings either individually or through other corporate
interests; however, none of these matters involve the Company or are
related to any of the Company's activities.  Management believes that none
of these matters will have a significant adverse impact on the Company.
See Litigation.



Subsequent Registration of Privately Held Shares

    At present the Company plans to file a subsequent registration
statement in the fourth quarter of fiscal 1996 to register additional
shares (privately held shares).  There can be no assurance that the Company
will be able to achieve the registration of these privately held shares.

                         USE OF PROCEEDS

    The net proceeds to the Company from the sale of the shares of Common
Stock offered hereby are estimated to be approximately $4,414,491, if the
minimum number of shares offered hereby are sold and approximately
$22,592,595, if the maximum number of shares offered hereby are sold, after
deducting the commissions to the underwriter and estimated offering
expenses payable by the Company.  If the minimum number of shares offered
hereby are sold, the Company plans to use the funds for working capital
purposes.  If the maximum number of shares offered hereby are sold, the
Company plans to use the funds for working capital purposes and
additionally, shall use proceeds of the offering to:  fund further
international expansion into other provinces of Canada and Mexico and to
develop its own product fulfillment center.  In addition, the Company is
registering shares for future employee compensation.  Pending such uses,
the Company intends to invest the net proceeds from this offering in
short-term interest bearing securities.

                               Minimum Offering       Maximum Offering
                             Amount       Percent 	Amount      Percent   

Working Capital               $4,414,491  100%    	$16,217,595 71.79%
Fund Expansion Into New Areas                           $3,550,000  15.71% 
Develop Fulfillment Center                              $2,825,000   12.50%
               
     Total                    $4,414,491  100%          $22,592,595  100%   


                         DIVIDEND POLICY

     The Company does not currently pay dividends on its Common Stock and
does not anticipate paying dividends.  It is the present policy of the
Company's Board of Directors to retain earnings, if any, to finance the
expansion of the Company's business.  The payment of dividends in the
future will depend on the results of operations, financial condition,
capital expenditure plans and other cash obligations of the Company and
will be at the sole discretion of the Board of Directors.

                             DILUTION

     The difference between the public offering price per share and the net
tangible book value per share after this offering constitutes the dilution
to investors in this offering.  Net tangible book value per share is
determined by dividing the net tangible book value of the Company (total
tangible assets less total liability) by the number of shares of Common
Stock actually outstanding.

     As of July 31, 1996, the fully diluted net book value of the Company
was ($0.06) per share.  Assuming the sale of the minimum number of shares
offered hereby (500,000 shares) and the receipt of the proceeds therefrom
(based upon the assumed initial offering price of $10.00 per share and
after deducting estimated cash offering expenses payable by the Company in
connection with this offering), the fully diluted pro forma net book value
of the Company on July 31, 1996 would have been $0.35 per share.  This
represents an immediate increase in net book value of $0.41 per share to
the existing shareholders and an immediate dilution of $9.65 per share to
new investors.  Assuming full subscription of the offering ($25,000,000 or
2,500,000 shares), and the receipt of the proceeds therefrom (based upon
the assumed initial offering price of $10.00 per share and after deducting
the estimated cash offering expenses payable by the Company in connection
with this offering), the fully diluted pro forma net book value of the
Company on July 31, 1996 would have been $1.70 per share.  This represents
an immediate increase in net book value of $1.76 per share to the existing
shareholders and an immediate dilution of $8.30 per share to new investors.
This table illustrates this per share dilution:

                                        Minimum Offering     Maximum Offering
Initial public offering price per share    $10.00               $10.00
     Net tangible book value per share 
          before pro forma adjustments     ($0.06)              ($0.06)
     Increase attributable to investors 
        in this offering                    $0.41                $1.76
Adjusted net tangible book 
        value after offering                $0.35                $1.70
Dilution to investors in this offering      $9.65                $8.30


     The following table summarizes, as of July 31, 1996, with respect to
existing shareholders and investors in the offering, a comparison of the
number of shares of Common Stock acquired from the Company, the percentage
ownership of such shares, the total consideration paid, the percentage of
total consideration paid and the average price per share.


                              Minimum Offering

           Shares of Common Stock Purchased Total Consideration Paid Avg. Price
           Number           Percent         Amount      Percent      Per Share

Existing                                                              
Shareholders   10,493,540   95.45%          $1,607,060  24.32%       $0.15

Investors in
Offering       500,000      4.55%           $5,000,000  75.68%       $10.00

TOTAL         10,993,540     100%           $6,607,060  100%


                              Maximum Offering

          Shares of Common Stock Purchased  Total Consideration Paid Avg. Price
          Number           Percent          Amount     Percent       Per Share

Existing                                                              
Shareholders 10,493,540    80.76%           $1,607,060 6.04%          $0.15

Investors in
Offering     2,500,000     19.24%           $25,000,000 93.96%        $10.00

TOTAL       12,993,540     100%             $26,607,060 100%

                           CAPITALIZATION

     The following table sets forth the capitalization of the Company as of
July 31, 1996 and as adjusted to give pro forma effect to the issuance and
sale of the minimum number of shares offered hereby and the issuance and
sale of the maximum number of shares offered hereby and the application of
the estimated net proceeds of the offering ($4,414,491 in the event of the
minimum and $22,592,595 in the event of the maximum).  The table should be
read in conjunction with the Selected Financial Information, Management's
Discussion and Analysis of Results of Operations and Financial Condition,
and the Financial Statements of the Company and notes thereto appearing
elsewhere in this Prospectus.
     
                           Actual              Actual         As Adjusted
                           December 31, 1996   July 31, 1996  Minimum Maximum
                                                                              
Long-term debt (including current portion)
                                   $0           $19,544  $19,544    $19,544
Stockholders' deficit:
   Common stock, $0.001 par value: 25,000,000
   authorized 10,493,540 issued and outstanding(2)(3)(4),               
   respectively:                $9,987          $10,494  $10,994    $12,994
Additional paid-in capital    
                            $1,247,463        $1,596,565 $6,596,066 $26,594,066
Adjustment for foreign currency translation  
                                  $156          $2,592   $2,592        $2,592
Accumulated deficit     
                           ($1,929,823)    ($2,220,616)($2,220,616)($2,220,616)

(2) Does not include conditional share gifts to employees to be awarded January,
1997, totaling 142,000 shares; conditional share gifts to top salesman to be 
awarded January, 1997, totaling 120,000 shares; and conditional shares to others
to be awarded January, 1997, totaling 200,000 shares.

(3) Does not include unexercised outstanding options for up to 3,175,000 shares
set forth in Option Grants.

(4) Pursuant to the terms of his employment contract, the President is entitled
to stock incentives as follows: (i) 2% of the issued and outstanding shares
as of December 31, 1996 if the Company has achieved gross revenue in excess of
$25,000,000; (ii) 3% of the issued and outstanding shares as of December 31,
1997 if the Company has achieved gross revenue in excess of $75,000,000; (iii) 
3% of the issued and outstanding shares as of December 31, 1998 if the Company
has achieved gross revenue in excess of $125,000,000; (iv) 3% of the issued and
outstanding shares as of December 31, 1999 if the Company has achieved gross
revenue in excess of $200,000,000; and (v) 3% of the issued and outstanding 
shares as of December 31, 2000 if the Company has achieved gross revenue of
$275,000,000.


                  SELECTED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     The selected financial information presented in the following table
for the period from April 28, 1995 (inception) to December 31, 1995 and for
the seven months ended July 31, 1996 have been derived from the Company's
audited consolidated financial statements.  All information in the
following table should be read in conjunction with Management's Discussion
and Analysis of Results of Operations and Financial Condition and with the
Financial Statements of the Company and related notes thereto appearing
elsewhere in this Prospectus.
                                               April 28, 1995                
                                           (Inception) to      Seven Months  
                                            December 31, 1995  Ended July 31, 
                                                                1996 
     
Consolidated Statements of Operations:
        Revenue       			        $4,852,242         $19,079,496
        Gross Income (Loss)  			($66,095)           $3,121,961 

        Selling and Administrative Expenses     
                              			$1,863,728         $3,412,754
        Net Income (Loss)                      ($1,929,823)         ($590,793)
        Weighted Average Number of Common
         Shares Outstanding                        877,446          7,495,387
       Net Loss Per Shares at Period Ended     
                                                  ($2.20)            ($0.08)

Consolidated Balance Sheets:

        Cash                                      $454,671            $274,797 
        Current Assets                          $1,033,481          $1,760,286
        Current Liabilities                     $2,951,210          $3,806,017
        Total Assets                            $2,278,993          $3,207,500
        Long-Term Debt, 		 
        less current maturities                         $0             $12,447
        Stockholders' Deficit                    ($672,217)          ($610,964)
                              


     MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL
          CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

The Company

     The Company was incorporated in North Carolina on April 28, 1995, and
has a wholly owned Canadian subsidiary, International Heritage of Canada,
Inc. The Company is a network marketing company, owned by some of its
Independent Retail Sales Representatives ("IRSRs") and its professional
management team.  The Company distributes a variety of fine jewelry and
collectible products through IRSRs throughout the United States and Canada.

     In June, 1995 when the Company commenced its operations, it offered 27
products and by December, 1995, the Company was offering over 500 products
in two categories of goods.  The Company's product categories are:  fine
14K, 18K and 24K gold and precious stone jewelry and fine collectibles from
manufacturers around the world.  The fine collectible products are from the
following manufacturers:  Waterford (crystal), Lalique (crystal), Lenox
(crystal, china and silver), Mark Hopkins (bronze sculptures), Sorrento
(Italian hand-made music boxes), Mont Blanc (writing instruments), Lladro
(Spanish porcelain), Coach Leather (handbags, briefcases, luggage,
accessories), Chilmark (bronze sculptures), Marlene's Collection (Canadian
collectible dolls), Swarovski (crystal) and Reed & Barton (silver and
flatware).  Some Company products mentioned above are not available for
sale, but rather are available only as awards to IRSRs through the earn-out
program of the Company's Bi-Lateral Compensation Plan.  The Company is
constantly expanding its product lines of jewelry and fine collectibles,
and looking at other value-based products to add to its offerings in the
future.

     The Company works like a "partner" with its IRSRs. By distributing and
supporting world class products for distributors, the Company addresses the
problems with which most distributors have been faced.  The confidence
shown in the Company by its customers and distributors is its most valued
possession and the Company acknowledges and accepts those responsibilities
as their "partner."

Start-Up Objectives

     On April 28, 1995 three entrepreneurs:  Claude W. Savage, Larry G.
Smith and Stanley H. Van Etten were drawn together by a vision to build and
develop a network marketing company that would have all of the strengths of
corporate America and all of the benefits of network marketing.  This
vision would become International Heritage, Inc. ("IHI").

     During May and June, 1995, the entrepreneurial vision was shared with
57 other individuals who further refined the vision and invested in
International Heritage, Inc. Together, the founding shareholders assembled
a team of professionals to assist, plan and advise the Company in every
regard.  These professional parties were instrumental in developing the
Company, and included:  securities attorneys, network marketing attorneys,
certified public accountants, computer and technical advisors, management
consultants and investment bankers.  The founding shareholders invested and
loaned the Company over $700,000 to form and implement the IHI concept.

     On June 21, 1995, IHI opened its doors for business, signed its first
IRSR, and sold its first product.  The Company started by making its
products available to a small number of highly motivated professional
people in key sales regions.  These IRSRs earn sales commissions by
building their own retail sales organizations, or networks.  IRSRs who join
the Company are given the same opportunities as the initial distributors,
and, as the process repeats itself, the Company's distribution system
expands, spreading from person to person, from state to state, and
eventually, from country to country.  Currently the Company has more than
25,000 Representatives in 48 states (except North Dakota and South Dakota),
the U.S. territories and the provinces of Alberta, British Columbia and
Ontario, Canada.  The Company carries the costs of developing supporting
materials used by the distribution network, to include, but not limited to:
sales brochures; audio and video tapes; training manuals; sales kits;
business forms; and warehousing and transporting products; all in an effort
to support the IRSR at a lower cost than that of standard retailing
channels.  The Company sells its sales aids and audio/visual materials to
its Representatives for a marginal profit.  By providing materials and
support to Representatives at reduced start-up costs, the Company hopes to
benefit from:  reduced advertising expenditures; a highly motivated sales
force; positive word of mouth; a sense of customer and IRSR loyalty; and a
high volume of repeat sales.  The IRSR should be able to affordably start
his or her own business with minimal start-up costs and operating
expenditures, a reasonable expectation of profits and individual business
profitability.  Further, the IRSR should benefit from the following as
well:  high earnings potential; the ability to be his or her own boss; the
ability to operate a business from home; the ability to work on a part-time
or full-time basis; the ability to buy products at a reduced cost; no
franchise fees; no legal and accounting costs associated with starting and
running a small business; and the opportunity to work with family, friends
and relatives.

     Throughout 1995 the Company continued to grow its network of IRSRs
and, as a result, the need for capital continued to grow.  The Company
offered additional stock to Representatives through December, 1995.  In
December 1995 the Company offered each of its shareholders the opportunity
to rescind their investment.  The Company made rescission offers to
approximately 190 persons who had invested money in the Company prior to
the Company's securities being registered for sale or exempted from
registration under applicable securities laws.  While these rescission
offers should absolve the Company of any civil liability to the individual
investors, the Company may still be liable for administrative penalties and
sanctions as a result of these transactions.  Such administrative sanctions
can be severe, and can include, among other things, significant monetary
penalties and injunctive actions.  While the Company can give no assurances
that it will not be sanctioned for these transactions in the future, the
Company knows of no administrative proceedings or regulatory investigations
related to these rescission offers or the facts underlying same, that are
currently pending or proposed.  The Company intends to make an appropriate
filing to register the shares of all shareholders who previously rejected
the Company's offer of rescission.  Four (4) shareholders accepted the
Company's offer of rescission.

     The Company's philosophy is similar to that of traditional corporate
America, that is to let as many people as possible benefit from owning a
small stake in the Company.  The Company's existing shareholders consist of
IRSRs, management and eventually, employees.  A benefit of this broad basis
of stock ownership, especially ownership by Representatives, is the
creation of a national "training force" of sorts to enforce compliance with
the Company's policies and procedures.

Network Development and Training

     The Company has recently implemented the IHI Training, Leadership
Development and Support System (the "System") which is a comprehensive
system designed to:  stimulate and support recruiting activity and
organized growth of an IRSR's Retail Sales Organization; enhance retention
of IRSRs; develop responsive field leadership which extends the Company's
philosophy and vision throughout its network of Representatives; and to
create and promote a working partnership between the Company and its
network of Representatives.  The System is supported by a series of events,
recognition (sales production and other) and tools.  The events include:
local weekly business opportunity meetings, area events, regional events,
national events and conventions, international conference calls with the
Company's President and various guest speakers, corporate leadership
courses, leadership retreats and special meetings and contest/incentive
trips.  The recognition system is designed to increase sales momentum,
sales volume, Representative income and retention.  The tools include:  a
series of audio and video tapes on the Company, building a retail sales
organization, Quickstart Training, retailing products, the IHI Bi-Lateral
Compensation Plan and how to fill out Company forms along with commonly
asked questions and answers; slide presentations; overhead presentations;
flip chart presentations; a monthly newsletter The IHI Business Journal;
fax on demand (which provides an overview of the Company); monthly
conference calls; an Internet home page; various sales and marketing
publications (Gettin' the Business; A Sales Professional's Handbook is
included in the Company's Retail Business Career Kit); and the
International Data and Communications Center, which is an automated,
comprehensive, multi-functional communication and support service linking
the Representative, via telephone to the Company's computer system in order
to access all types of information relevant to the Representatives'
business.

Results of Operations

     At year end 1995, only six months after the start of business, the
Company's total assets were in excess of $2,000,000 and total revenue for
the year was a little over $5,000,000 ($4,852,242 in sales and $408,375 in
deferred sales).  In addition, the Company reached profitability one month
ahead of management's financial projections, by showing a $175,878 profit
for the month of December.  However, at year end 1995, the Company had lost
in excess of $1,900,000.

     While the Company lost approximately $1,900,000 from its inception to
December 31, 1995, it experienced a dramatic turn-around in cash flow and
operating profitability.  For the month end December 1995, the Company had
net cash provided from operating activities of $537,171.  For the seven
month period ended July 31, 1996, the Company had a net loss of $590,793,
based on total revenue of $19,079,496.  For the seven month period ended
July 31, 1996, the Company had net cash provided by operating activities of
$775,974.  This increase in positive cash flow is a direct result of
management's ongoing efforts to cut costs and improve operating
efficiencies.  However, management fully expected the losses incurred to
date and attributes the one-time losses directly to the high cost of
start-up, the need for professional parties and their planning expertise,
the development of an IRSR network from scratch, the high cost of computer
hardware and software development, and numerous other technical and
specialized issues.  However, the Company does not anticipate the
continuation of these losses since most of the relevant costs were isolated
in nature.  The Company's gross operating profit margin is in excess of 16%
before overhead expenses.  However, there can be no assurance that the
profit margin can be sustained.  See Financial Statements.  In addition,
the Company's initial capitalization and the additional capitalization from
the proceeds of this offering should be sufficient to operate the Company
into profitability.  However, there can be no assurances of profitability
and no reliance should be made therein.  See Financial Statements.

     Although the Company has reduced its loss since December 1995, and the
proceeds of this offering are anticipated to fund continued growth, there
may be some unforeseen event which will require the Company to seek
additional capital in the future.  The extent and timing of such
requirements will depend upon many factors, including, but not limited to,
economic conditions, the level of product sales, competition and cash flow
levels.  The Company believes that the funds generated by this offering,
together with existing resources and cash generated from operations, will
be sufficient to fund its operations.  However, no assurances can be given
that unforeseen circumstances will not alter the Company's capital
requirements, or that adequate funds will be available on acceptable terms,
if at all.  The Company's shareholders will have no obligation to provide
any such funds that may be required in the future.

                             BUSINESS

General

     The Company was incorporated in North Carolina on April 28, 1995.  The
Company is engaged principally in the direct sale of fine jewelry and fine
collectibles.  The Company utilizes a network marketing distribution system
to market its products through catalogue sales.  Compensation to the
Company and to its network of IRSRs is based on the volume and price of
Company products sold.

     The Company's wholly owned subsidiary, International Heritage of
Canada, Inc., incorporated on July 25, 1995, engages in similar direct
sales of fine jewelry and fine collectibles in three Canadian provinces
(Alberta, British Columbia and Ontario).

Primary Markets

     The Company currently has IRSRs operating in forty-eight (48) states
(except North Dakota and South Dakota), all of the U.S. territories and the
Canadian provinces of Alberta, British Columbia and Ontario through its
wholly-owned subsidiary International Heritage of Canada, Inc. While there
can be no assurances that such will come to fruition, the Company
anticipates expanding into additional provinces of Canada, as well as
Mexico and certain overseas markets in the next twelve (12) months.  Such
expansion will depend on, among other things, the availability of qualified
IRSRs and the ability of the Company to comply with applicable local
licensing and business laws.  Prior to expanding into foreign markets, the
Company intends to translate some of its current sales and marketing
materials into languages such as Spanish and Mandarin Chinese for use in
its current markets.

Operations

     The Company's operations provide for the sale of fine gold jewelry and
collectibles.  The Company markets and sells its products through a network
of IRSRs, independent contractors who purchase products from the Company
and resell them to the public or consume them personally.  While these
IRSRs are in business for themselves, the Company provides support for
their efforts by making available certain sales, training and motivational
tools and other technical and supervisory assistance.  All IRSRs must
adhere to the Company's written Policies and Procedures in order to
maintain their affiliation with the Company.  Compensation to these IRSRs
is based on the Company's proprietary Bi-Lateral Compensation Plan.  See
Bi-Lateral Compensation Plan.

     The Company negotiates for and secures the rights to market and sell
the various products available to the IRSRs. The Company has secured the
rights to market various items of fine jewelry from E.B. Harvey.  The items
of jewelry currently available to the Company from E.B. Harvey include gold
(14K, 18K and 24K) and precious stone jewelry in the form of rings,
bracelets, earrings, necklaces and watches, among others.  In addition, the
Company's current access to the fine collectible products it offers to the
public is maintained through E. B. Harvey and the agreements that this
supplier has with the individual collectibles suppliers.  The Company is
constantly reviewing and evaluating the possibility of adding additional
product lines, as well as, additional product suppliers.

     The Company has recently made an arrangement with Jewels By Evonne to
provide jewelry products which are being tested for sales receptiveness
through a new Value Series Brochure (a marketing program which makes an
introduction of new Company products or introduces a new supplier on a
quarterly basis).  If these products are well received, Jewels By Evonne
shall serve as a new supplier to the Company and its products shall be
added to the Company's primary catalog.

     The Company is currently in discussions with a major US
telecommunications carrier to provide a value-added line of
telecommunications products to IRSRs to include:  personal communications
systems, long-distance pre-paid calling cards and conference calling.  The
Company is also exploring several affinity programs for its IRSRs not
limited to its own Visa/MasterCard and a travel program.

     The Company displays the various products for sale in color catalogues
which are made available for use by the IRSRs. In addition, the Company
assists its IRSRs in ordering the products, tracking delivery, and
recording and paying compensation associated with the sale of products.

     As of July 31, 1996 the Company had over 25,000 IRSRs throughout most
of the United States and parts of Canada, the vast majority of whom are
actively engaged in selling the Company's current product lines.  Gross
revenues for the Company, since its inception, have steadily increased with
the increase in the number of active IRSRs. Gross revenues have risen from
approximately $409,000 in June 1995, to approximately $1,135,000 for the
week ended August 23, 1996.

     As of August 31, 1996 the Company had already achieved a significant
increase in sales and operating profitability.  For the one month period
ending August 31, 1996 (unaudited) the Company had gross revenues of
$5,650,242.15, with operating income of $678,029.04.  In addition, the
Company achieved its first $1,000,000 sales day on August 30, 1996 and for
the one week sale period ending August 31, 1996 the Company had gross
revenues in excess of $2,000,000.  In management's opinion, the Company is
experiencing significant sales growth and operating profitability and
expects the Company to continue with this trend of operations and sales.

Bi-Lateral Compensation Plan

     IRSRs are compensated for sales of the Company's products in
accordance with the Company's proprietary Bi-Lateral Compensation Plan,
(the "Plan").  Representatives earn compensation under in the Plan in any
of several ways.  First, Representatives may purchase products at wholesale
cost from the Company and sell them at a marked-up retail price to
consumers, thereby earning a retail profit.

     Second, Representatives may undertake to build a Retail Sales
Organization, and earn override commissions and bonuses on the sales made
by the other Representatives in the Retail Sales Organization.  Attendant
with this opportunity to earn override commissions and bonuses, the Company
places an obligation on the sponsoring Representative to supervise, manage
and otherwise support and aid the down line Representatives in their sales
efforts.  To qualify for such override commissions and bonuses, a
Representative must (1) "open" a Retail Business Center with the Company;
(2) "create" Retail Sales Business Volume through retail sales, retail
purchases and/or the use of Retail Business Agreements; (3) "certify" the
Retail Business Center by amassing at least 200 in Retail Sales Business
Volume Credit; and (4) "duplicate" the Retail Business Center by sponsoring
two additional IRSRs who also create sales organizations of their own.
Override commissions and bonuses are tracked and calculated by the Company
and paid out weekly to qualifying representatives.  To maintain their
qualification to receive override commissions and bonuses, all
Representatives are required to meet certain retail sales quotas themselves
by selling products to buyers outside the Company.  The Company only pays
commissions on product sales.  No commissions are paid when Representative
or prospective Representative is sponsored.  Representatives are personally
responsible for all taxes due on their earnings.

Competition

     The Company operates in a highly competitive business.  The Company
competes with a number of established network marketing companies including
several that are better known than the Company.  Among others, the Company
competes with Jewelway (a jewelry distributor), Amway (a disposable goods
distributor) and Quorum (an electronics distributor).  With its network
marketing competitors, the Company competes not only for the sale of
products but also for the services of successful IRSRs. The Company
believes its products are of a higher quality than its network marketing
competitors, and that it offers more services and a more attractive
compensation formula for selling Representatives than its competitors.

     In addition, the Company also competes with more traditional retail
sellers of fine jewelry and fine collectibles.  These competitors are
typically located in malls or other retail shopping areas.  The Company
believes its marketing approach is more efficient and effective than these
traditional store-front retailers, and that it can provide its products at
a more attractive price because of the absence of traditional retail
overhead costs.

Network Marketing Industry and Government Regulation

     Regulations regarding network marketing companies are a complexity of
overlapping laws which vary from jurisdiction to jurisdiction.  Network
sales programs are affected by combinations of business opportunity
statutes, franchise and securities statutes, anti-pyramid statutes, network
distribution statutes, and state lottery statutes, as well as, U.S. Post
Office lottery and Federal Trade Commission fraud regulations, among
others.  In addition, some regulatory officials seem to have a negative
bias toward the legality of network marketing as a means of merchandising.
Many network marketing programs have been targeted for prosecution and
litigation under a variety of laws, though enforcement of these statutes
and regulations has often appeared selective.  Failure to comply with the
laws of any jurisdiction can result in the loss of the Company's ability to
operate therein for indefinite periods of time, and could possibly affect
its ability to operate in other jurisdictions as well.  From time to time,
the Company has, in the past, received inquiries from various state
regulators regarding various aspects of the Company's business.  The
Company's practice is to promptly respond to all such inquiries, and to
provide whatever information is requested.  The Company is aware of no
currently outstanding inquiries to which it has not responded, or other
actions by any state or federal regulatory authority.  However, no
assurances can be given that such responses will be deemed dispositive of
any particular matter.  From its inception, the Company has invested a
substantial amount of money to seek the advice of legal counsel in the
areas of corporate, network marketing and securities law in order to
structure itself in accordance with the multiplicity of laws that govern
its operations.  Though it can give no assurances, the Company believes it
has taken reasonable steps to comply with the various laws that would apply
to it in the jurisdictions in which it currently operates.  In addition,
the Company has adopted certain policies and procedures designed to assure
compliance with the various laws that govern its business, and it devotes
significant efforts to policing its operations and sales force.

Physical Properties and Equipment

     The following table provides a description of the Company's principal
physical properties and equipment including the original cost, and the
accumulated depreciation and net book value as of July 31, 1996.  All of
the physical properties and equipment are located at the Company's Raleigh,
North Carolina headquarters.  Although the Company has not retained an
independent appraisal for such purposes, the Company estimates the total
replacement cost associated with the physical properties and equipment is
approximately $575,000.

Property and equipment - at cost:

     Construction In Process                   $18,876     
     Computer Software                         108,081     
     Computer Hardware                         260,121
     Office Furniture and Equipment            132,511
     Vehicle                                    32,775
     Leasehold Improvement                       4,547
     Total Cost                                556,911
     Accumulated Depreciation                  114,701
     Book Value                               $442,210                    
               
Employees

     As of July 31, 1996, the Company had forty-four (44) employees, of
whom eleven (11) performed management and supervisory functions and
thirty-three (33) performed technical, administrative and support functions
related to the Company's sales and network marketing operations.  As of
July 31, 1996, forty-three (43) of the Company's employees were full-time
employees and one (1) Company employee was part-time.  As of July 31, 1996,
the Company had employment contracts with its President and managers only.
The management contracts are for one (1) year terms and address
confidentiality and non-competition concerns.


     As of July 31, 1996, International Heritage of Canada, Inc. had two
(2) employees both of whom were full-time employees.  These employees are
involved primarily in conducting the same business as the Company; however,
their duties are related solely to business conducted in the three Canadian
provinces where authorization to do business has been secured.

     The Company is not a party to any collective bargaining agreements.
The Company considers relations with its employees to be excellent.

                    PRIOR SALES OF SECURITIES

     Prior to this Offering, the Company sold and issued a total of
10,493,540 Shares of Common Stock for a total consideration of $1,607,060(5).
The Company received cash consideration of $732,660.  The balance of the
consideration was for services rendered, sales awards and incentives, and
management awards, having a value of $874,400.

(5) As of July 31, 1996. See Financial Statements.

    Between May 1995 and December 1995, the Company sold 998,675 shares of
its Common Stock to approximately 192 persons for an aggregate of
$1,257,450 in cash and services.  The Company relied upon the Regulation D,
Rule 504 exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act
of 1933 for these sales.  The Company made rescission offers to each of
these investors in December 1995.  All investors who accepted the offer of
rescission were repaid the amount of their investment plus interest at the
legal rate.  Four (4) investors accepted the offer of rescission.

    In January 1996, the Company issued rights to shares of Common Stock
(totaling 50,000 post-split shares) to four (4) existing shareholders and
IRSRs as merit awards for their previous provision of gratis services to
the Company.  Two (2) of these individuals are current directors of the
Company.  The issuance of shares pursuant to these rights is contingent
upon each remaining an IRSR of the Company through December 31, 1996.  The
Company relied upon the Section 4(2) exemption from the registration
requirements of the Securities Act of 1933 for issuance of these
securities.

    In January 1996, the Company issued rights to shares of Common Stock
(totaling 70,000 post-split shares) to eight (8) existing IRSRs as sales
awards and compensation for their product sales efforts.  Three (3) of
these IRSRs are past or present directors of the Company or are affiliated
with present directors of the Company.  The issuance of shares pursuant to
these rights is contingent upon each IRSR remaining in good standing with
the Company through December 31, 1996.  The Company relied upon the Section
4(2) exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act of
1933 for issuance of these securities.

    In January 1996, the Company issued rights to shares of Common Stock
(totaling 152,000 post-split shares) to twenty (20) existing employees as
compensation for their various services to the Company.  One (1) of these
employees is a current director of the Company.  The issuance of shares
pursuant to these rights is contingent upon each remaining an employee in
good standing through December 31, 1996.  The Company relied upon the
Section 4(2) exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities
Act of 1933 for issuance of these securities.  As of July 31, 1996 four (4)
of the employees were no longer employed but an additional employee was
granted such rights to shares for a total of 142,000 shares subject to this
conditional gift.

    In February 1996, the Company issued 10,087 shares (100,870 post-split
shares) of its Common Stock to the Company's President, Stanley H. Van
Etten, pursuant to an employment contract between the Company and Mr. Van
Etten whereby he was entitled to receive as compensation for his services a
bonus of one percent (1%) of the shares of the Company's Common stock
outstanding at December 31, 1995, as a result of the Company meeting
certain financial goals during 1995.  The Company relied upon the Section
4(2) exemption from the registration requirements of the Securities Act of
1933 for the issuance of these shares.  Mr. Van Etten assigned these shares
to Mayflower Holdings, Inc., who in turn gifted the shares to various
individuals.

    In March 1996, the Company issued 25,000 shares (250,000 post-split
shares) of its Common Stock to Mayflower Holdings, Inc., a principal
shareholder of the Company, of which the Company's President, Stanley H.
Van Etten, is also president.  The Company granted said shares as
prepayment for services in connection with a corporate capitalization plan.
The Company relied upon the Section 4(6) exemption from the registration
requirements of the Securities Act of 1933 for the issuance of these
shares.

    During the March 1996 meeting of the Board of Directors, Johnny Daniel
was granted 20,000 (200,000 post-split shares) conditional shares for
assisting the Company in establishing IRSRs in the State of Montana.  The
award of these shares is contingent upon Mr. Daniel remaining a
Representative in good standing with the Company through January 1, 1997.

                    RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

    It is the Company's policy that any person that is a member of
management or an employee of either the Company or International Heritage
of Canada, Inc., may not build a sales organization and receive override
commissions and bonuses therefrom under the Bi-Lateral Compensation Plan.
Such members of management and employees are free to purchase the Company's
products and resell them to others or to consume them personally.

    All future material affiliated transactions and loans will be made or
entered into on terms that are no less favorable to the Company than those
that can be obtained from unaffiliated third parties.  In addition, all
future material affiliated transactions and loans and any forgiveness of
loans, must be approved by a majority of the independent outside members of
the Company's Board of Directors who do not have an interest in the
transactions; however, at present, there are no such independent outside
members.

    Mayflower Holdings, Inc., ("Mayflower") a principal shareholder of whom
Stanley H. Van Etten is President, provided substantial professional
services, employees, operating capital, corporate office space, loans,
general administrative supplies and support to the Company during the
period March through May 1995.  As a result, the Company owed $131,812 to
the President and to Mayflower.  These notes have been repaid as of July
31, 1996.  Mayflower advanced $178,500 to the Company in August 1996.  The
note requires repayment at a rate of $50,000 on the fifteenth of each month
for the months October 1996 through January 1997 with the final payment
including interest accrued at a rate of twelve percent (12%).  This loan is
secured by the assets of the Company.

    In addition, as of July 31, 1996, the Company has shareholder loans in
the amount of $10,000 outstanding.  The notes bear interest at a rate of
twelve percent (12%) and mature in less than one year.  In order to provide
the note holders with a rate of return commensurate with the risk of their
investments, the notes were discounted ten percent (10%) and the discount
is being amortized over the twelve (12) month period.  The notes shall be
repaid with proceeds from the offering.

    The Company received services related to the start-up and organization
of the Company's Canadian subsidiary totaling $450,000 in exchange for
stock of the Company from shareholders.

    The Company entered into an agreement with the Company's President,
Stanley H. Van Etten, and a relative to create a sales training handbook
for the Company's IRSRs. The agreement calls for a lump sum payment of
$10,000 to the authors as well as a $4.00 per book royalty.

    The Company has entered into an agreement with Premium Concepts, Inc.,
the president of which is a shareholder of the Company, to provide the
Company with a line of clothing, and other accessories.  The Company shall
not bear any of the costs associated with production and manufacture of the
clothing and other accessories, but shall receive a royalty for granting
the license to use the Company logo(s).

                            MANAGEMENT

Directors and Executive Officers

    The directors and executive officers of the Company, their ages
as of July 31, 1996, and their respective positions are as follows:

    Name                     Age                     Position    

Stanley H. Van Etten         34             President, CEO and Chairman
Barry A. Ackel               54             Director
John D. Brothers             30             Secretary and Director
Jimmie D. Knowles            50             Director
Claude W. Savage             58             Director
Larry G. Smith               51             Director
Sabrina L. H. Wei            27             Director

Directors are elected by the shareholders to serve until their successors
are duly elected and qualified.  There are no family relationships between
any of the directors and executive officers of the Company.

 STANLEY H. VAN ETTEN has served as President, CEO and Chairman of the
Company since May 4, 1995.  Mr. Van Etten was the incorporator and a
founding party of the Company.  Mr. Van Etten also is the President of
Mayflower Holdings, Inc., and has held this position since 1992.  Mayflower
Holdings is engaged in various business activities including corporate
finance and management consulting, and is a principal shareholder of the
Company.  See Principal Shareholders.  Through Mayflower Holdings Mr. Van
Etten is a principal shareholder and also is the Managing Director of
Mayflower Capital LLC, a pending National Association of Securities
Dealers, Inc., ("NASD") member investment banking firm.  Mr. Van Etten is
also the President of Mayflower Venture Capital, LLC, a venture fund which
focuses on emerging and developing small to middle-market companies located
in the southeastern Unites States.  From 1988 to 1993, Mr. Van Etten was
Regional Vice President for F.N. Wolf & Co., Inc., a national investment
banking firm.  Mr. Van Etten holds a Bachelor of Arts degree from Florida
State University.  Mr. Van Etten attended the Duke University, Fuqua School
of Business Executive MBA program in 1991 and 1992 but did not complete all
of the course work for graduation.  He holds Series 24, 7, and 63 licenses
with the NASD as well.  In addition, Mr. Van Etten owns small percentages
of numerous companies and from time to time serves as director or
consultant.

    BARRY A. ACKEL has served as a Director of the Company since January
1996.  He is also a principal shareholder of the Company.  See Principal
Shareholders.  Prior to his association with the Company, Mr. Ackel was an
independent distributor with various network marketing companies.  In
addition, Mr. Ackel has been the owner or co-owner of several businesses
dating back to 1967.

    JOHN D. BROTHERS has served as a Director of the Company since January
1996.  Since November 1995, Mr. Brothers also has served as the Company's
Compliance Director, and from June 1995 to November 1995 he was an IRSR of
the Company.  From September 1994 to June 1995, he was an Account Manager
with Ostrander Burch & Co. in Raleigh, and from February 1993 to September
1994, he was Vice President of Mayflower Holdings, Inc. In addition, from
1989 to 1993, he held several positions with F.N. Wolf & Co., Inc.
including the position of Branch Manager.  Mr. Brothers holds a Bachelors
degree from Elon College with a major in Finance.  In addition, he holds
Series 24, 7, 63 and 28 licenses with the NASD.

    JIMMIE D. KNOWLES has served as a Director of the Company since March
1996.  He is also a principal shareholder of the Company.  See Principal
Shareholders.  Since 1982 he has been the owner of several businesses in
North Carolina including at present, Body's N Motion, Garner Glass & Mirror
and Action Glass of the Triangle.  In addition, from 1983 to 1994, Mr.
Knowles held insurance and securities salesmen licenses.

    CLAUDE W. SAVAGE has served as a Director of the Company since May
1995.  He also is a principal shareholder of the Company.  See Principal
Shareholders.  Mr. Savage has been involved with network marketing since
1990.  He is the former National Marketing Director with National Safety
Associates.  Mr. Savage also is a former teacher and coach in various
public school systems in North Carolina, and since 1975, he has been the
owner of fourteen (14) restaurants.  He is currently the owner of the Fish
Farm Seafood Restaurant in Matthews, North Carolina.  Prior to his
association with the Company, Mr. Savage was an independent distributor
with various network marketing companies.  Mr. Savage holds a Masters
degree and a Bachelor of Science degree from Appalachian State University.

    LARRY G. SMITH has served as a Director of the Company since May 1995.
Mr. Smith is the Managing Director of Omega Leasing Services, a principal
shareholder of the Company.  See Principal Shareholders.  From 1987 to
1994, Mr. Smith was President and a principal shareholder of Cross Key
Enterprises, Inc., which was engaged in various corporate activities
including business development and acquisitions.  Mr. Smith's experience
lies in the health care field.  For eighteen (18) years he worked with
Smith Kline Beckman and Johnson & Johnson.  The highest position held was
Vice President of Sales and Marketing.  Prior to his association with the
Company, Mr. Smith was an independent distributor with various network
marketing companies.  He holds a Bachelor of Science degree from Bob Jones
University.

    SABRINA L.H. WEI has served as a Director of the Company since January
1996.  Prior to her association with the Company, Ms. Wei was involved with
network marketing with Nu Skin International and was Regional Vice
President for Images & Attitudes International (New Ways).  Prior to that
she established Trans Global Development and Investment Company, Ltd., a
Hong Kong-based investment consulting firm.  In addition, from 1986 to 1990
she was a Senior Auditor specializing in finance and investment with Touche
Ross, Chartered Accountants.  Ms. Wei holds a Bachelors degree from Simon
Fraser University.

Executive Compensation

    The following table sets forth the compensation paid by the Company as
of July 31, 1996 to each of the individuals who served as officers or
directors of the Company, and to all officers and directors as a group.

          Name               Position               Compensation 

Stanley H. Van Etten         President/CEO/Director $842,499(1)(3)
Barry A. Ackel               Director               -0-(1)(2)
John D. Brothers             Secretary/Director     $60,963(1)(2)
Jimmie D. Knowles            Director               -0-(1)(2)
Claude W. Savage             Director               -0-(1)(2)
Larry G. Smith               Director               -0-(1)(2)
Sabrina L.H. Wei             Director               -0-(1)(2)
All officers and directors
as a group (7 persons)                              $903,462
                                                                     
    (1) Does not include payments to each director of $100 per
        meeting plus reimbursement of expenses incurred in
        attending meetings.

    (2) Does not include compensation received from the Company for
        sales of products or bonuses or override commissions
        on sales by down line sales organizations.

    (3) In accordance with the provisions of his employment contract
        and based on the performance of the Company in 1995,
        Mr. Van Etten received a stock bonus of 1% of the
        issued and outstanding shares (or 10,087 pre-split
        shares) of the Company's Common Stock as of December
        31, 1995 on February 16, 1996.


                          OPTIONS GRANTS

     The Company has granted various options and conditional shares as
incentives to various parities associated with the Company and its
business.  Currently all shareholders, optionees and prospective
(conditional) shareholders are either IRSRs or employees of the Company.
The only exception to this is:  Patrick Kolenick, Bridge Ventures, Inc.,
Mayflower Holdings, Inc., Justo Nunez, Georgina Marie Mollick, Wood &
Francis, PLLC, Richard S. Heller, Jeffrey Babener and Wyrick, Robbins,
Yates & Ponton, PLLP, all of whom are professional parties working on
behalf of the Company.  All outstanding options (other than those issued to
managers, employees and professional parties) have been issued to "key"
IRSRs who work on a full-time basis selling Company products.  Since all of
these IRSRs are independent contractors, the Company believes these options
are a necessary incentive in order to keep these IRSRs associated with the
Company as opposed to loosing these key IRSRs to competing network
marketing companies.

     The following table sets forth all outstanding options as of July 31,
1996:
                                

                 Options Granted                                 Expiration 
Name             Number of Shares    Exercise Price  Grant Date  Date

Claude Savage(1) 5% of the issued and $0.0002    May 4, 1995 May 4, 1998
               	 outstanding shares

Omega Leasing Services(1)     
                5% of the issued and  $0.0002    May 4, 1995 May 4, 1998
               	outstanding shares

Mayflower Holdings, Inc.(1)   
                5% of the issued and  $0.0002    May 4, 1995 May 4, 1998
               	outstanding shares

Barry Ackel(2)         100,000          $0.20     Jan 8, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Claude Savage(2)       100,000          $0.20     Jan 8, 1996 Jan 1, 1999
 
Larry G. Smith(2)      100,000          $0.20     Jan 8, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Stanley H. Van Etten(2)
                       100,000         $0.20     Jan 8, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Sabrina L. H. Wei(2)   100,000         $0.20     Jan 8, 1996 Jan 1, 1999
												 
Derrick L. Rodgers(2)  100,000         $0.20     Jan 8, 1996 Jan 1, 1999


John D. Brothers(2)    100,000         $0.20     Jan 8, 1996 Jan 1, 1999


Jimmie Knowles(2)      100,000         $0.20     Apr 1, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

John D. Brothers(3)    100,000         $0.20     Mar 4, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Dawn McIntyre(3)       50,000          $0.20     Mar 4, 1996  Jan 1, 1999

Dawn McIntyre(3)       50,000          $0.20     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Mary Breen(3)          50,000          $0.20     Mar 4, 1996  Jan 1, 1999

Dwight Hallman(3)      50,000          $0.20     Mar 4, 1996  Jan 1, 1999

Dwight Hallman(3)      50,000          $0.20     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Clark Jones(3)         50,000          $0.20     Mar 4, 1996  Jan 1, 1999

Jeffrey L. Hooks(3)    50,000          $0.20     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Stephanie Harris(3)    50,000          $0.20     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Gary Bisby(4)          50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Johnny Daniell(4)      50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Rodger Gadd(4)         50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

B. Smith III(4)        50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

DeAnne Elrod(4)        50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Martin Runion(4)       50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Maureen Uphill(5)      50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Dave Martin(5)         50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Greg Bright(5)         50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Robert L. Chalmers(5)  50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Tricia Martin(5)       50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Rhyon Caldwell(5)      50,000          $1.00     Jun 30, 1996 Jan 1, 1999

Patrick Kolenik(6)     400,000         $1.50     Jul 3, 1996(10) Jan 1, 1999

Bridge Ventures, Inc.(6)
                       100,000         $1.50     Jul 3, 1996(10) Jan 1, 1999

Mayflower Holdings, Inc.(6)   
                       200,000         $1.50     Jul 3, 1996(10) Jan 1, 1999

O. Kenneth Rudd III(7) 100,000         $0.20     Jun 30, 1996  Jan 1, 1999

Evonne Eckenroth(7)     50,000         $0.20     Jun 30, 1996  Jan 1, 1999

Justo Nunez(8)         100,000         $0.20     Jun 30, 1996  Jan 1, 1999

Georgina Marie Mollick(9)
                       150,000         $0.20     Jun 30, 1996  Jun 30, 1999

Wood & Francis, PLLC(9) 50,000         $1.00     Jun 30, 1996  Jun 30, 1999
																  
Richard S. Heller(9)(11) 25,000        $1.00     Jun 30, 1996  Jun 30, 1999
												 
Jeffrey Babener(9)      50,000         $1.00     Jun 30, 1996  Jun 30, 1999

Wyrick, Robbins, 
   Yates & Ponton (9)   50,000         $1.00     Jun 30, 1996  Jun 30, 1999
     
                         
     (1)  1995 Board of Directors option.
     (2)  1996 Board of Directors option.
     (3)  1996 Management option.
     (4)  U.S. Advisory Board option.
     (5)  Canadian Advisory Board option.
     (6)  Option of consultants.
     (7)  Retail Sales Training System Development and Implementation
          Team Member Option.
     (8)  Merit Award for marketing services to Company since inception.
     (9)  Option to legal service providers.
     (10) Option granted after the ten for one (10:1) stock split
     (11) Will be restricted for 12 months from the date of SEC effectiveness.
     
      SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND
                           MANAGEMENT

     At July 31, 1996, the directors, executive officers and persons
holding five percent (5%) or more of the outstanding Shares were as
follows:
                                     Percentage              
                                     Shares
                                     Benefi-   Prior    After       After
                                     cially    to       $5,000,000  $25,000,000
Shareholder                          Owned     Offering Offering    Offering

Acme Holdings                        522,500   4.98%    4.75%       4.02%
Barry Ackel, Director
1239 Heyman Lane
Alexandria, LA 71303

Omega Leasing Services               915,000  8.72%     8.32%       7.04%
Larry G. Smith, Director
2435 E. North Street
Suite 292
Greenville, SC 29615

Jimmie & Portia Knowles, Director   663,900  6.33%      6.04%       5.11%
105 Beechtree Court
Apex, NC 27502

Mayflower Holdings                  885,280(6) 8.43%    8.05%       6.81%
Stanley H. Van Etten, President & CEO
2626 Glenwood Avenue
Suite 300
Raleigh, NC 27608

Paradise Investments, Ltd.          250,000  2.38%      2.27%       1.92%
Sabrina L. H. Wei, Director
1370-885 W. Georgia
Vancouver, BC V6C 3E8
Canada

Derrick L. Rodgers                  577,000  5.50%          5.25%  4.44%
409 Jackson Park Road
Kannapolis, NC 28083

Claude Savage, Director             797,000  7.59%          7.25%  6.13%
106 Benbow Lane
Charlotte, NC 28214

To the Top We Go, Inc.              110,000(7) 1.05%        1.00%  0.85%
John D. Brothers, Director
2626 Glenwood Ave.,
Ste. 200
Raleigh, NC 27608

All directors and                 4,143,680   39.48%       37.68%  31.88%
executive officers
as a group (7 persons)

(6) Does not include stock bonus of 10,087 shares (pre-split) earned pursuant to
the president's employment contract with the Company or the 25,000 shares
(pre-split) awarded to Mayflower Holdings, Inc., as prepayment for services
in connection with as corporate capitalization plan. All shares were gifted to
other parties, no shares were retained by Mr. Van Etten or Mayflower Holdings,
Inc.

(7) Does not include 25,000 conditional shares to be granted January 1, 1997 so
long as Mr. Brothers remains continuously employed by the Company through Dec-
ember 31, 1996.


                            LITIGATION
The Company is not involved currently in any material legal proceedings.

The Company's directors and officers are not involved currently in any
legal proceedings, except as listed below regarding Stanley H. Van Etten
and John D. Brothers.

1.  Jerry W. Kapp, et al. v.  F.N. Wolf & Co., Inc., et al., 93 CVS 02170,
    Wake County Superior Court; 93-207-CIV-5-BO, United States District
    Court for the Eastern District of North Carolina, Raleigh Division.

    This action was initiated on February 26, 1993, in Wake County Superior
    Court.  The Complaint was filed by Jerry W. Kapp against F.N. Wolf &
    Co., Inc. ("Wolf"), and Stanley H. Van Etten.  The Plaintiff alleged
    that he had been damaged through the Defendants' sale of unregistered
    securities, market manipulation, and fraud in connection with the sale
    of securities in violation of the North Carolina Securities Act, as
    well as, through common law fraud, negligent misrepresentation, and
    breach of an implied contract duty of good faith and fair dealing.  Mr.
    Van Etten denied the allegations.  The Complaint also sought to
    certify, as a class, all North Carolina investors who purchased shares
    of Treats International Enterprises, Inc. from Wolf.  On August 24,
    1994, Wolf filed for Chapter 11 bankruptcy protection in the United
    States District court for the Southern District of New York.
    Subsequently, the Plaintiffs were enjoined temporarily from prosecuting
    their action provided that a disclosure statement was approved by the
    Bankruptcy Court and provided that a Plan of Reorganization was
    confirmed.  Wolf seeks a permanent injunction as part of the Plan of
    Reorganization which would presumably settle all claims against Mr. Van
    Etten.  Mr. Van Etten has entered into settlement discussions and
    management believes that the claims against Mr. Van Etten will be so
    settled, and that this matter will have no material effect on the
    Company.

2.  In addition, Mr. Van Etten and/or Mayflower Holdings, Inc., a principal
    shareholder of the Company, and a company in which Mr. Van Etten is a
    principal, and/or Carpediem Venture Capital Group, Inc., a company in
    which Mr. Van Etten is a shareholder, also are involved in certain
    litigation stemming from various venture capital financing
    transactions.  First, on March 2, 1995, Mayflower Holdings, Inc. filed
    suit against Denise Fordin in Superior Court in Wake County, North
    Carolina alleging that Ms. Fordin had failed to repay a loan made to a
    company of which Ms. Fordin was a principal and for which Ms. Fordin
    had personally guaranteed the loan.  Mayflower Holdings, Inc. secured a
    judgment in the matter and has enforced the same.  Second, Mr. Van
    Etten is a shareholder in Carpediem Venture Capital Group, Inc., which
    filed a complaint against various defendants in Superior Court in
    Forsyth County, North Carolina in March 1995, alleging common law fraud
    and securities law violations, stemming from a transaction to provide
    investment capital to the defendants and their business venture.
    Answers have been filed by the Defendants and a Motion for Summary
    Judgment is currently pending.  Third, Parissa Haibodi Jones has filed
    suit against Mr. Van Etten individually in September 1995, in District
    Court, Wake County, North Carolina, alleging that Mr. Van Etten was
    liable for loans that Jones had made to Sunshine Jr. Acquisition, Inc.
    Mr. Van Etten has prepared an Answer to this Complaint denying the
    allegations.  Mr. Van Etten intends to vigorously prosecute or defend
    his interests in each of these suits.  In addition, management believes
    that none of these matters will have a significant adverse impact on
    the Company, and has included disclosure of these matters in the
    interest of full disclosure.

3.  On January 20, 1995, Mr. Brothers filed a petition for adjustment of
    debts under Chapter 13, Title 11, United States Code in the United
    States Bankruptcy Court for the Eastern District of North Carolina
    (Case No. 95-00061-5-ATS).  The Court ordered a schedule for repayment
    of debts.

                   DESCRIPTION OF COMMON STOCK

Upon the closing of the offering, the authorized capital stock of the
Company will consist of 25,000,000 shares of Common Stock, par value $0.001
per share.

As of July 31, 1996, there were 10,493,540 shares of Common Stock
outstanding held by the Shareholders.  In addition, pursuant to its
employment agreement with its President, Stanley H. Van Etten, the Company
awarded Mr. Van Etten a bonus of 10,087 pre-split shares (1% of the issued
and outstanding shares of December 31, 1995) based on the Company's
financial performance in 1995.  These shares were issued on February 16,
1996.  March 4, 1996, the Company's Board of Directors awarded an
additional 25,000 pre-split shares of Common Stock to Mayflower Holdings,
Inc. as prepayment for services provided by a related party in an
anticipated capitalization plan.  Mr. Van Etten assigned all rights and
ownership to these shares to Mayflower Holdings, Inc., who in turn gifted
the shares to various individuals.

During the January 1996 annual meeting of the Board of Directors, certain
conditional share awards were approved.  These awards included:  (i) rights
to shares of common stock totaling 50,000 shares to be awarded in January
1997 to four (4) existing shareholders and Representatives as merit awards
for their previous provision of gratis services to the Company; (ii) rights
to shares of common stock totaling 70,000 shares to be awarded in January
1997 to nine (9) existing sales Representatives as sales awards for their
product sales efforts (three (3) of these Representatives are past or
present directors of the Company); and (iii) rights to shares of common
stock totaling 152,000 shares to be awarded January 1997 to twenty (20)
employees as compensation for their various services to the Company (some
of these employees have failed to meet the condition of continued
employment through December 31, 1996, and therefore there are 142,000
shares which are subject to the terms of this provision).
                                                           
During the January 1996 annual meeting of the Board of Directors, options
to the members of the Board of Directors were approved.  These options were
for 10,000 (pre-split) shares each at an exercise price of $2.00 per share,
the term of the option is between January 1, 1997 and January 1, 1999 to be
exercised in whole.  These options were conditioned on the optionee being
associated in good standing with the Company and remaining a member of the
Board of Directors from January 8, 1996 through December 31, 1996.

During the March 1996 meeting of the Board of Directors, as part of their
overall compensation, the Company's managers were awarded a stock option
for $2.00 per share exercisable between January 1, 1997 and January 1,
1999.  The options were granted as follows:  Mary Breen, 5,000 shares; Dawn
McIntyre, 5,000 shares; Clark Jones, 5,000 shares; Dwight Hallman, 5,000
shares; and John Brothers, 10,000 shares.  (All options reflect pre-split
numbers).

During the March 1996 meeting of the Board of Directors, Johnny Daniel was
granted 20,000 (pre-split) conditional shares for assisting the Company in
establishing IRSRs in the State of Montana.  The award of these shares is
contingent upon Mr. Daniel remaining a representative in good standing with
the Company through January 1, 1997.

June 30, 1996, the Board of Directors granted options to the members of the
Canadian Advisory Board and the U.S. Advisory Board.  Each member of the
advisory boards were entitled to 5,000 shares at an exercise price of
$10.00 per share on or before January 1, 1999.  The shares of common stock
subject to this option total 65,000 (pre-split) shares.  June 30, 1996 the
Board also granted options to its Retail Sales Training System Development
and Implementation Team, O. Kenneth Rudd, III and Evonne Eckenroth.  These
options are for 10,000 and 5,000 pre-split shares, respectively,
exercisable at a price of $2.00 per share on or before January 1, 1999.

On June 30, 1996, the Board of Directors also awarded options to various
service providers as follows:  (1) Justo Nunez of Nunez Communications
10,000 shares exercisable at a price of $2.00 per share in whole or in part
before January 1, 1999 for work with the Company in developing its
marketing materials since inception; (2) Georgina Marie Mollick, 15,000
shares exercisable at a price of $2.00 per share in whole or in part on
demand on or before June 30, 1999 for the rendering of legal services from
inception to date; (3) Wood & Francis, PLLC, 5,000 shares at $10.00 per
share exercisable in whole on or before January 1, 1999 for services as
general counsel to the Company; (4) Richard S. Heller, 2,500 shares at
$10.00 per share exercisable on or before January 1, 1999 for legal
services related to this offering.  Mr. Heller's shares will be restricted
for 12 months from the date of SEC effectiveness; (5) Jeffrey Babener,
5,000 shares at $10.00 per share exercisable on or before January 1, 1999
for network marketing legal services; and (6) Wyrick, Robbins, Yates &
Ponton, LLP, 5,000 shares at $10.00 per share on or before January 1, 1999
for legal services.  (All options reflect pre-split numbers).

On June 30, 1996, the Board of Directors also awarded options to new
managers Jeffrey L. Hooks and Stephanie Harris pursuant to the same terms
as the options granted to the Company's managers in March 1996.
Additionally, the Board awarded an additional option of 5,000 shares each
to Dawn McIntyre and Dwight Hallman (pursuant to the same terms as the
prior option grant).

The Company has granted the afore-mentioned various options and conditional
shares as incentives to parities associated with the Company and its
business.  Currently all shareholders, optionees and prospective
(conditional) shareholders are either IRSRs or employees of the Company.
The only exception to this is:  Patrick Kolenick, Bridge Ventures, Inc.,
Mayflower Holdings, Inc., Justo Nunez, Georgina Marie Mollick, Wood &
Francis, PLLC, Richard S. Heller, Jeffrey Babener and Wyrick, Robbins,
Yates & Ponton, PLLP, all of whom are professional parties working on
behalf of the Company.  All outstanding options (other than those issued to
managers, employees and professional parties) have been issued to "key"
IRSRs who work on a full-time basis selling Company products.  Since all of
these IRSRs are independent contractors, the Company believes these options
are a necessary incentive in order to keep these IRSRs associated with the
Company as opposed to loosing these key IRSRs to competing network
marketing companies.

Holders of shares of Common Stock are entitled to receive dividends in
cash, property or shares when and if dividends are declared by the Board of
Directors out of funds legally available therefor.  There are no
limitations on the payment of dividends.  A quorum for any meeting of
shareholders is fifty percent (50%) of the outstanding shares entitled to
be voted at the meeting.  Holders of Shares are entitled to one (1) vote
per share.  Upon any liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the business
of the Company, any assets will be distributed to the holders of shares
after payment or provision for payment of all debts, obligations or
liabilities of the Company.  There are no preemptive rights, subscription
rights, conversion rights and redemption provisions relating to the shares
and none of the shares carry any liability for further calls.

The rights of holders of shares of Common Stock may not be modified other
than by vote of two-thirds (2/3) of the shares voting on such modification.

                 SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE

Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for securities of
the Company.  No prediction can be made as to the effect, if any, that
market sales of shares of Common Stock or the availability of share of
Common Stock for sale will have on the market price prevailing from time to
time.  Nevertheless, sales of substantial amount of Common Stock of the
Company in the public market after the lapse of the restrictions through
the registration of the underlying shares, could adversely affect the
prevailing market price of the Common Stock.

Upon completion of the Minimum Offering, the Company will have outstanding
10,993,540 shares of Common Stock.  Upon completion of the Maximum
Offering, the Company will have outstanding 12,993,540 shares of Common
Stock.  Of these shares, 500,000 shares of Common Stock, representing all
of the shares sold in the Minimum Offering, or 2,500,000 shares of Common
Stock, representing all of the shares sold in the Maximum Offering, as the
case may be, will be freely tradable without restriction or limitation
under the Securities Act, except for shares, if any, purchased by an
"affiliate" of the Company (as defined in the rules and regulations of the
Commission under the Securities Act) which shares will be subject to the
resale limitations of Rule 144 under the Securities Act. The remaining
outstanding shares are "restricted" shares within the meaning of the
Securities Act (the "Restricted Shares").  The Restricted Shares
outstanding on the date hereof were issued and sold by the Company in
private transaction in reliance upon exemptions from registration under the
Securities Act and may be sold only if they are registered under the
Securities Act or unless any exemption from registration is available.  See
Prior Sales of Securities and Subsequent Registration of Privately Held
Shares.

                       PLAN OF DISTRIBUTION

The securities offered hereby are being offered on a "best efforts" basis
by WIN Capital Corporation.  Subject to the terms and conditions of the
Underwriting Agreement, a copy of which has been filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part, WIN Capital
Corporation has agreed to act as representative of the several underwriters
who will form the proposed selling group.  See Revised Underwriting
Agreement.

The Company will bear all costs and expenses incident to the issuance,
offer, sale and delivery of the Common Stock.  The Issuer has agreed to
reimburse WIN Capital Corporation's counsel, Shustak, Jalil, Sanders &
Heller, its legal fees estimated to be $35,000.  Richard S. Heller, a
member of the firm, has had options conferred on him by the Issuer for
25,000 common shares as an exercise price of $0.20 per share (post-split).
(These options are restricted for 12 months from the date of SEC
effectiveness).  The members of the selling group, if any, have agreed to
pay all fees and expenses of any legal counsel who it may employ to
represent it separately in connection with or on account of the proposed
offering by the Company, mailing, telephone, travel and clerical costs and
all other office costs incurred or to be incurred by the Underwriters or by
their representatives in connection with this offering.

The Company and the Underwriters have agreed to indemnify each other
against certain liabilities, including liabilities under the 1933 Act, and,
if such indemnifications are unavailable or insufficient, the Company and
the Underwriters have agreed to damage contribution agreements between them
based upon relative benefits received from this offering and relative fault
resulting in such damages.  The Company also has agreed with the
Underwriters that the Company will file and cause to become effective a
registration statement pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Securities Exchange
Act of 1934 no later than the date of this Prospectus.

The Company intends to sell the shares of Common Stock in this offering
only in the states in which the offering is qualified.  An offer to
purchase may only be made and consummated in such states.  The Subscription
Agreement for the shares of Common Stock must be executed, and the shares
of Common Stock may only be delivered only in such states.  Resales or
transfer of the shares of Common Stock may be restricted under state law.

If the Company does not terminate the offering earlier, the offering of
shares of Common Stock will continue beyond the minimum amount of
$5,000,000 until the Company raises an aggregate of $25,000,000, provided
that the offering period for all of the shares of Common Stock of the
Company will not exceed 120 days from the effective date of this
Prospectus.

The participating members of the selling group have agreed in accordance
with the provisions of Rule 15c2-4 promulgated by the Securities and
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, to cause all funds received upon
subscription for shares of Common Stock to be forwarded to the Escrow Agent
upon the receipt of the executed Subscription Agreement and related funds
by the member of the selling group by or before noon of the next business
day following the subscription for said shares of Common Stock.

Any and all proceeds received by the Underwriter from the sale of the Stock
shall be deposited in an escrow account with Continental Trust & Transfer
Company (the "Escrow Agent") pursuant to the terms and conditions of the
Escrow Agreement, a copy of which has been filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement of which this Prospectus forms a part.  The Company
shall pay the fee for establishing and maintaining the escrow account.
Subscribers' checks shall be made payable to the Escrow Agent and the
Underwriter will transmit such checks directly to the Escrow Agent by noon
the next business day after receipt.  The Escrow Agent promptly shall
release to the Company the net proceeds (proceeds less commissions) from
the sales of the Stock as and when requested by the Company but in any
event, no earlier than the closing of the offering beginning with the first
closing upon receipt of the Minimum Offering amount of $5,000,000 and the
Maximum Offering amount of $25,000,000 or until the termination of the
offering.  The commission relating to a particular sale shall be released
by the Escrow Agent to the Underwriter when the net proceeds of that sale
are released to the Company.

Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for the Common
Stock.  The initial public offering price has been unilaterally determined
by the Company without being negotiated with an underwriter or other third
party.  Among factors considered by the Company in determining the price
were the history of, and the prospects for, the Company and the industry in
which it competes, its past and present operations, its past and present
earnings and the trend of such earnings, the prospects for future earnings,
the present state of the Company's development, the general condition of
the securities markets at the time of this offering, and the recent market
prices of publicly traded common stocks of comparable companies.
                                 
                            LEGAL MATTERS

The legality of the Securities offered hereby has been passed upon for the
Company by Wood & Francis, PLLC, Raleigh, North Carolina.  The Underwriter
will be represented by Shustak Jalil Sanders & Heller, New York, New York.

                             EXPERTS

The balance sheets of the Company as of July 31, 1996 (historical and pro
forma) and December 31, 1995, and the statements of loss, changes in
stockholders' deficit, cash flow and the consolidated financial statement
schedules for the period from April 28, 1995 (inception) to December 31,
1995, and the seven months ended July 31, 1996 appearing in this Prospectus
and Registration Statement, have been included herein in reliance on the
reports of Eilers, Jones, Brown & McLeod, CPAs, PA, independent
accountants, given on the authority of that firm as experts in accounting
and auditing.

                      ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

The Company is subject to the informational requirements of the Securities
Exchange Act of 1934 and in accordance therewith files reports and other
information with the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC"), all of
which may be inspected and copied at the public reference facilities
maintained by the SEC at 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20549.
In addition, the Company intends to provide its shareholders with annual
reports, including audited financial statements, and such other reports as
the Company may determine.

The Company has filed with the SEC a Registration Statement under the
Securities Act of 1933, as amended, with respect to the securities offered
hereby.  This Prospectus does not contain all of the information set forth
in the Registration Statement and exhibits thereto.  For further
information with respect to the Company and the securities offered hereby,
or with respect to any contract or other document referred to, reference is
made to such Registration Statement and exhibits, including the copy of
such contract or other documents as it is filed as an exhibit to the
Registration Statement.  Copies of all or any part of the Registration
Statement may be obtained from the Public Reference Section of the SEC,
Washington, D.C. 20549 upon the payment of the fees prescribed by the SEC.


                  INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                
   INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTAL
                           INFORMATION
                                
        Periods Ended July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                

                                                              PAGE(S)

INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT                                    F-2

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Consolidated Balance Sheets                               F-3 & F-4

Consolidated Statements of Loss                                 F-5

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders' Deficit                F-6

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows                           F-7

Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements              F-8 to F-16

SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION:

Schedules of Consolidated Selling and Administrative Expenses  F-17

























        
        
        
        
        
        
                       INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
        
        
        
        To the Shareholders of
        International Heritage, Inc.
        Raleigh, North Carolina
        
        We  have  audited  the  accompanying  consolidated  balance
        sheets of International Heritage, Inc. as of July 31,  1996
        and   December  31,  1995,  and  the  related  consolidated
        statements  of loss, stockholders' deficit and  cash  flows
        for  the periods January 1, 1996 to July 31, 1996 and April
        28,  1995 (date of inception) to December 31, 1995.   These
        consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of
        the   management  of  International  Heritage,  Inc.    Our
        responsibility is to express an opinion on these  financial
        statements based on our audits.
        
        We  conducted  our  audits  in  accordance  with  generally
        accepted auditing standards.   Those standards require that
        we   plan  and  perform  the  audit  to  obtain  reasonable
        assurance about whether the financial statements  are  free
        of  material misstatement.  An audit includes examining, on
        a   test   basis,  evidence  supporting  the  amounts   and
        disclosures  in the financial statements.   An  audit  also
        includes  assessing  the  accounting  principles  used  and
        significant  estimates  made  by  management,  as  well  as
        evaluating  the  overall financial statement  presentation.
        We  believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis  for
        our opinion.
        
        In  our  opinion,  the  consolidated  financial  statements
        referred to above present fairly, in all material respects,
        the  financial position of International Heritage, Inc.  as
        of  July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995, and the results of
        its  operations  and its cash flows for  the  periods  then
        ended  in  conformity  with generally  accepted  accounting
        principles.
        
        Our  audits  were conducted for the purpose of  forming  an
        opinion  on  the  basic  consolidated financial  statements
        taken as a whole.  The supplemental information on page  F-
        17  is presented for purposes of additional analysis and is
        not  a  required  part of the basic consolidated  financial
        statements.   Such  information has been subjected  to  the
        same  auditing procedures applied in the audit of the basic
        consolidated financial statements and, in our  opinion,  is
        fairly stated in all material respects, in relation to  the
        basic consolidated financial statements taken as a whole
        
        
        /s/ EILERS, JONES, BROWN & McLEOD, CPAs, PA
        
        
        
        August 24, 1996
		Raleigh, North Carolina


                  INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                
                   CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                                
               July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                

                             ASSETS
                                               
                                                   1996       1995
CURRENT ASSETS
 Cash                                         $ 274,797  $ 454,671
 Certificates of deposit                         70,265     10,000
 Inventory                                      423,193    283,371
 Employee and stockholder advances               54,093     39,556
 Due from representatives, less allowance for
     doubtful accounts of $11,595 in 1996       347,177    142,028
 Sales tax refunds due                           44,214          -
 Other receivables                               45,457     22,998
 Deposits                                       122,179     79,419
 Prepaid expenses                               378,911      1,438
     Total Current Assets                     1,760,286  1,033,481

PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT - AT COST
 Construction in process                         18,876          -
 Computer software                              108,081     81,102
 Computer hardware                              260,121    101,114
 Office furniture and equipment                 132,511     88,137
 Vehicle                                         32,775         -
 Leasehold improvements                           4,547         -
                                                556,911    270,353
 Less accumulated depreciation and amortization 114,701     36,411
     Net Property and Equipment                 442,210    233,942

ORGANIZATIONAL AND START-UP COSTS, NET           804,630    864,861

DOWNLINE DEVELOPMENT COSTS, NET                  200,374    146,709





                                               $3,207,500 $2,278,993





The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated
                      financial statements.
                                
                  INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                
                   CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
                                
               July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                

              LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' DEFICIT
                                
                                               
                                                   1996       1995
CURRENT LIABILITIES
 Trade accounts payable                       $ 909,877  $ 594,566
 Payable to representatives                     148,399    103,331
 Cash overdrafts                                      -    242,606
 Deferred revenue                               464,914    408,375
 Sales tax payable                               41,703    135,913
 Accrued payroll and payroll taxes              218,640     13,215
 Accrued commissions                          1,542,132    915,421
 Accrued earn-out product                       413,255    253,913
 Accrued award trip                              50,000          -
 Accrued interest payable                             -      2,675
 Notes payable from stockholders                 10,000     33,733
 Notes payable - other                                -    131,812
 Current maturities of long-term debt             7,097          -
 Potential investor deposits                          -    115,650
     Total Current Liabilities                3,806,017  2,951,210

LONG-TERM DEBT, less current maturities          12,447        -

STOCKHOLDERS' DEFICIT
 Common stock                                    10,494      9,987
 Additional paid-in capital                   1,596,566  1,247,463
 Equity adjustment for foreign currency translation
                                                  2,592        156
 Paid-in capital -- stock options             1,566,000         -
 Accumulated deficit                         (2,520,616)(1,929,823)
                                                655,036   (672,217)
 Deferred compensation expense               (1,266,000)         -
     Total Stockholders' Deficit              (610,964)  (672,217)
 

                                              $3,207,500 $2,278,993






The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated
                      financial statements.

                  INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                
                 CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF LOSS
                                
        Periods Ended July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                
                                
                                             
                                                   1996        1995
REVENUE
 Sales - product                            $17,099,074     $4,254,278
 Sales - business kits                        1,321,925        312,110
 Sales - administrative fees                    658,497        285,854
     Total Revenue                           19,079,496      4,852,242

COST OF SALES
Commissions                                    8,372,285     2,580,177
Product                                        5,624,063     1,912,157
Business kits                                  1,249,711       358,549
Other                                            711,476        67,454
     Total Cost of Sales                      15,957,535     4,918,337

      GROSS INCOME (LOSS)                      3,121,961       (66,095)

SELLING AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES            3,712,754     1,863,728


NET  LOSS                                  $   (590,793)   $(1,929,823)


NET  LOSS  PER SHARE                       $       (0.08)  $     (2.20)

Weighted  average  number of common shares  outstanding
                                                7,495,387   877,446
                                             















The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated
                      financial statements.
                          INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                        
                CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF STOCKHOLDERS' DEFICIT
                                        
                Periods Ended July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995

                 Common Stock; $.001 par value, 25,000,000 shares authorized
                                                            Adjustment for
                                            Additional Paid Foreign Currency
                        Shares      Amount     in Capital   Translation

Initial issuance of common stock
                        1,615 $         16   $   111,475 $        -

Stock split (500 for 1)
                       805,885        8,059        (8,059)        -

Issuance of common stock
                      114,475        1,145        803,320         -

Conversion of notes payable to
 common stock
                       76,700          767        340,727         -

Adjustment for foreign currency tran
                           -            -              -        156

Net Loss
                           -            -              -          -

Balance as of December 31, 1995
                      998,675        9,987      1,247,463       156

Issuance of common stock
                       50,679          507        349,103         -

Issuance of common stock options
                           -            -              -          -

Stock split (10 for 1)
                    9,444,186           -              -          -

Adjustment for foreign currency tran-
 slation                   -            -              -       2,436

Net Loss
                           -            -              -          -

Balance as of July 31, 1996
                   10,493,540 $      10,949 $    1,596,566 $   2,592




                        Paid-in                         Deferred         Total
                        Capital        Accumulated   Compensation Stockholders'
                        Stock Options      Deficit       Expensed      Deficit

Initial issuance of common stock
                        $          $            $              $       111,491

Stock split (500 for 1)
                              -            -              -              -

Issuance of common stock
                              -            -              -            804,465

Conversion of notes payable to
 common stock
                             -            -              -             341,494

Adjustment for foreign currency tran
                             -            -              -                 156

Net Loss
                             -       (1,929,823)                   (1,929,823)

Balance as of Decemer 31, 1995
                            -        (1,929,823)                    ($672,217)

Issuance of common stock
                            -            -              -             349,610

Issuance of common stock options
                     1,566,000           -        (1,266,000)         300,000

Stock split (10 for 1)
                            -            -              -              -

Adjustment for foreign currency tran-
 slation                    -            -              -               2,436

Net Loss
                          -           (590,793)        -            (590,793)

Balance as of July 31, 1996
                 $  1,566,000  $   (2,520,616)   $(1,266,000)     $ (610,694)

 
                                        
                                        
  The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
                                   statements.
                        INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                      
                    CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
                                      
              Periods Ended July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                      

                                                        1996        1995
  CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES
    Net loss                                      $(590,793)  $(1,929,823)
    Adjustments to reconcile net loss to net cash
      provided by operating activities:
       Depreciation                                   78,290      36,411
       Amortization                                  121,334      54,252
       Adjustments for foreign currency translation    2,436         156
       Issuance of stock bonus                       100,870           -
       Other                                         (1,260)           -
       Common stock options                          300,000           -
    Changes in Assets and Liabilities:
       Inventory                                    (139,822)   (283,371)
       Receivables                                  (286,359)   (204,582)
       Deposits and prepaid expenses                (170,233)    (80,857)
       Payables                                      360,379     697,897
       Deferred revenue                               56,539     408,375
       Accrued expenses                              944,593   1,321,137
  NET CASH PROVIDED BY OPERATING ACTIVITIES          775,974      19,595
  
  CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES
    Purchases  of  property  and  equipment         (286,558)   (270,353)
    Purchases  of  certificates  of  deposit         (60,265)    (10,000)
  NET  CASH  USED  IN  INVESTING ACTIVITIES         (346,823)   (280,353)
       
  CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES
    Proceeds  from the sale of stock and conversion of notes payable
                                                         -      1,257,450
    Proceeds  from  notes payable and long term  debt 22,775      170,045
    Payments  on  notes payable and long term  debt (158,776)      (4,500)
    Deposits from potential investors                    -        115,650
    Refunds to investors                           (115,650)           -
    Payments for organization and start-up  costs   (36,446)     (905,776)
    Payments for downline development costs         (78,322)     (160,046)
    Cash overdraft                                 (242,606)      242,606
  NET CASH PROVIDED BY (USED IN) FINANCING ACTIVITIES
                                                   (609,025)      715,429
  
  NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AT END OF PERIOD (179,874)      454,671
  Cash at Beginning of Period                        454,671           -
  
  CASH AT END OF PERIOD                           $  274,797  $  454,671
  
  The  accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial
  statements.
                     INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                   
              NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                   
                  July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                   

NOTE 1 -THE COMPANY AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

        THE  COMPANY  -  International Heritage, Inc. (the "Company")
        was  incorporated in North Carolina on April 28, 1995.  It  is
        principally  engaged  in direct sales in  forty-eight  states.
        The  Company is dedicated to helping Independent Retail  Sales
        Representatives  ("IRSR") build retail sales organizations  to
        sell jewelry and collectibles.

        The  Company  has  a  wholly  owned subsidiary,  International
        Heritage  of Canada, Inc., that was incorporated in Canada  on
        July  26,  1995,  and  is  engaged in the  same  direct  sales
        business  in  Canada as the parent Company.  The  accounts  of
        the  Canadian Company have been consolidated with the  Company
        and  all  significant intercompany accounts  and  transactions
        have been eliminated.

        USE  OF  ESTIMATES - The preparation of consolidated financial
        statements in conformity  with generally accepted  accounting
        principles requires  management  to   make   estimates   and
        assumptions that  affect  certain  reported   amounts   and
        disclosures.  Accordingly, actual results could  differ  from
        those estimates.

        RECLASSIFICATIONS  -  Certain   1995   amounts   have   been
        reclassified to conform to current year presentation.   None
        of these reclassifications  effected  the  net   loss   or
        stockholders' deficit.
     
        CERTIFICATES OF DEPOSIT - The Company was required to  deposit
        $70,000  in  1996  and  $10,000 in 1995 into  certificates  of
        deposit  in  order  to obtain a merchant credit  card  account
        with  a  financial institution.  The certificates  of  deposit
        are  required to be maintained with this financial institution
        until they mature on various dates in 1996 and 1997.

        INVENTORY   -  Inventory,  consisting  primarily   of   retail
        business  center  kits, is stated at  the  lower  of  cost  or
        market,  with  cost  determined under the  first-in  first-out
        (FIFO) method.

        PROPERTY  AND EQUIPMENT -  Depreciation expense is  calculated
        on   the  declining  balance  methods  over  useful  lives  as
        follows:
                                          Estimated Useful Life
            Computer software                5 years
            Computer hardware                5 years
            Office furniture and equipment   7 years
            Vehicle                          5 years
            Leasehold improvements           7 years

        Expenditures   for  repairs  and maintenance  are  charged  to
        expense   as  incurred.   The  cost  of  major  renewals   and
        betterments  are  capitalized  and  depreciated   over   their
        estimated  useful lives.  Upon disposition of  equipment,  the
        respective  assets and accumulated depreciation  accounts  are
        relieved  and  any  related  gain  or  loss  is  reflected  in
        operations.

                    INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                   
              NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                   
                  July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                   

NOTE 1 -THE COMPANY AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

        ORGANIZATION AND START-UP COSTS - The  organization costs  are
        being   amortized    on    a straight-line basis  over  5
        years (accumulated amortization  was $120,914 as of July 31, 1996
        and $33,898 as of December 31,1995).   The start-up  costs are
        being  amortized  on  a straight-line basis over  15 years
        (accumulated amortization was $16,679  as of July 31, 1996
        and $7,017 as of December 31, 1995).

        DOWNLINE  DEVELOPMENT COSTS - In order to facilitate a  larger
        retail  sales organization in a short time period, the Company
        allowed  certain  representatives  to  develop  retail   sales
        organizations with products paid for by the Company,  not  the
        representative.  Accordingly, the costs associated  with  this
        downline  development  have  been capitalized  and  are  being
        amortized  on  a straight-line basis over 5 years (accumulated
        amortization  was $37,994 as of July 31, 1996 and  $13,337  as
        of December 31, 1995).

        REVENUE  RECOGNITION AND DEFERRED REVENUE -   The  Independent
        Retail  Sales Representative may join the Company at no  cost,
        but  must  purchase a $75 professional retail business  career
        kit  (at  cost), which then allows them to sell the  Company's
        products.   When  the  IRSR  sells a product  under  a  direct
        product  purchase, the sale is recognized when the product  is
        shipped.   When the IRSR makes a down payment of $250  towards
        the   purchase   of   product  and  signs   a   representative
        application   and  retailed  business  agreement    with   the
        Company,  they can directly market the Company's products  and
        build a retail sales organization.  This agreement allows  the
        buyer  to  cancel the agreement without penalty or  obligation
        within  60  days  and receive a complete refund  ("cash-out").
        The  Company defers a portion of all other revenue at the time
        of  receipt and after the 60 day time period has elapsed,  the
        remaining  revenue is recognized.  Effective July 1996,  those
        representatives  who enter with more than one business  center
        are  not  eligible to cash-out.  The Company provides  a  100%
        satisfaction  guarantee  on  all  products  and   sales   aids
        purchased by representatives.  The Company recognizes  revenue
        based  on a $25 administrative fee and the out-of-pocket  cost
        when  a representative first joins the company and every  year
        thereafter.  Commissions  are earned  by  the  representatives
        based  on  sales  volume levels.  The  Company  does  not  pay
        commissions  on  representative  sponsorships,  it  only  pays
        commissions on product sales. The Company does not accrue  for
        commissions  on  an  incremental basis  between  sales  volume
        levels.

        ADVERTISING COSTS - Advertising costs are expensed  the  first
        time the advertising takes place.

        PER SHARE AMOUNTS - Per share amounts are calculated based  on
        the  weighted  average  number of common  shares  outstanding.
        Common  stock options and contingent shares are excluded  from
        the calculation due to their anti-dilutive nature.

                     INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                   
              NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                   
                  July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                   

NOTE   1   -   THE  COMPANY  AND  SIGNIFICANT  ACCOUNTING  POLICIES
                (CONTINUED)
        INVESTOR  DEPOSITS  -  Subsequent to the initial  issuance  of
        common  stock,  the Company  received $804,465 of  funds  from
        potential  investors.  These securities may have been  offered
        and  sold  without  having been registered  or  exempted  from
        registration  under  applicable federal and  state  securities
        laws.   Thus, the Company offered to rescind such prior  sales
        to  all investors who deposited monies during the period  from
        August  to December 1995 by refunding the price paid  for  the
        securities  plus interest.  The Company has recorded  deposits
        made  by  investors  who  rejected  the  Rescission  Offer  as
        equity.   Three  investors, for a total of  $15,000,  accepted
        the  Rescission  Offer  and  received  a  refund.   All  other
        investors  rejected the Rescission Offer.    Any investor  who
        rejected   the  Rescission  Offer  received  shares   of   the
        Company's  stock at the rate of one pre-split share  for  each
        $10 investment.

        EMPLOYEE  STOCK OPTIONS - The Company recognizes  compensation
        cost   for   nonvariable  employee  stock   options   at   the
        differences  between what the stock has sold  for  to  outside
        investors  ($1.00 per share post-split) less  the  amount,  if
        any,  the  employee is required to pay.  The method used  here
        is  the  intrinsic value based method (which approximates  the
        fair  value  based method) and is expensed over the  estimated
        period of service (estimated to be three years).

        STATEMENT  OF  CASH  FLOWS - For purposes  of  reporting  cash
        flows,  cash includes cash on hand and amounts due from banks.
        Cash  paid for interest was $20,872 for the period ended  July
        31,  1996  and $2,833 for the period ended December 31,  1995.
        Cash  received for interest was $266 for the period ended July
        31,  1996.   Noncash financing activities in 1996 include  the
        exchange   of  approximately  $250,000  of  common  stock   as
        prepayment for services to be provided by a related  party  in
        connection  with  a planned stock offering,  and  $100,870  of
        common  stock  for services provided by the President  of  the
        Company.   Noncash financing activities in 1995  included  the
        exchange  of  approximately  $522,485  of  common  stock   for
        services   provided  by  individuals  who  assisted   in   the
        organization  of  the  Company.  As  of  July  31,  1996,  the
        Company  had U.S. bank balances of $746,745 of which  $546,745
        was  in excess of the insured limits prescribed by the Federal
        Deposit Insurance Corporation.

NOTE 2 -    DEVELOPMENT STAGE OPERATIONS

        The  Company  was  formed April 28, 1995 and  from  that  date
        until  June  21,  1995,  the  Company's  operations  consisted
        primarily  of  raising  capital, developing  and  implementing
        business policies and administrative activities.  During  this
        development   stage,   the   Company  incurred   approximately
        $225,000 of losses.




                     INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                   
              NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                   
                  July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                   

NOTE 3 -    OPERATING STATUS

        As  noted  in  the  accompanying  financial  statements,  the  Company
        incurred a net loss of $2,520,616 for the period April 28, 1995  (date
        of  inception)  to  July 31, 1996.  In addition,  the  Company  has  a
        stockholders' deficit of $610,964 as of July 31, 1996, and its current
        liabilities  exceed its current assets by $2,045,731 as  of  July  31,
        1996.   This situation has been caused by the nature of the  Company's
        business  (deferred  revenue and commissions are the  highest  at  the
        start  of  a  business center) and the fact that  it  has  taken  more
        capital  to establish an international direct sales Company  than  was
        originally  anticipated.   The  Company is  currently  completing  the
        required  filings that will allow them to issue common  stock  in  the
        Company  to  raise  additional  capital.   The  Company's  ability  to
        continue  as  a going concern is dependent on its ability to  maintain
        future   profitability   through  cutting   corporate   expenses,   to
        successfully obtain the above mentioned capital and the change in  the
        cash-out policy (see Note 1).  The financial statements do not include
        any  adjustments that might be necessary should the Company be  unable
        to continue as a going concern.

NOTE 4 -    ORGANIZATION AND START-UP COSTS

        The   Company   was  incorporated  April  28,  1995  and  accordingly,
        significant  organization  and start-up  expenses  were  incurred.   A
        portion  of  these costs were paid to or exchanged for  services  from
        various  parties.  The components of organization and  start-up  costs
        are detailed below:
                                                          1996      1995
         Consulting services and expense
           reimbursements charged by Mayflower
           Holdings, Inc. (a stockholder)               $104,065  $104,065
         Exchange of common stock for services
           provided                                      434,985   434,985
         Legal and accounting fees                       277,595   242,668
         Consulting fees                                  50,806    50,806
         Exchange of common stock for services
          provided Mayflower Holdings, Inc. and
          Eagle  Harbor  Holdings  (a  stockholder)       38,500    38,500
         Video  production                                32,412    32,412
         Trademarks                                        3,860     2,340
                                                         _______   _______
                                                         942,223   905,776
         Less accumulated amortization                   137,593    40,915
                                                        $804,630  $864,861
     
     
     
     
     
                       INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                     
                NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                     
                    July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
    

    NOTE 5 -NOTES PAYABLE AND LETTERS OF CREDIT
    
    The  Company  has  loans of $10,000 outstanding to  two  stockholders.
    These  notes  have interest rates of 12% and mature in one  year.   In
    order  to  provide the note holders with a rate of return commensurate
    with  risk of their investment, the notes were discounted 10% and  the
    discount is being amortized over the 12 month period.
    
    The Company has a $10,000 letter of credit with a bank for the benefit
    of a telephone company.  The related note bears interest at a variable
    rate (8.25% as of July 3, 1996) and matures on July 3, 1997.  The note
    is  secured by certain cash balances maintained with  the  bank.   The
    Company has a $7,300 (10,000 Canadian dollars) letter of credit with a
    bank  for the benefit of the Canadian Ministry of Housing, Recreations
    and Consumer Services.  The related note bears interest at one percent
    above  the  prime rate (prime rate was 8.25% as of July 31, 1996)  and
    matures  on  September 17, 1996.  The note is secured by a certificate
    of  deposit  with the bank.  No amounts are outstanding  under  either
    letter as of July 31, 1996.
    
    NOTE 6 -LONG-TERM DEBT
    
    At  July  31,  1996,  the Company was indebted on  long-term  debt  as
    follows:
    
    $22,775 note payable to Ford Motor Credit Company,
    bearing interest at 12.5%.  Principle and interest are
    payable in monthly    installments of $762.  The note is
    secured  by  a  vehicle  and  matures  January  4,  1999.     $19,544
    Less    current    maturities                                   7,097
                                                                  $12,447
    Interest expense was $1,544 in 1996.
    
NOTE 7 -    PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES
    
    The   Company  has  a  Federal  income  tax  net  operating  loss   of
    approximately $590,000 in 1996 and $1,930,000 in 1995.  As  a  result,
    no provision for income taxes has been recorded.  As of July 31, 1996,
    The  Company has a net operating loss carryforward for Federal  income
    tax  purposes  of  approximately $2,520,000.  The net  operating  loss
    carryforward  is  available to offset against future  Federal  taxable
    income and expires in 2010 and 2011.





                         INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                       
                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                       
                      July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995



    NOTE 8 -COMMON STOCK AND STOCK OPTIONS

             On  July  1,  1996, the shareholders approved an  increase  in
             authorized shares of common stock to 25,000,000 shares  and  a
             ten   for  one  common  stock  split.   Concurrent  with  this
             amendment,  the par value of common stock changed  from  $0.01
             to  $0.001  per share.  The Company has granted the  following
             stock options, all of which remain exercisable as of July  31,
             1996:


                                   Optioned    Exercise     Expiration
        Optionee                     Shares    Price        Date

        1995 Board of Directors   5% of issued
                                  and outstanding
                                  shares    $   0.002        May 4, 1998
        1996 Board of Directors   800,000   $   0.20     January 1, 1999
        1996 Management           500,000   $   0.20     January 1, 1999
        Advisory Board            600,000   $   1.00     January 1, 1999
        Consultants               700,000   $   1.50     January 1, 1999
        Legal Service Providers   325,000   $   1.00       June 30, 1999
        Others                    250,000   $   0.20     January 1, 1999
    
    
             The  Company has promised 462,000 shares of stock as employee
             stock bonuses and salesman incentives.  The share issuance is
             contingent on the employee or salesman remaining employed  by
             or  in  good  standing with the Company through December  31,
             1996 with an award date of January 1, 1997.
    
             Under  an  employment  contract and based  on  the  Company's
             achievement of certain revenue goals,  the President  of  the
             Company is entitled to receive stock incentives in the amount
             of  2%  of  issued and outstanding shares as of December  31,
             1996  and 3% as of each year ended December 31, 1997  through
             2000.
    
    NOTE 9  -  LEASE COMMITMENTS

             On  November 11, 1995, the Company entered into a  lease  for
             its  U.S.  office  space under  an operating lease  agreement
             expiring on November 30, 2002.  The rental rate will escalate
             each  November based on changes in the consumer price  index,
             not  to  exceed a five percent annual increase.  On September
             1,  1995,  the Company entered into a lease for its  Canadian
             operations  under an operating lease expiring on  August  31,
             1996.   The  lease automatically renews for six month  terms.
             Certain  office  equipment is being  leased  under  operating
             leases  expiring in 1999.  Certain other office equipment  is
             being  leased on a month-to-month basis.  The combined future
             minimum lease payments are as follows:



                       INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                     
                NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                     
                    July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                     


    NOTE 9  -  LEASE COMMITMENTS (CONTINUED)

                Year Ending July 31,                           Amount
                        1997                               $  23,867
                        1998                                  20,087
                        1999                                  19,034
                        2000                                  11,492
                        2001                                  11,094
                        Thereafter                           177,501
                                                           $ 263,075

             Rent expense was $90,679 in 1996 and $94,197 in 1995.
             
    NOTE 10 -  ECONOMIC DEPENDENCY

             A  material  amount of the Company's jewelry and collectibles
             products  are acquired from one supplier, the loss  of  which
             may  have  an  adverse effect on the Company.   The  supplier
             accounted  for  approximately 100% of  the  jewelry  products
             purchased as of July 31, 1996.  The Company has recently made
             an arrangement with a stockholder to provide jewelry products
             which  are  being  tested for future sales by  the  Company's
             representatives.

             A material amount of the Company's inventory is acquired from
             three principal suppliers, the loss of which may also have an
             adverse effect on the Company.  These suppliers accounted for
             approximately 100% of the inventory on hand at July 31, 1996.
     
    NOTE 11 -  SEGMENT REPORTING OF FOREIGN OPERATIONS

                                             United
                                             States    Canada  Consolidated
             Period ended December 31, 1995:

             Total revenue                $4,808,711    $43,531  $4,852,242
                
             Operating loss              $(1,822,500)  $(80,715)$(1,903,215)
             General corporate expenses                             (18,546)
                   Interest expense                                  (8,062)
                   Net loss                                     $(1,929,823)

             Identifiable assets         $1,459,098    $ 506,481 $1,965,579
             Corporate assets                                    $  313,414
             Total assets as of
                   December 31, 1995                             $2,278,993



                       INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                     
                NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                     
                    July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                     

    NOTE 11 -  SEGMENT REPORTING OF FOREIGN OPERATIONS (CONTINUED)

                                       United
                                       States      Canada  Consolidated
             Period ended July 31, 1996:
          Total   revenue         $19,003,642     $75,854  $19,079,496
                
          Operating loss          $ (184,881)   $(169,901) $ (354,782)
          General corporate expenses                         (216,348)
          Interest expense                                    (19,663)
                  Net loss                                 $ (590,793)

          Identifiable assets      $2,599,814   $ 431,131  $3,030,945
          Corporate assets                                    176,555
                   Total assets as of
                      July 31, 1996                        $3,207,500

             Operating loss is total revenue less operating expenses.  In
             computing  operating  loss, none of the following  items has
             been  added or deducted: general corporate expenses, interest
             expense  and  income  tax expense.  Identifiable  assets are
             those  assets  of  the Company that are identified  with the
             operations in each geographic area.  Corporate assets are
             principally certain  cash  accounts and  certificates  of
             deposit.

    NOTE 12 -  RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

             The  Company  paid  for  or  received  services  and  expense
             reimbursements   (excluding  those   costs   capitalized   as
             described in Note 4) totaling approximately $12,530  in  1996
             and  $258,000  in  1995  from  Mayflower  Holdings,  Inc.,  a
             stockholder  which is owned by the President of the  Company,
             for  services  related to the start-up  and  other  operating
             expenses of the Company.  As of July 31, 1996, the amount due
             from Mayflower Holdings, Inc. was $25,000.

             The  Company  subleases office space to  Mayflower  Holdings,
             Inc.  on a month-to-month basis.  Rental income is $3,500  in
             1996.

             In  1996, the Company issued Mayflower Holdings, Inc.  25,000
             shares   of common stock ($10 a share pre-split) in  exchange
             for prepaid consulting services.

             In  1996, the President of the Company received 10,087 shares
             of  common stock ($10 a share pre-split) for having  attained
             certain  corporate revenue goals pursuant to  his  employment
             contract.

             
                         INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                       
                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                                       
                      July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
                                       

    
    NOTE 12 -  RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS (CONTINUED)
    
             The  Company entered into an agreement with the President and
             a  relative to create a sales training handbook for its sales
             representatives.  The agreement calls for a lump sum  payment
             of  $10,000  to the authors as well as a $4 per book  royalty
             for  all books sold to the Company. $52,000 was paid to these
             individuals in 1996 and $30,600 was paid in 1995.  No amounts
             were due at July 31, 1996.
 
             The  Company has an agreement with a stockholder  to  provide
             the Company with a promotional line of merchandise.
 
             As of July 31, 1996, two stockholders owe the Company $25,537
             and $17,100, respectively, for employee advances.
 
             The  Company owed $131,812 outstanding to the President and to
             Mayflower  Holdings, Inc. as of December 31, 1995.  The notes
             were paid off in February 1996.
    
             In 1995, the Company received services totaling 45,000 shares
             of  common  stock  ($10 a share pre-split)  in  exchange  for
             services  related  to  the start-up and organization  of  the
             Canadian subsidiary.
 
    NOTE 13 -  SUBSEQUENT EVENT
 
             In  August 1996, Mayflower Holdings, Inc. loaned the  Company
             $178,500,  with  interest at 12%.  The  note  is  payable  in
             monthly  installments of $50,000 beginning  in  October  1996
             with  a final payment including interest due in January 1997.
             The note is secured by the assets of the Company.
             
                        INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
 
       SCHEDULES OF CONSOLIDATED SELLING AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES
    
             Periods Ended July 31, 1996 and December 31, 1995
    

                                                   1996           1995

    Salaries and employee benefits           $1,923,308     $  526,613
    Rent                                         90,679         94,197
    Seminars and meeting room                    18,623          3,893
    Telephone                                   114,067         94,919
    Insurance                                    29,526         12,280
    Office supplies                              60,651         24,035
    Postage and shipping                        205,824        107,367
    Repair and maintenance                        1,051          3,705
    Dues  and subscriptions                       1,258          1,041
    Fulfillment fees                             56,887         53,297
    Taxes and licenses                            8,362          1,343
    Advertising                                  15,702         17,444
    Sales presentations and promotions          114,486        248,815
    Printing and binders                         51,580        120,700
    Royalties                                    52,000         17,500
    Meals and entertainment                      52,024          2,968
    Travel                                      191,068        113,046
    Professional and consulting fees            177,113        128,145
    Directors fees                                4,000          -
    Computer services                            48,174         20,661
    Temporary and contract help                  98,476         18,716
    Depreciation                                 78,290         36,411
    Amortization                                121,334         54,252
    Product development                          20,000              -
    Conference calls                             16,760              -
    Bank fees and charges                        18,303         25,656
    Recruiting and training                       2,229          4,950
    Business development                         59,456         96,182
    Bad debt                                     11,595              -
    Fax and mobile communications                33,329         23,929
    Interest                                     19,663          8,062
    Charitable contributions                     11,000              -
    Exchange loss                                 2,745            737
    Other                                         3,191          2,864

                                              $3,712,754   $ 1,863,728







                  INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                
  INDEX TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET AND PRO FORMA INFORMATION
                                
                          July 31, 1996
                                
       
                                                      PAGE(S)

INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT                          F-19

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Consolidated Balance Sheet                            F-20 & F-21

Notes to Consolidated Balance Sheet                   F-22 & F-29

        
                       INDEPENDENT AUDITORS' REPORT
        
        
        
        To the Shareholders of
        International Heritage, Inc.
        Raleigh, North Carolina
        
        We  have  audited the accompanying historical  consolidated
        balance  sheet of International Heritage, Inc. as  of  July
        31,   1996.    The  consolidated  balance  sheet   is   the
        responsibility   of   the   management   of   International
        Heritage, Inc.  Our responsibility is to express an opinion
        on the consolidated balance sheet on our audit.
        
        We   conducted  our  audit  in  accordance  with  generally
        accepted auditing standards.   Those standards require that
        we   plan  and  perform  the  audit  to  obtain  reasonable
        assurance about whether the consolidated balance  sheet  is
        free   of   material  misstatement.   An   audit   includes
        examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts
        and  disclosures  in the statement of financial  condition.
        An  audit also includes assessing the accounting principles
        used  and significant estimates made by management, as well
        as  evaluating the overall statement of financial condition
        presentation.   We  believe  that  our  audit  provides   a
        reasonable basis for our opinion.
        
        In  our opinion, the historical consolidated balance  sheet
        referred   to  above  presents  fairly,  in  all   material
        respects, the financial position of International Heritage,
        Inc.  as  of  July  31, 1996 in conformity  with  generally
        accepted accounting principles.
        
        We  have  also audited the pro forma adjustments reflecting
        the  transactions described in Note 13 and the  application
        of  those  adjustments  to the historical  amounts  in  the
        accompanying  July  31, 1996, consolidated  balance  sheet.
        Our audit was made in accordance with standards established
        by  the  American Institute of Certified Public Accountants
        and, accordingly, included such procedures as we considered
        necessary in the circumstances.  The objective of this  pro
        forma  consolidated  balance sheet  is  to  show  what  the
        significant effects on the historical financial information
        might  have been had the transactions described in Note  13
        been consummated as of July 31, 1996.
        
        In our opinion, the July 31, 1996 pro forma amounts reflect
        the  proper application of the pro forma adjustments to the
        historical  consolidated  balance  sheet  amounts  in   the
        aforementioned pro forma consolidated balance sheet.
        
        
        /s/ EILERS, JONES, BROWN & McLEOD, CPAs, PA
       
        August 24, 1996
	  Raleigh, North Carolina





                  INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                
                   CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                
                          July 31, 1996
                                

                             ASSETS
                                
                                                 Pro Forma
                                                 Adjustment
                                          1996   (See Note 13)     Pro Forma
CURRENT ASSETS
 Cash                                   $ 274,797   $3,514,842     $3,789,639
 Certificates of deposit                   70,265           -          70,265
 Inventory                                423,193           -         423,193
 Employee and stockholder advances         54,093           -          54,093
 Due from representatives, less allowance
     for doubtful accounts of $11,595     347,177           -         347,177
 Sales tax refunds due                     44,214           -          44,214
 Other receivables                         45,457           -          45,457
 Deposits                                 122,179           -         122,179
 Prepaid expenses                         378,911           -         378,911
     Total Current Assets               1,760,286   3,514,842       5,275,128

PROPERTY AND EQUIPMENT - AT COST
 Construction in process                   18,876          -           18,876
 Computer software                        108,081          -          108,081
 Computer hardware                        260,121          -          260,121
 Office furniture and equipment           132,511          -          132,511
 Vehicle                                   32,775          -           32,775
 Leasehold improvements                     4,547          -            4,547
                                          556,911          -          556,911
 Less accumulated depreciation and amortization
                                          114,701           -         114,701
     Net Property and Equipment           442,210          -          442,210

ORGANIZATIONAL AND START-UP COSTS, NET    804,630          -          804,630

DOWNLINE DEVELOPMENT COSTS, NET           200,374          -          200,374


                                      $3,207,500     $3,514,842    $6,722,342






The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated
                         balance sheet.
                                
                  INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                
                   CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                
                          July 31, 1996
                                

         LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT)
                                

                                              Pro Forma
                                              Adjustments
                                       1996  (See Note 13)  Pro Forma
CURRENT LIABILITIES
 Trade accounts payable              $ 909,877   $      -   $ 909,877
 Payable to representatives            148,399          -     148,399
 Deferred revenue                      464,914   (327,000)    137,914
 Sales tax payable                      41,703          -      41,703
 Accrued payroll and payroll taxes     218,640          -     218,640
 Accrued commissions                 1,542,132          -   1,542,132
 Accrued earned-out product            413,255          -     413,255
 Accrued award trip                     50,000          -      50,000
 Notes payable from stockholders        10,000          -      10,000
 Current maturities of long-term debt    7,097          -       7,097
Total Current Liabilities            3,806,017   (327,000)  3,479,017

LONG-TERM  DEBT,  less  current  maturities
                                        12,447       -          12,447

STOCKHOLDERS' EQUITY (DEFICIT)
 Common stock                           10,494          -       10,494
 Additional paid-in capital          1,596,566          -    1,596,566
 Equity  adjustment  for  foreign currency  translation
                                         2,592           -       2,592
 Paid-in capital--stock options      1,566,000           -   1,566,000
 Retained earnings (deficit)        (2,520,616)   3,841,842  1,321,226
                                       655,036    3,841,842  4,496,878
     Deferred  compensation expense (1,266,000)         -   (1,266,000)
       Total  Stockholders' Equity (Deficit)
                                      (610,964)   3,841,842  3,230,878

                                    $3,207,500   $3,514,842 $6,722,342






The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated
                         balance sheet.
                                
                  INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                
               NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                
                          July 31, 1996
                                

NOTE 1 -THE COMPANY AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

        THE  COMPANY  -  International Heritage, Inc. (the  "Company")
        was  incorporated in North Carolina on April 28, 1995.  It  is
        principally  engaged  in direct sales in  forty-eight  states.
        The  Company is dedicated to helping Independent Retail  Sales
        Representatives  ("IRSR") build retail sales organizations  to
        sell jewelry and collectibles.

        The  Company  has  a  wholly  owned subsidiary,  International
        Heritage  of Canada, Inc., that was incorporated in Canada  on
        July  26,  1995,  and  is  engaged in the  same  direct  sales
        business  in  Canada as the parent Company.  The  accounts  of
        the  Canadian Company have been consolidated with the  Company
        and  all  significant intercompany accounts  and  transactions
        have been eliminated.

        USE  OF  ESTIMATES - The preparation of consolidated financial
        statements  in conformity  with generally accepted  accounting
        principles   requires  management  to   make   estimates   and
        assumptions   that   affect  certain  reported   amounts   and
        disclosures.   Accordingly, actual results could  differ  from
        those estimates.
                                      
        CERTIFICATES OF DEPOSIT - The Company was required to  deposit
        $70,000  in  1996  and  $10,000 in 1995 into  certificates  of
        deposit  in  order  to obtain a merchant credit  card  account
        with  a  financial institution.  The certificates  of  deposit
        are  required to be maintained with this financial institution
        until they mature on various dates in 1996 and 1997.

        INVENTORY   -  Inventory,  consisting  primarily   of   retail
        business  center  kits, is stated at  the  lower  of  cost  or
        market,  with  cost  determined under the  first-in  first-out
        (FIFO) method.

        PROPERTY  AND EQUIPMENT -  Depreciation expense is  calculated
        on   the  declining  balance  methods  over  useful  lives  as
        follows:
                                          Estimated Useful Life
            Computer software                5 years
            Computer  hardware               5 years
            Office furniture and equipment   7 years
            Vehicle                          5 years
            Leasehold improvements           7 years
            
        Expenditures  for  repairs  and  maintenance  are  charged  to
        expense   as  incurred.   The  cost  of  major  renewals   and
        betterments  are  capitalized  and  depreciated   over   their
        estimated  useful lives.  Upon disposition of  equipment,  the
        respective  assets and accumulated depreciation  accounts  are
        relieved  and  any  related  gain  or  loss  is  reflected  in
        operations.

        ORGANIZATION AND START-UP COSTS - The organization  costs  are
        being   amortized on   a  straight-line  basis  over 5 years
        (accumulated amortization  was $120,914  as   of July  31,  1996).
        The start-up costs  are  being amortized  on   a straight-line
        basis over 15 years (accumulated amortization  was $16,679   as
        of July 31, 1996).

                      INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                   
                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                   
                             July 31, 1996
                                   

NOTE 1 -THE COMPANY AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

        DOWNLINE  DEVELOPMENT COSTS - In order to facilitate a  larger
        retail  sales organization in a short time period, the Company
        allowed  certain  representatives  to  develop  retail   sales
        organizations  with product paid for by the Company,  not  the
        representative.  Accordingly, the costs associated  with  this
        downline  development  have  been capitalized  and  are  being
        amortized  on  a straight-line basis over 5 years (accumulated
        amortization was $37,994 as of July 31, 1996).

        REVENUE  RECOGNITION AND DEFERRED REVENUE -   The  Independent
        Retail  Sales Representative may join the Company at no  cost,
        but  must  purchase a $75 professional retail business  career
        kit  (at  cost), which then allows them to sell the  Company's
        products.   When  the  IRSR  sells a product  under  a  direct
        product  purchase, the sale is recognized when the product  is
        shipped.   When the IRSR makes a down payment of $250  towards
        the  purchase  of  product and signs  an  agreement  with  the
        Company,  they can directly market the Company's products  and
        build a retail sales organization.  This agreement allows  the
        buyer  to  cancel the agreement without penalty or  obligation
        within  60  days  and receive a complete refund  ("cash-out").
        The  Company defers a portion of all other revenue at the time
        of  receipt and after the 60 day time period has elapsed,  the
        remaining  revenue is recognized. Effective July  1996,  those
        representatives  who enter with more than one business  center
        are  not  eligible to cash-out.  The Company provides  a  100%
        satisfaction  guarantee  on  all  products  and   sales   aids
        purchased   by   representatiaves.   The  Company   recognizes
        revenue  based  on a $25 administrative fee  and  the  out-of-
        pocket cost when a representative first joins the Company  and
        every   year  thereafter.   Commissions  are  earned  by   the
        representatives  based on sales volume  levels.   The  Company
        does  not  accrue  for  commissions on  an  incremental  basis
        between  sales  volume  levels.   The  Company  does  not  pay
        commissions  on  representatiave sponsorships,  it  only  pays
        commissions on product sales.

        INVESTOR  DEPOSITS  -  Subsequent to the initial  issuance  of
        common  stock,  the Company  received $804,465 of  funds  from
        potential  investors.  These securities may have been  offered
        and  sold  without  having been registered  or  exempted  from
        registration  under  applicable federal and  state  securities
        laws.   Thus, the Company offered to rescind such prior  sales
        to  all investors who deposited monies during the period  from
        August  to December 1995 by refunding the price paid  for  the
        securities  plus interest.  The Company has recorded  deposits
        made  by  investors  who  rejected  the  Rescission  Offer  as
        equity.   Three  investors, for a total of  $15,000,  accepted
        the  Rescission  Offer  and  received  a  refund.   All  other
        investors  rejected the Rescission Offer.    Any investor  who
        rejected   the  Rescission  Offer  received  shares   of   the
        Company's  stock at the rate of one pre-split share  for  each
        $10 investment.

        EMPLOYEE  STOCK OPTIONS - The Company recognizes  compensation
        cost   for   nonvariable  employee  stock   options   at   the
        differences  between what the stock has sold  for  to  outside
        investors  ($1.00 per share post-split) less  the  amount,  if
        any,  the  employee is required to pay.  The method used  here
        is the intrinsic value based method (which
                     INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                   
                  NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                   
                             July 31, 1996
                                   

NOTE 1 -THE COMPANY AND SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (CONTINUED)

        approximates  the  fair value based method) and is  expensed  over
        the estimated period of service (estimated to be three years).

NOTE 2 -    OPERATING STATUS

        As  noted  in the accompanying historical balance  sheet,  the
        Company  incurred  a  net loss of $2,520,616  for  the  period
        April  28,  1995  (date of inception) to July  31,  1996.   In
        addition, the Company has a stockholders' deficit of  $610,964
        as  of  July 31, 1996, and its current liabilities exceed  its
        current  assets  by  $2,045,731 as of  July  31,  1996.   This
        situation  has  been  caused by the nature  of  the  Company's
        business (deferred revenue and commissions are the highest  at
        the  start  of  a business center) and the fact  that  it  has
        taken  more capital to establish an international direct sales
        Company  than  was  originally anticipated.   The  Company  is
        currently  completing  the required filings  that  will  allow
        them  to issue common stock in the Company to raise additional
        capital.   The  Company's  ability  to  continue  as  a  going
        concern  is  dependent  on  its  ability  to  maintain  future
        profitability   through   cutting   corporate   expenses,   to
        successfully  obtain  the  above  mentioned  capital  and  the
        change  in  the  cash-out policy (see Note 1).  The  financial
        statements  do  not  include  any adjustments  that  might  be
        necessary should the Company be unable to continue as a  going
        concern.
                                   
NOTE 3 -    ORGANIZATION AND START-UP COSTS

        The  Company  was incorporated April 28, 1995 and accordingly,
        significant organization and start-up expenses were  incurred.
        A  portion  of  these  costs were paid  to  or  exchanged  for
        services   from   various   parties.    The   components    of
        organization and start-up costs are detailed below:
                                                    
      Consulting services and expense reimbursements
       charged by Mayflower Holdings, Inc. (a stockholder)     $104,065
      Exchange of common stock for services provided            434,985
      Legal  and accounting fees                                277,595
      Consulting fees                                            50,806
      Exchange  of  common stock for services provided Mayflower
      Holdings, Inc. and Eagle  Harbor  Holdings  (a  stockholder)
                                                                38,500
      Video production                                          32,412
      Trademarks                                                 3,860
                                                               942,223
Less  accumulated amortization                                 137,593
                                                        $      804,630

                       INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                     
                    NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                     
                               July 31, 1996
                                     

NOTE 4 -    NOTES PAYABLE AND LETTERS OF CREDIT
        
        The   Company  has  loans  of  $10,000  outstanding   to   two
        stockholders.   These notes have interest  rates  of  12%  and
        mature  in  one  year.  In order to provide the  note  holders
        with  a  rate  of  return  commensurate  with  risk  of  their
        investment, the notes were discounted 10% and the discount  is
        being amortized over the 12 month period.

        The  Company has a $10,000 letter of credit with  a  bank  for
        the  benefit of a telephone company.  The related  note  bears
        interest  at  a variable rate (8.25% as of July 3,  1996)  and
        matures on July 3, 1997.  The note is secured by certain  cash
        balances  maintained with the bank.  The Company has a  $7,300
        (Canadian  dollars)  letter of credit  with  a  bank  for  the
        benefit  of the Canadian Ministry of Housing, Recreations  and
        Consumer  Services.  The related note bears  interest  at  one
        percent  above  the prime rate (prime rate was 8.25% as of July
        31,  1996)  and matures on September 17, 1996.   The  note  is
        secured  by  a  certificate  of deposit  with  the  bank.   No
        amounts are outstanding as of July 31, 1996.

NOTE 5 -    LONG-TERM DEBT

        At  July 31, 1996, the Company was indebted on long-term  debt
        as follows:

        $22,775 note payable to Ford Motor Credit Company,
        bearing interest at 12.5%.  Principle and interest are
        payable in monthly installments of  $762.   The note is
        secured by a vehicle and matures January 4,1999.
                                                          $   19,544

        Less current maturities                                7,097
                                                          $   12,447

NOTE 6 -    COMMON STOCK AND STOCK OPTIONS

        On  July  1,  1996, the shareholders approved an  increase  in
        authorized shares of common stock to 25,000,000 shares  and  a
        ten   for  one  common  stock  split.   Concurrent  with  this
        amendment,  the par value of common stock changed  from  $0.01
        to  $0.001  per share.  The Company has granted the  following
        stock options, all of which remain exercisable as of July  31,
        1996:


                       INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                     
                    NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                     
                               July 31, 1996
                                     
                                     
            
NOTE 6 -    COMMON STOCK AND STOCK OPTIONS (CONTINUED)
        
                                   Optioned    Exercise     Expiration
        Optionee                     Shares    Price        Date

        1995 Board of Directors   5% of issued
                                  and outstanding
                                  shares    $   0.002        May 4, 1998
        1996 Board of Directors   800,000   $   0.20     January 1, 1999
        1996 Management           500,000   $   0.20     January 1, 1999
        Advisory Board            600,000   $   1.00     January 1, 1999
        Consultants               700,000   $   1.50     January 1, 1999
        Legal Service Providers   325,000   $   1.00       June 30, 1999
        Others                    250,000   $   0.20     January 1, 1999

        The  Company has promised 462,000 shares of stock as  employee
        stock bonuses and salesman incentives.  The share issuance  is
        contingent  on the employee or salesman remaining employed  by
        or  in  good  standing with the Company through  December  31,
        1996 with an award date of January 1, 1997.

        Under  an  employment  contract and  based  on  the  Company's
        achievement  of certain revenue goals,  the President  of  the
        Company is entitled to receive stock incentives in the  amount
        of  2%  of   issued and outstanding shares as of December  31,
        1996  and  3% as of each year ended December 31, 1997  through
        2000.

NOTE 7 -    PROVISION FOR INCOME TAXES
        
        The  Company  has a Federal income tax net operating  loss  of
        approximately  $590,000 in 1996.  As a  result,  no  provision
        for  income taxes has been recorded.  As of July 31, 1996, the
        Company  has  a  net operating loss carryforward  for  Federal
        income  tax  purposes  of approximately $2,520,000.   The  net
        operating  loss  carryforward is available to  offset  against
        future Federal taxable income and expires in 2010 and 2011.

 NOTE 8  -  LEASE COMMITMENTS

        On  November  11, 1995, the Company entered into a  lease  for
        its  U.S.  office  space under  an operating  lease  agreement
        expiring  on November 30, 2002.  The rental rate will escalate
        each  November based on changes in the consumer  price  index,
        not  to  exceed a five percent annual increase.  On  September
        1,  1995,  the  Company entered into a lease for its  Canadian
        operations  under an operating lease expiring  on  August  31,
        1996.   The  lease automatically renews for six  month  terms.
        Certain  office  equipment  is being  leased  under  operating
        leases  expiring in 1999.  Certain other office  equipment  is
        being  leased on a month-to-month basis.  The combined  future
        minimum lease payments are as follows:

                       INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                     
                    NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET

                            July 31, 1996



 NOTE 8  -  LEASE COMMITMENTS (CONTINUED)

        Year Ending July 31                                Amount
                 1997                                  $    23,867
                 1998                                       20,087
                 1999                                       19,034
                 2000                                       11,492
                 2001                                       11,094
                 Thereafter                                177,501
                                                     $     263,075

NOTE 9 -    ECONOMIC DEPENDENCY

        A  material  amount of the Company's jewelry and  collectibles
        products  are  acquired from one supplier, the loss  of  which
        may  have  an  adverse  effect on the Company.   The  supplier
        accounted  for  approximately 100%  of  the  jewelry  products
        purchased as of July 31, 1996.  The Company has recently  made
        an  arrangement with a stockholder to provide jewelry products
        which  are  being  tested for future sales  by  the  Company's
        representatives.

        A  material amount of the Company's inventory is acquired from
        three principal suppliers, the loss of which may also have  an
        adverse effect on the Company.  These suppliers accounted  for
        approximately 100% of the inventory on hand at July 31, 1996.

NOTE 10 -   SEGMENT REPORTING OF FOREIGN OPERATIONS

        Segment information by geographic area as of July 31, 1996  is
        as follows:

                                         United
                                         States    Canada   Consolidated
            Identifiable assets      $2,599,814   $431,131  $3,030,945
            Corporate assets                                   176,555
               Total Assets                                 $3,207,500

        Identifiable assets are those assets of the Company  that  are
        identified  with  the  operations  in  each  geographic  area.
        Corporate  assets  are principally certain cash  accounts  and
        certificates of deposit.

NOTE 11 -   RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

        The   Company  paid  for  or  received  services  and  expense
        reimbursements   (excluding   those   costs   capitalized   as
        described  in Note 4) totaling approximately $12,530  in  1996
        and  $258,000  in  1995  from  Mayflower  Holdings,  Inc.,   a
        stockholder which is owned by the
        
                        INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                     
                    NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
                                     
                                July 31, 1996
                                     

NOTE 11 -   RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS (CONTINUED)

President  of the Company, for services related to the start-up and  other
operating  expenses of the Company.   As  of  July  31, 1996, the amount
due from Mayflower Holdings, Inc. was $25,000.

The Company subleases office space to Mayflower Holdings, Inc. on a month-
to-month basis.  Rental income is $3,500 in 1996.


In  1996,  the  Company issued Mayflower Holdings, Inc. 25,000  shares  of
common  stock  ($10 a share pre-split) in exchange for prepaid  consulting
services.
            
In  1996,  the President of the Company received 10,087 shares  of  common
stock  ($10  a  share  pre-split) for having  attained  certain  corporate
revenue goals pursuant to his employment contract.

The Company entered into an agreement with the President and a relative to
create  a  sales  training  handbook for its sales  representatives.   The
agreement calls for a lump sum payment of $10,000 to the authors  as  well
as  a  $4 per book royalty for all books sold to the Company. $52,000  was
paid to these individuals in 1996.  No amounts were due at July 31, 1996.

The  Company  has an agreement with a stockholder to provide  the  Company
with a promotional line of merchandise.

As of July 31, 1996, two stockholders owe the Company $25,537 and $17,100,
respectively, for employee advances.

The  Company  owed  $131,812 outstanding to the President  and  to
Mayflower Holdings, Inc. as of December 31, 1995.  The notes  were
paid off in February 1996.

In 1995, the Company received services totaling 45,000 shares of common
stock ($10 a share pre-split) in exchange for services related to the
start-up and organization of the Canadian subsidiary.

NOTE 12 - SUBSEQUENT EVENT

In August 1996, Mayflower Holdings, Inc. loaned the Company $178,500, with
interest at 12%. The note is payable in monthly installments of $50,000
beginning in October 1996 with a final payment including interest due in
January 1997. The note is secured by the assets of the Company.



               INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
     
           NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEET
     
                    July 31, 1996
     

NOTE 13 - PRO FORMA ADJUSTMENT

Effective July 1, 1996, the Board of Directors of the Company approved a
change in policy such that those representatives who enter with more than
one business center will not be eligible to cash-out. This change has
been implemented prospectively and is designed to encourage potential
representatives to weigh their options carefully prior to entering the
business. If this adjustment had been effective since the Company's
inception (April 28, 1995) through July 31, 1996, it would have provided
$3,841,842 in additional income, $3,514,842 in additional cash, $327,000
reduction in deferred revenue and would have changed the retained earnings
to a positive $1,321,226. The attached pro forma balance sheet has been
adjusted for this change as if it was made on April 28, 1995.
































No person has been authorized in connection with the offering made hereby
to give any information or to make any representation not contained in this
Prospectus and, if given or made, such information or representation must
not be relied upon as having been authorized by the Company.  This
Prospectus does not constitute an offer to sell or a solicitation of any
offer to buy any of the securities offered hereby to any person or by
anyone in any jurisdiction in which it is unlawful to make such offer or
solicitation.  Neither the delivery of this Prospectus nor any sale made
hereunder shall, under any circumstances, create any implication that the
information contained herein is correct as of any date subsequent to the
date hereof.
                                               
                        Table of Contents

                                                             Page
Prospectus Summary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2
Risk Factors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5
Use of Proceeds. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Dividend Policy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Dilution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Capitalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Selected Financial Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
Management's Discussion and
     Analysis of Financial Condition
     and Results of Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
Business . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
Prior Sales of Securities. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
Related Party Transactions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
Options Grants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial
     Owners and Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Litigation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
Description of Common Stock. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Shares Eligible for Future Sale. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Plan of Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
Legal Matters. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Experts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Aditional Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Financial Statements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .F-1

                                                                     

     Until September 30, 1996 (25 days after the date of this Prospectus),
all dealers effecting transactions in the Common Stock offered hereby,
whether or not participating in this distribution, may be required to
deliver a Prospectus.



                         2,500,000 Shares




                   International Heritage, Inc

                           Common Stock
                         $.001 Par Value


                                                  

                            PROSPECTUS

                                                  



















                        SEPTEMBER 5, 1996





                              PART II

              INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 13.  Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution

The following table sets forth the costs and expenses, other than
underwriting discounts and commissions, payable by the Company in
connection with the sale of Common Stock being registered.  All amounts are
estimates except the SEC registration fee.


                                               Minimum        Maximum
                                                  
SEC registration fee                           $1,724*        $8,620*
Printing and engraving                         25,000*        35,000*
Legal Fees and expenses                        50,000*        50,000*
Accounting fees and expenses                   35,000*        35,000*
Blue Sky fees and expenses                     13,785*        13,785*
Transfer Agent and Registrar fees               5,000*         5,000*
Miscellaneous                                   5,000*        10,000*
           Total                             $135,509*      $157,405*
         
                       
*Estimated cost

Item 14.  Indemnification of Directors and Officers

    The Registrant's Amended Articles of Incorporation and Bylaws include
provisions to (i) eliminate personal liability of its directors for
monetary damages resulting from breaches of their fiduciary duty to the
fullest extent permitted by Section 55-8-30(e) of the North Carolina
Business Corporation Act and (ii) require the Registrant to indemnify its
directors and officers to the fullest extent permitted by Sections 55-8-50
thorough 55-8-58 of the North Carolina Business Corporation Act. Pursuant
to Section 55-8-51 and 55-8-57 of the North Carolina Business Corporation
Act, a corporation generally has the power to indemnify its present and
former directors, officers, employees and agents against expenses incurred
by them in connection with any suit to which they are, or are threatened to
be made, a party by reason of their serving in such positions so long as
they acted in good faith and in a manner they reasonably believed to be in,
or not opposed to, the best interest of the Company, and with respect to
criminal action, they had no reasonable cause to believe their conduct was
unlawful.  The Registrant believes that these provisions are necessary to
attract and retain qualified persons as directors and officers.  These
provisions do not eliminate the directors' duty of care, and, in
appropriate circumstances, equitable remedies such as injunctive or other
forms of non-monetary relief will remain available under the North Carolina
Business Corporation Act. In addition, each director will continue to be
subject to liability for breach of the director's duty of loyalty to the
Registrant, for acts or omissions not in good faith or involving
intentional misconduct or knowing violations of law.  For acts or omissions
that the director believes to be contrary to the best interests of the
Registrant or its shareholders, for any transaction from which the director
derived an improper personal benefit, for acts or omissions involving a
reckless disregard for the director's duty to the Registrant or its
shareholders when the director was aware or should have been aware of a
risk of serious injury to the Registrant or its shareholders, for acts or
omissions that constitute an unexcused pattern of inattention that amounts
to an abdication of the director's duty to the Registrant or its
shareholders, for improper transactions between the director and the
Registrant and for improper distributions to shareholders and loans to
directors and officers.  Theses provisions do not affect a director's
responsibilities under any other laws, such as the federal securities laws.

    The Registrant's Amended Articles of Incorporation require the
Registrant to indemnify its directors and officers against expenses,
judgements, fines, settlements and other amounts actually and reasonably
incurred in connection with the defense of, or for advice concerning, any
claim asserted or proceeding brought against him by reason of his or her
being or having been a director or officer of the Registrant, provided that
such person acted in good faith and in a manner such person reasonably
believed to be in or not opposed to the best interest of the Registrant
and, with respect to any criminal proceeding, had no reasonable caused to
believe his or her conduct was unlawful.

    At present, there is no pending litigation or proceeding involving a
director or officer of the Registrant as to which indemnification in being
sought nor is the Registrant aware of any threatened litigation that may
result in claims for indemnification by any officer or director.

    The Underwriting Agreement filed as Exhibit 1.1 to this Registration
Statement provides for indemnification by the Underwriters of the
Registrant and its directors and officers, and by the Registrant of the
Underwriters, for certain liability arising under the Securities Act of
1933, as amended (the "Securities Act") or otherwise.

Item 15.  Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities

    Since April 28, 1995 (inception) the Company has sold and issued the
following securities:

Generally

    Fred B. Smith & Associates purchased on April 31, 1995, 50 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $12,600, which was
converted to 2,520 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 275,200
shares.

    Eagle Harbor Holdings purchased on May 4, 1995, 175 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $20,000, which was converted
to 4,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 915,000 shares.
Eagle Harbor Holdings assigned all right, title and interest in these
shares to Omega Leasing Services on April 4,1996.

    Mayflower Holdings, Inc. purchased on May 4, 1995, 175 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $20,000, which was converted
to 4,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  These shares were
split 500:1 for a total of 91,500 shares.  February 16, 1996, Stanley H.
Van Etten, President, received 10,087 shares pursuant to the terms of his
employment contract with the Company and assigned these shares to Mayflower
Holdings, Inc. who gifted these shares to several individuals.  March 11,
1996, the Board of Directors gave Stanley H. Van Etten a bonus of 25,000
shares as prepayment for services in connection with a corporate
capitalization plan.  Mr. Van Etten assigned these shares to Mayflower
Holdings, Inc., who in turn gifted the shares to several individuals.
Subsequent to the gifting of several shares and the 10:1 stock split,
Mayflower Holdings, Inc. owns a total of 885,280 shares.

    Claude W. Savage purchased on May 4, 1995, 175 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $20,000, of which $10,000 was
converted to 2,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest and the
remaining $10,000 was repaid June 4, 1995.  The non-converted shares were
split 500:1 for a total of 89,500 shares.  Mr. Savage gifted certain shares
to his children.  Subsequent to the gifting of shares and the 10:1 stock
split, Mr. Savage owns a total of 797,000 shares.

    Wendell and Jodie C. Elliott purchased on May 9, 1995, 20 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $10,000, which was
converted to 2,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 for a total of 12,000 shares.  The
Elliotts purchased an additional 1,650 shares.  Subsequent to the 10:1
stock split, the Elliotts own a total of 136,500 shares.

    Dean Elliott purchased on May 10, 1995, 5 shares of common stock and a
convertible note in the amount of $2,500, which was converted to 500 shares
on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares were
split 500:1 for a total of 3,000 shares.  Mr. Elliott purchased and
additional 400 shares on August 18, 1995 for $4,000.  Mr. Elliott purchased
an additional 350 shares.  Subsequent to the 10:1 stock split, Mr. Elliott
owns a total of 37,500 shares.

    Larry Ellis purchased on May 10, 1995, 20 shares of common stock and a
convertible note in the amount of $12,500, which was converted to 2,500
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 for a total of 12,500 shares.  Mr. Ellis purchased on June
8, 1995, an additional 5,000 shares for $5,000.  Mr. Ellis purchased on
July 21, 1995, an additional 7,500 shares for $7,500.  Subsequent to the
10:1 stock split, Mr. Ellis owns 250,000 shares.

    Calvin Michael Ward purchased on May 22, 1995, 25 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted
to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 135,000 shares.

    Geni and Michael D. Batchelor purchased on May 22, 1995, 10 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was
converted to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000
shares.

    John Buhrman purchased on May 23, 1995, 10 shares of common stock and a
convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted to 1,000
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    Jimmie and Portia Knowles purchased on May 24, 1995, 45 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $19,450, which was
converted to 3,890 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  Mr. and
Mrs. Knowles purchased an additional 80 shares of common stock and a
convertible note in the amount of $50,000 on July 19, 1995.  The note was
repaid October 6, 1995.  The non-converted shares were split 500:1 and
again 10:1 for a total of 663,900 shares.

    To The Top We Go, Inc. received on May 24, 1995, 25 shares in exchange
for services rendered to the Company.  These shares were split 500:1 for a
total of 12,500 shares.  To The Top We Go, Inc. Gifted some of its shares
to others.  Subsequent to the gifts and the 10:1 stock split, To The Top We
Go, Inc. owns 110,000 shares.

    Jeffrey L. Hooks received on May 24, 1995, 25 shares in exchange for
services rendered to the Company.  These shares were split 500:1 and again
10:1 for a total of 125,000 shares.

    Dr. Martin R. and Nina R. Runion purchased on May 24, 1995, 45 shares
of common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $20,000, which was
converted to 4,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 265,000
shares.

    Harold W. and Linda W. Queen purchased on May 26, 1995, 10 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was
converted to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000
shares.

    Steven E. and Nanette N. Taitt purchased on May 28, 1995, 5 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500, which was
converted to 500 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-convertible shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of
30,000 shares.

    George B. Bain purchased on May 30, 1995, 10 shares of common stock and
a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted to 1,000
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    Bobby W. and Shirley E. Bristow purchased on May 30, 1995, 10 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was
converted to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000
shares.

    Joseph F. Spoon purchased on May 30, 1995, 5 shares of common stock and
a convertible note in the amount of $2,500, which was converted to 500
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-convertible shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 30,000 shares.

    Ronald W. Cassese purchased on May 31, 1995, 25 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted to
1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 135,000 shares.

    Nick Collias purchased on May 31, 1995, 30 shares of common stock and a
convertible note in the amount of $15,000, which was converted to 3,000
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 180,000 shares.

    Barry Ackel purchased on June 1, 1995, 100 shares of common stock and a
convertible note in the amount of $12,500, which was converted to 2,520
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 525,200 shares.

    Jack F. Weatherly purchased on June 2, 1995, 10 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted to
1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The shares were split
500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    Leisure Time Rentals & Management purchased on June 3, 1995, 10 shares
of common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was
converted to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000
shares.

    Dennis E. And Linda C. Brackett purchased on June 5, 1995, 10 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was
converted to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000
shares.

    Braxton Merritt purchased on June 5, 1995, 40 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $20,000, which was converted to
4,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 240,000 shares.

    Dwight and Jennifer Hallman received on June 6, 1995, 25 shares of
common stock in exchange for Mr. Hallman's services to the Company in
establishing their computer system for the tracking of sales and
computation of compensation to Independent Retail Sales Representatives and
other services in the start-up of the Company.  These shares were split
500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 125,000 shares.
    
    William A. Blackman purchased on June 7, 1995, 5 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500.  On July 20, 1995, Mr.
Blackman purchased an additional 5 shares of common stock and a convertible
note in the amount of $3,750.  Both notes were converted to 1,250 shares on
August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares were split
500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 62,500 shares.

    Diane B. James purchased on June 7, 1995, 10 shares of common stock and
a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which will be repaid from
offering proceeds.  These share were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total
of 50,000 shares.

    Harold Scott Jr. purchased on June 7, 1995, 10 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000.  Mr. Scott accepted the
Company's offer of rescission and was repaid the amount of his investment
plus interest at the legal rate September 29, 1995.

    Paul Hoyle purchased on June 8, 1995, 10 shares of common stock and a
convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted to 1,000
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    Jimmy Aymond purchased on June 8, 1995, 50 shares of common stock and a
convertible note in the amount of $12,600, which was converted to 2,520
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 275,200 shares.

    Faiger M. Blackwell purchased on June 9, 1995, 5 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500, which was converted to 500
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 30,000 shares.

    Clotilda Rodgers purchased on June 9, 1995, 10 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted to
1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    Michael Francis Canning, Jr. purchased on June 12, 1995, 5 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500, which was
converted to 500 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 for a total of 3,000 shares.  Mr.
Canning purchased on August 10, 1995, an additional 800 shares for $8,000.
The shares were split 10:1 for a total of 38,000 shares.

    Neva Marie Canning purchased on June 12, 1995, 10 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted
to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    Kenneth W. and Helen W. Wilkinson purchased on June 12, 1995, 10 shares
of common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was
converted to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000
shares.

    Kay Wood Disman purchased on June 13, 1995, 20 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $10,000, which was converted to
2,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 120,000 shares.

    Rodger Dale Gadd received on June 13, 1995, 10 shares of common stock
in exchange for downline development services.  These shares were split
500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 50,000 shares.

    John F. and Margaret H. Hudson purchased on June 13, 1995, 5 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500, which was
converted to 500 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 30,000
shares.

    Edgar Collins purchased on June 14, 1995, 15 shares of common stock and
a convertible note in the amount of $7,500, which was converted to 1,500
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 for a total of 9,000 shares.  Mr. Collins gifted 3,000
shares to others.  Subsequent to the gift and a 10:1 stock split, Mr.
Collins owns a total of 60,000 shares.

    Clinton S. (Jr.) and Lavada P. Forbis received on June 14, 1995, 5
shares of common stock in exchange for downline development services
rendered.  These shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of
25,000 shares.

    Conda McCall purchased on June 14, 1995, 10 shares of common stock and
a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted to 1,000
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    Derrick L. Rodgers purchased on June 14, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $47,500, which was converted
to 9,500 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 for a total of 59,500 shares.  Mr. Rogers gifted
2,200 shares to others.  Subsequent to the gift and a 10:1 stock split, Mr.
Rodgers owns 577,000 shares.

    James Ronnie and Sylvia M. Sherrill purchased on June 14, 1995, 5
shares of common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500,
which was converted to 500 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.
The non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of
30,000 shares.

    Christopher S. Brackett purchased on June 15, 1995, 10 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted
to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    Stephen E. Brackett purchased on June 15, 1995, 10 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted
to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    James Pinkney and Nina Lou Blackwelder purchased on June 15, 1995, 5
shares of common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500,
which was converted to 500 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.
The non-converted shares were split 500:1 for a total of 3,000 shares.  On
November 17, 1995, the Blackwelders purchased an additional 3,150 shares of
common stock for $1,500.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
61,500 shares.

    Gold Raven, Inc. received on June 16, 1995, 10 shares of common stock
in exchange for downline development services.  These shares were split
500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 50,000 shares.

    Eddie L. Mattox Irrevocable Trust purchased on June 16, 1995, 10 shares
of common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was
converted to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The
non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000
shares.

    Sunrise Pro Glass purchased on June 16, 1995, 5 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500, which was converted to 500
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 for a total of 3,000 shares.  The shares were issued to
the individual shareholders who invested through Sunrise Pro Glass to
include:  David Andrew and Kathy June Holt, Gary Lee and Valerie Bisby,
Darin and Jennifer Brewer, Donald and Patricia Snyder, and Brian D. and
Debra Jean Waite, who subsequent to the 10:1 stock split, own 6,000 shares,
respectively.

    Robert L. Chalmers purchased on June 20, 1995, 10 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted
to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000 shares.

    Kathleen Illian received on June 20, 1995, 5,000 shares of common stock
in exchange for establishing a group health insurance program for Company
IRSRs. These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 50,000 shares.

    Samuel W. (III) and Carolyn Johnston purchased on June 21, 1995, 10
shares of common stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000,
which was converted to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.
The non-converted shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of
60,000 shares.

    Egbert Louis Ming purchased on June 22, 1995, 10 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted to
1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 for a total of 6,000.  Mr. Ming purchased on August
22, 1995, an additional 1,000 shares for $10,000.  Mr. Ming purchased on
October 5, 1995, and additional 1,500 shares for $15,000.  These shares
were split 10:1 for a total of 85,000 shares.

    Joanne and Ray Norville purchased on June 22, 1995, 5 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500, which was converted
to 500 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 30,000 shares.

    Larry J. Rickard purchased on June 22, 1995, 5 shares of common stock
and a convertible note in the amount of $2,500, which was converted to 500
shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted shares
were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 30,000 shares.

    Evonne B. Eckenroth purchased on July 3, 1995, 60 shares of the common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $12,600, which was paid July
23, 1996.  These shares were split 500:1 for a total of 30,000 shares.  On
August 18, 1995, Ms. Eckenroth purchased an addition 5,000 shares for
$1,300.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 300,000 shares.

    Richard C. Hungate purchased on August 10, 1995, 18,750 shares of
common stock and a convertible note in an amount of $12,600, which was
repaid March 27, 1996.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 187,500
shares.

    Kathryn C. Crist received on August 10, 1995, 1,250 shares of common
stock as a gift of shares from Richard C. Hungate.  These shares were split
10:1 for a total of 12,500 shares.

    John Bell Neil purchased on August 10, 1995, 300 shares of common stock
for $3,000.  These share were split 10:1 for a total of 3,000 shares.

    Richard Blaine Smith purchased on August 11, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    David Lane Tillman purchased on August 11, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Terry D. Phillips purchased on August 14, 1995, 10 shares of common
stock and a convertible note in the amount of $5,000, which was converted
to 1,000 shares on August 15, 1995, including interest.  The non-converted
shares were split 500:1 and again 10:1 for a total of 60,000.

    Kathi Jean Jones purchased on August 15, 1995, 70 shares of common
stock for $700.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 700 shares.

    Bobby Wren Bristow purchased on August 18, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    James R. Reynolds received on August 18, 1995, 4,000 shares of common
stock as a gift from Evonne Eckenroth.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 40,000 shares.

    Thomas Suber (Jr.) and Betty Jean Cromer purchased on August 21, 1995,
200 shares of common stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 2,000 shares.

    Claude W. Savage, Jr. purchased on August 22, 1995, 5,000 shares of
common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
50,000 shares.

    Frank S. Hart purchased on August 24, 1995, 200 shares of common stock
for $2,000.  Mr. Hart purchased on November 9, 1995, 300 shares of common
stock for $3,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 5,000
shares.

    Frank Wesley Alexander purchased on August 28, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    John H. Giles purchased on August 28, 1995, 100 shares of common stock
for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000 shares.

    Edmund Eugene and Rosemarie Jaqueline Dreyer purchased on August 31,
1995, 500 shares of common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1
for a total of 5,000 shares.

    Russell Hugh Caston purchased on September 5, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Charles Campbell Edmondson, Jr. purchased on September 7, 1995, 1,000
shares of common stock for $10,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 10,000 shares.

    Paul Bourque purchased on September 20, 1995, 600 shares of common
stock for $6,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 6,000
shares.

    Rhyon Caldwell received on September 20, 1995, 5,000 shares of common
stock in exchange for working with International Heritage of Canada, Inc.
to establish a Canadian office for the Company and to assist in developing
IRSRs in the various provinces of Canada in which the Company conducts
business.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 50,000 shares.

    James Law received on September 20, 1995, 5,000 shares of common stock
in exchange for working with International Heritage of Canada, Inc. to
establish a Canadian office for the Company and to assist in developing
IRSRs in the various provinces of Canada in which the Company conducts
business.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 50,000 shares.

    Felix Li received on September 20, 1995, 5,000 shares of common stock
in exchange for working with International Heritage of Canada, Inc. to
establish a Canadian office for the Company and to assist in developing
IRSRs in the various provinces of Canada in which the Company conducts
business.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 50,000 shares.

    Paradise Investments, Ltd. received on September 20, 1995, 25,000
shares of common stock in exchange for working with International Heritage
of Canada, Inc. to establish a Canadian office for the Company and to
assist in developing IRSRs in the various provinces of Canada in which the
Company conducts business.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
250,000 shares.

    Lawrence A. Canning purchased on September 20, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Neva Marie Canning and Freeland R. Goldammer purchased on September 20,
1995, 500 shares of common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1
for a total of 5,000 shares.

    Kathleen Canning Leone purchased on September 20, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Frederick Michael Kennel purchased on September 22, 1995, 300 shares of
common stock for $3,000.  Mr. Kennel purchased an additional 400 shares of
stock for $4,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 7,000
shares.

    Hans Fiedrich Kennel purchased on September 22, 1995, 300 shares of
common stock for $3,000.  Mr. Kennel purchased an additional 400 shares for
$4,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 7,000 shares.

    Aubry L. and Brenda Sue Vincent purchased on September 25, 1995, 500
shares of common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 5,000 shares.

    Ray Paul Boudreaux purchased on September 27, 1995, 50 shares of common
stock for $500.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 500 shares.

    The Dujay Living Trust of 1994 purchased on September 28, 1995, 500
shares of common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 5,000 shares.

    McCleldon Van and Judith Ann Evans purchased on September 28, 1995, 300
shares of common stock for $3,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 3,000 shares.

    Charles C. Geoffroy purchased on September 28, 1995, 250 shares of
common stock for $2,500.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,500
shares.

    Eric J. Geoffroy purchased on September 28, 1995, 250 shares of common
stock for $2,500.  Mr. Geoffroy purchased an additional 200 shares of
common stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 4,500
shares.

    Lloyd Geoffroy, Jr. purchased on September 28, 1995, 300 shares of
common stock for $3,000.  Mr. Geoffroy purchased an additional 300 shares
of common stock for $3,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
6,000 shares.

    Robin K. Savage McDaniel purchased on September 28, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  Ms. McDaniel received 4,900 shares of common
stock as a gift from Claude W. Savage.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 50,000 shares.

    Tracy E. Sabates purchased on September 28, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock for $1,000.  Ms. Sabates received 4,900 shares of common stock as a
gift from Claude W. Savage.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
50,000 shares.

    Charles Edward and Patricia Joanne White purchased on September 28,
1995, 500 shares of common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1
for a total of 5,000 shares.

    Kathleen Helen Caldwell purchased on September 29, 1995, 200 shares of
common stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    Melissa Aine Caldwell purchased on September 29, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Muriel Kathleen Caldwell purchased on September 29, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Charles Barron Elrod purchased on September 29, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Bruce W. Jones purchased on September 29, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 5,000
shares.

    Melvola J. Mitchell purchased on September 29, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    David Matthew Canning purchased on October 2, 1995, 500 shares of
common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 5,000
shares.

    Douglas L. Simms purchased on October 2, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  Mr. Simms purchased an additional 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 4,000
shares.

    Rhett M. Starnes purchased on October 2, 1995, 150 shares of common
stock for $1,500.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,500
shares.

    Darrell Murray Olinger purchased on October 3, 1995, 1,000, shares of
common stock for $10,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
10,000 shares.

    Norbert Louis Ming purchased on October 5, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  Mr. Ming purchased an additional 2,000 shares for
$20,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 25,000 shares.
Douglas Rene Schexnayder purchased on October 5, 1995, 320 shares of common
stock for $3,200.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 3,200
shares.

    Harold Walter Queen purchased on October 6, 1995, 110 shares of common
stock for $1,100.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,110
shares.

    Rebecca G. Rushing purchased on October 6, 1995, 50 shares of common
stock for $500.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 500 shares.

    Patricia S. Schnell purchased on October 9, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 5,000
shares.

    Joyce M. Hatley received on October 10, 1995, 400 shares of common
stock as a gift from Derrick L. Rodgers.  These shares were split 10:1 for
a total of 4,000 shares.

    William A. Myers, III received on October 10, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock as a gift from Derrick L. Rodgers.  These shares were split
10:1 for a total of 1,000 shares.

    Ann M. Smoak received on October 10, 1995, 400 shares of common stock
as a gift from Derrick L. Rodgers.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 4,000 shares.

    Betty Jean H. Taylor purchased on October 10, 1995, 200 shares of
common stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    Elizabeth M. Oakley purchased on October 11, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    Enrico Victor Cannella purchased on October 16, 1995, 1,000 shares of
common stock for $10,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
10,000 shares.

    Dorothy Grant Eaddy purchased on October 16, 1995, 300 shares of common
stock for $3,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 3,000
shares.

    Patricia A. Gore purchased on October 18, 1995, 30 shares of common
stock for $300.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 300 shares.

    Marc Homer Mitchell purchased on October 18, 1995, 270 shares of common
stock for $2,700.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,700
shares.

    Luke J. Carline purchased on October 19, 1995, 60 shares of common
stock for $600.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 600 shares.

    Daivd R. Fanning purchased on October 23, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  Mr. Fanning purchased an additional 300 shares of common
stock for $3,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 5,000
shares.

    Carl Richard Fears purchased on October 23, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  Mr. Fears purchased an additional 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 7,000
shares.

    John Vales purchased on October 23, 1995, 20 shares of common stock for
$200.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 200 shares.

    The Vales Revocable Living Trust purchased on October 23, 1995, 2,500
shares of common stock for $25,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 25,000 shares.

    Bobbie Lee Baer purchased on October 24, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    Rachel H. Clark purchased on October 24, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  Ms. Clark accepted the Company's offer of rescission
dated December 15, 1995, and was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on January 30, 1996.

    Caroll Joseph Boutte, III purchased on October 25, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Joe Oscar Matthews purchased on October 25, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Byron Keith and Elizabeth McKellips purchased on October 25, 1995, 300
shares of common stock for $3,000.  Mr. and Mrs. McKellips accepted the
Company's offer of rescission dated December 15, 1995, and were repaid the
amount of their investment plus interest at the legal rate on January 30,
1996.

    Barbara M. Romero purchased on October 25, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Helen G. Rourk purchased on October 25, 1995, 400 shares of common
stock for $4,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 4,000
shares.

    Philip Andre Martin purchased on October 26, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  Mr. Martin purchased an additional 500 shares for
$5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 10,000 shares.

    Terry Lane Neustrom purchased on October 26, 1995, 1,000 shares of
common stock for $10,000.  Mr. Neustrom accepted the Company's offer of
rescission dated December 15, 1995, and was repaid the amount of his
investment plus interest at the legal rate on January 30, 1996.

    Sherry T. Macklin purchased on October 27, 1995, 115 shares of common
stock for $1,150.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,150
shares.

    Lawrence L. and Dorothy Smith purchased on October 27, 1995, 500 shares
of common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
5,000 shares.

    William Larry Duncan purchased on October 30, 1995, 50 shares of common
stock for $500.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 500 shares.

    Fannie Lenora Ross purchased on October 30, 1995, 800 shares of common
stock for $8,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 8,000
shares.

    Karen Elaine Sardinas purchased on October 30, 1995, 200 shares of
common stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    Henry C. and Winifred E. Turner purchased on October 30, 1995, 400
shares of common stock for $4,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 4,000 shares.

    Mollie M. Stewart purchased on November 2, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    Mollie M. Stewart and Pharoh H. Smith purchased on November 2, 1995,
100 shares of common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 1,000 shares.

    Bradley Reed Thomas, Jr. received on November 8, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock in exchange for pulling cable and wire network for computer in
home office.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000 shares.

    Joel Daniel Thomas received on November 8, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock in exchange for pulling cable and wire network for computer in home
office.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000 shares.

    Scot Rolland Thomas received on November 8, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock in exchange for pulling cable and wire network for computer in home
office.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000 shares.

    Ronald Franklin Hopson purchased on November 10, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  Mr. Hopson purchased an additional 100 shares for
$1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000 shares.

    David P. Accurso purchased on November 13, 1995, 250 shares of common
stock for $2,500.  Mr. Accurso purchased an additional 750 shares for
$7,500.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 10,000 shares.

    Jerome Victor and Sandra Yvonne Leventhal purchased on November 13,
1995, 500 shares of common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1
for a total of 5,000 shares.

    James LeRoyal Lucas purchased on November 13, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  Mr. Lucas purchased an additional 50 shares for
$500.00.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,500 shares.

    McDaniel Air Conditioning and Heating, Inc. purchased on November 13,
1995, 2,500 shares of common stock for $25,000.  These shares were split
10:1 for a total of 25,000 shares.

    David and Leslie Newman Family Trust purchased on November 13, 1995,
500 shares of common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 5,000 shares.

    Kenneth R. Hines purchased on November 14, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    Houston Allen Little purchased on November 17, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Charles T. and Rachel E. Moore purchased on November 17, 1995, 100
shares of common stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 1,000 shares.

    Charles Otto and Deborah Ann Reynolds purchased on November 17, 1995,
50 shares of common stock for $500.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 500 shares.

    Eric O. and Trina C. Skidmore purchased on November 17, 1995, 400
shares of common stock for $4,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 4,000 shares.

    Jerry Dean and Dorthea P. Staley purchased on November 17, 1995, 500
shares of common stock for $5,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a
total of 5,000 shares.

    Homer R. and Ruth J. Fears purchased on November 23, 1995, 200 shares
of common stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
2,000 shares.

    Bobby Dean Sidden purchased on November 27, 1995, 1,000 shares of
common stock for $10,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
10,000 shares.

    Helen W. Kennedy purchased on December 1, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock for $1,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 1,000
shares.

    Johnny R. Kennedy, Sr. purchased on December 1, 1995, 200 shares of
common stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of 2,000
shares.

    Reine R. and David Hemelright purchased on December 6, 1995, 200 shares
of common stock for $2,000.  These shares were split 10:1 for a total of
2,000 shares.

Washington State

    Similar to the shares issued above, securities were sold to several
investors in Washington.  Upon filing of the proposed offer of rescission
by the Company, the securities administrator indicated that in order to
make an offer of rescission the Company would have to register the shares,
therefore the Company opted to return to each of the investors in
Washington the amount of their investment along with interest at the legal
rate rather than pursue a registration with the State.  The transactions
were as follows:

    David Andrew and Kathy June Holt purchased on August 8, 1995, 500
shares of common stock for $5,000.  Mr. and Mrs. Holt were repaid the
amount of their investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8,
1996.

    Glen M. Christopherson purchased on August 9, 1995, 500 shares of
common stock for $5,000.  Mr. Chistopherson was repaid the amount of his
investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Geraldine June Coons purchased on August 11, 1995, 50 shares of common
stock for $500.  Ms. Coons was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Christine L. Del Nagro purchased on August 11, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  Ms. Del Nagro was repaid the amount of her
investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Walter E. Dewater purchased on August 11, 1995, 150 shares of common
stock for $1,500.  Mr. Dewater was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Rodney Dean Alvord purchased on August 11, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  Mr. Alvord was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Mildred Gerard purchased on August 11, 1995, 50 shares of common stock
for $500.  Ms. Gerard was repaid the amount of her investment plus interest
at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Karon Lee Hill purchased on August 11, 1995, 100 shares of common stock
for $1,000.  Ms. Hill was repaid the amount of her investment plus interest
at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Kenneth Lee Huff purchased on August 11, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock for $1,000.  Mr. Huff was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Vickie Lea Parks purchased on August 11, 1995, 300 shares of common
stock for $3,000.  Ms. Parks was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    James Paul Ramos purchased on August 11, 1995, 150 shares of common
stock for $1,500.  Mr. Ramos was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Timothy Thorpe purchased on August 11, 1995, 100 shares of common stock
for $1,000.  Mr. Thorpe was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Steven Keith Hagen purchased on August 14, 1995, 350 shares of common
stock for $3,500.  Mr. Hagen was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Darik Brewer purchased on August 14, 1995, 50 shares of common stock
for $500.  Mr. Brewer was repaid the amount of his investment plus interest
at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Darin Brewer purchased on August 14, 1995, 500 shares of common stock
for $5,000.  Mr. Brewer was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Darin and Jennifer Brewer purchased on August 14, 1995, 50 shares of
common stock for $500.  Mr. and Mrs. Brewer were repaid the amount of their
investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Shirley Mae Carter purchased on August 14, 1995, 300 shares of common
stock for $3,000.  Ms. Carter was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Randall C. And Wanda K. Knight purchased on August 14, 1995, 125 shares
of common stock for $1,250.  Mr. and Mrs. Knight were repaid the amount of
their investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Ruben Marshall Lalish purchased on August 14, 1995, August 18, 1995,
and August 24, 1995, 60, 130, and 250 shares of common stock for ($600,
$1,300 and $2,500), respectively.  Mr. Lalish was repaid the amount of his
investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Debra Jean Waite purchased on August 14, 1995, 100 shares of common
stock for $1,000.  Ms.Waite was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Brian D. And Debra Jean Waite purchased on August 14, 1995, 50 shares
of common stock for $500.  Mr. and Mrs. Waite were repaid the amount of
their investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Patricia A. Wells purchased on August 14, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  Ms. Wells was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Heather Michelle Zeilestra purchased on August 14, 1995, 200 shares of
common stock for $2,000.  Ms. Zeilestra was repaid the amount of her
investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Barbara J. Dickson purchased on August 15, 1995, 50 shares of common
stock for $500.  Ms. Dickson was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Gary Lee Bisby purchased on August 16, 1995, 500 shares of common stock
for $5,000.  Mr. Bisby was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Gary Lee and Valerie Bisby purchased on August 16, 1995, 50 shares of
common stock for $500.  Mr. and Mrs. Bisby were repaid the amount of their
investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    John Hilde purchased on August 16, 1995, 150 shares of common stock for
$1,500.  Mr. Hilde was repaid the amount of his investment plus interest at
the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Donna A. Leslie purchased on August 18, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  Ms. Leslie was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Ronald Raymond Cartwright purchased on August 21, 1995, 500 shares of
common stock for $5,000.  Mr. Cartwright was repaid the amount of his
investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Sharon M. Klykken purchased on August 21, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  Ms. Klykken was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Sidney Wen Monwai purchased on August 22, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  Mr. Monwai was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Sandra Leigh Orestad purchased on August 28, 1995, 50 shares of common
stock for $500.  Ms. Orestad was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Lori Halverson purchased on August 30, 1995, 100 shares of common stock
for $1,000.  Ms. Halverson was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    John Ernest White purchased on September 5, 1995, 200 shares of common
stock for $2,000.  Mr. White was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Michael Anthony and Cheri Diane Rovick purchased on September 12, 1995,
500 shares of common stock for $5,000.  Mr. and Mrs. Rovick were repaid the
amount of their investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8,
1996.

    Joanne Shirley Boyer purchased on September 25, 1995, 50 shares of
common stock for $500.  Ms. Boyer was repaid the amount of her investment
plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Ena T. Shepard purchased on October 2, 1995, 500 shares of common stock
for $5,000.  Ms. Shepard was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Moreen Margot Allen purchased on October 2, 1995, 50 shares of common
stock for $500.  Ms. Allen was repaid the amount of her investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Robert J. Sumner purchased on October 5, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  Mr. Sumner was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Dean R. Dietrich purchased on October 9, 1995, 500 shares of common
stock for $5,000.  Mr. Dietrich was repaid the amount of his investment
plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Robert L. Undsderfer purchased on October 24, 1995, 200 shares of
common stock for $2,000.  Mr. Undsderfer was repaid the amount of his
investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    Marilyn L. VanDelinder purchased on December 1, 1995, 100 shares of
common stock for $1,000.  Ms. VanDelinder was repaid the amount of her
investment plus interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    William R. Baker purchased on December 1, 1995, 50 shares of common
stock for $500.  Mr. Baker was repaid the amount of his investment plus
interest at the legal rate on March 8, 1996.

    The sale and issuance of the securities in the transactions described
above were believed by the Company to be exempt from registration under the
Securities Act, by virtue of Section 4(2) thereof as transactions not
involving any public offering.  The recipients represented their intention
to acquire the securities for investment only and not with a view to
distribution thereof.  Appropriate legends were affixed to the stock
certificates issued in such transactions.  All recipients had adequate
access to information about the Registrant.




      [THE REMAINDER OF THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK]<PAGE>
      
      Item 16.  Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

    (a) Exhibits

Number            Description

1.1               Underwriting Agreement

3.1               Certificate of Incorporation of the Company, with 
				  Certificate of Amendment

3.2               Bylaws of the Company

4.1               Specimen Common Stock Certificate

5.1               Opinion and Consent of Wood & Francis, PLLC
                        
10.1              Employment Agreement - Stanley H. Van Etten

10.2              Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - John D. Brothers

10.3              Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Mary E. Breen

10.4              Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Dwight Hallman

10.5              Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Clark A. Jones

10.6              Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Dawn E. McIntyre

10.7              Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Stephanie Harris

21.1              Certificate of Incorporation International Heritage of 
				  Canada, Inc.

21.2              Bylaws of International Heritage of Canada, Inc.

23.1              Consent of Eilers, Jones, Brown & McLeod, CPAs, PA

25.1              Powers of Attorney (included on Signature Page)


Item 17.  Undertaking

    Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Act may be
permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the Company
pursuant to the North Carolina Business Corporation Act, the Amended
Articles of Incorporation or the Bylaws of the Company, Indemnification
Agreements entered into between the Company and its officers and directors,
the Underwriting Agreement, or otherwise, the Company has been advised that
in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such
indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act, and is,
therefore, unenforceable.  In the event that a claim for indemnification
against such liabilities (other than the payment by the Company of expenses
incurred or paid by a director, officer, or controlling person of the
Company in the successful defense of any action, suite or proceeding)
asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with
the securities being registered hereunder, the Company will, unless in the
opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling
precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the questions
whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in
the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.

    The Company hereby undertakes that:

    (1) For purposes of determining any liability under the Act, the
information omitted from the form of Prospectus filed as part of this
Registration Statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form
of Prospectus filed by the Company pursuant ro Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or
497(h) under the Act shall be deemed to be part of this Registration
Statement as of the time it was declared effective.

    (2) For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities
Act of 1933, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of
prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to
the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that
time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering.  

SIGNATURES

     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the
Company has duly caused this Registration Statement to be signed on its
behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in Raleigh, North
Carolina on this 30th day of August, 1996.

                                   INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.


                              By:  /s/STANLEY H. VAN ETTEN       
                                   Stanley H. Van Etten
                                   (Chairman of the Board)

     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933,
this Registration Statement has been signed by the following persons
in the capacities and on the date indicated:

     Signature                     Title                    Date


/s/ STANLEY H. VAN ETTEN  President, Chief Executive Officer  August 30, 1996
Stanley H. Van Etten      And Chairman of the Board


/s/ JOHN D. BROTHERS      Secretary and Director             August 30, 1996
John D. Brothers


/s/ LARRY G. SMITH       Director                            August 30, 1996
Larry G. Smith			 

/s/ CLAUDE W. SAVAGE     Director                            August 30, 1996
Claude W. Savage


/s/ BARRY ACKEL          Director                            August 30, 1996
Barry  Ackel


/s/ JIMMIE D. KNOWLES    Director                            August 30, 1996
Jimmie D. Knowles


/s/ SABRINA L .H. WEI    Director                            August 30, 1996
Sabrina L.H. Wei


/s/ STANLEY H. VAN ETTEN Attorney-in-fact                    August 30, 1996
Stanley H. Van Etten
Attorney-in-fact



                             EXHIBITS

                        INDEX OF EXHIBITS


Description                                                Number

Revised Underwriting Agreement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1.1

Certificate of Incorporation of the Company, with Certificate of 
Amendment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.1

Bylaws of the Company. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3.2

Specimen Common Stock Certificate. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4.1

Opinion and Consent of Wood & Francis, PLLC  . . . . . . . . .5.1
    
Employment Agreement - Stanley H. Van Etten. . . . . . . . . 10.1

Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - John D. Brothers 10.2

Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Mary E. Breen. . 10.3

Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Dwight Hallman . 10.4  

Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Clark A. Jones  .10.5  

Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Dawn E. McIntyre 10.6

Confidentiality/Non-Competition Agreement - Stephanie Harris 10.7

Certificate of Incorporation International Heritage of Canada, Inc.21.1

Bylaws of International Heritage of Canada, Inc. . . . . . . 21.2

Consent of Eilers, Jones, Brown & McLeod, CPAs, PA . . .     23.1     



                               REVISED
                        UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT
    
    THIS UNDERWRITING AGREEMENT (the "Agreement") is made and 
    entered into this 30th day of August 1996, by and between 
    International Heritage, Inc., a North Carolina corporation, 
    the address of which is 2626 Glenwood Avenue, Raleigh, North 
    Carolina 27608 (the "Issuer"), and WIN Capital Corporation, a 
    New York corporation, the address of which is 26 Ludlam 
    Avenue, Bayville, New York 11709 (the "Agent").
    
    Recitals:
    
    A. The Issuer desires to offer and sell up to 2,500,000 
    shares of its Common Stock, $0.001 par value (the "Stock"), at 
    a price of Ten Dollars ($10.00) per share in cash to outside 
    investors in a public offering in the States of Alabama, 
    California, Florida, Georgia, Kansas, Louisiana, Maryland, New 
    York, North Carolina, Oklahoma, Oregon, Pennsylvania, South 
    Carolina, Tennessee, Texas and Virginia (the "Jurisdictions"), 
    among other places (the "Offering").
    
    B. The Offering will be made pursuant to a Registration 
    Statement on Form S-1 under the Securities Act of 1933, as 
    amended (the "Securities Act"), which was originally filed with 
    the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the "SEC") on, or 
    about, July 16, 1996, (the "Offering Statement") and pursuant 
    to registrations and/or exemptions therefrom in each of the 
    above Jurisdictions.
    
    C. The Issuer desires to obtain the services of an Agent 
    to assist it in the offering and sale of the Stock in the 
    Jurisdictions.
        
    D. The Agent is a member of the National Association of 
    Securities Dealers, Inc. (the "NASD") and is willing, as an 
    Agent, to assist the Issuer in the offering and sale of the 
    Stock in the Jurisdictions on the terms and conditions set 
    forth herein.
    
    Agreement:
    
    NOW, THEREFORE, for and in consideration of the foregoing, 
    and of the mutual covenants, agreements undertakings, 
    representations and warranties contained herein, the parties 
    hereto agree as follows:
    
    1. Appointment of Agent. The Issuer hereby appoints the 
    Aqent as its Agent in the Jurisdictions for the Offering.
    
    The Issuer further appoints the Agent to act in its 
    behalf to form and menage a selling group to sell the Offering.
    The Issuer maintains the right in its sole discretion to approve or 
    disapprove any potential member of the selling group.
    
    2. Acceptance of Appointment; Best Efforts. The Agent hereby 
    accepts the appointment described in Section 1 above and agrees, as 
    Agent for the Issuer, to use its best efforts to find purchasers for 
    the Stock in the Jurisdictions. The Agent makes no commitment to 
    purchase all or any of the shares of the Stock.
    
    3. Other Jurisdictions. The Issuer retains the right to employ 
    other agents in jurisdictions other than the Jurisdictions for and in 
    connection with the sale of the Stock. However, the Issuer. in its 
    sole discretion, may accept or reject those agents.
    
    4. Termination of Offering. The Offering shall terminate upon the 
    happening of the earlier of (i) the sale of all of the Stock, (ii) 
    December 31, 1996 (or such later date if the Offering is extended by the 
    Issuer for an additional period, not to extend beyond January 3,  1997), or 
    (iii) the withdrawal or cancellation of the Offering by the Issuer in 
    its sole and absolute discretion (the earlier of (i), (ii) and (iii) 
    being sometimes referred to herein as the "Termination Date"). Upon 
    the Agent's receipt of written notice from the Issuer of the 
    termination of the Offering, the Agent immediately shall cease making 
    offers of the Stock and shall terminate all then pending offers.
    
    5. Proceeds to Issuer. The net proceeds that shall be paid to 
    the Issuer on the sale of Stock by the Agent are Nine Dollars and Ten 
    Cents ($9.10) per share.
    
    6. Agent Compensation. As compensation for its activities 
    hereunder and pursuant hereto, the Agent shall be paid a commission 
    equal to Ninety Cents ($0.90) per share of the Stock (whose 
    subscription is accepted by the Issuer) sold by the Agent or other 
    broker-dealers joining the syndicate with the Agent. A sales 
    commission of Cents ($ . ) per share of Stock sold in the Offering 
    shall be paid to members of the selling syndicate.
    
    In the event the offering is terminated prior to closing, 
    the Agent will be reimbursed only for its actual, accountable out of 
    pocket expenses.
    
    Options or Warrants to be granted to the Agent and to the 
    Agent's counsel, Richard Heller of Shustak Jalil Sanders & Heller will 
    be restricted from sale, transfer, assignment or hypothecation for a 
    period of one year from the effective date of the offering.
    
    7. Escrow and Release of Proceeds. Any and all proceeds received 
    by the Agent from the sale of the Stock shall be deposited in an 
    escrow account with Continental Trust & Transfer Company (the "Escrow 
    Agent") pursuant to that certain Escrow Agreement attached hereto as 
    Exhibit A (the "Escrow Agreement"). The Issuer shall pay
    the fee for establishing and maintaining the Escrow Account. 
    Subscribers' checks shall be made payable to the Escrow Agent and the 
    Agent will transmit such checks directly to the Escrow Agent by noon 
    the next business day after receipt. The Escrow Agent promptly shall 
    release to the Issuer the net proceeds (proceeds less commissions) 
    from the sales of the Stock as and when requested by the Issuer but in 
    any event, no earlier than the closing of the offering beginning with 
    the first closing upon receipt of the minimum offering amount of 
    $5,000,000 and the maximum offering amount of $25,000,000 or until the 
    termination of the offering. The commission relating to a particular 
    sale shall be released by the Escrow Agent to the Agent when the net 
    proceeds of that sale are released to the Issuer.
    
    8. Agent Expenses. The Agent shall be responsible for payment of 
    all of its, travel, printing and other expenses, whether or not there 
    is a closing under the Offering.
    
    The Issuer shall, however, reimburse the Agent for its 
    reasonable legal fees and disbursements related to the offering.
    
    9. Subscriptions. Each subscriber purchasing Stock through the 
    Agent shall subscribe for the Stock by completing and executing a 
    subscription agreement in the form attached hereto as Exhibit B 
    ("Subscription Agreement") and delivering the completed and executed 
    Subscription Agreement along with payment to the Agent. The Agent will 
    transmit such Subscription Agreements directly to the Issuer by noon 
    the next business day after receipt.
    
    10. Acceptance or Rejection of Subscriptions. The Issuer has the 
    right to accept or reject any subscription. Only upon the acceptance 
    of a subscription by the Issuer is a sale made. Upon the acceptance of 
    a subscription, the Issuer shall execute the acceptance on the 
    Subscription Agreement, and shall forward a duplicate of the accepted 
    Subscription Agreement to the subscriber with a copy to the Agent.
    
    11. Representations and Warranties of the Issuer. The Issuer
    represents and warrants to, and agrees with the Agent that:
    
    (a) The Issuer is a corporation duly organized, validly existing 
    and in good standing under the laws of the State of North 
    Carolina with power and authority to own its properties and to 
    conduct its business as described in the Offering Statement;
    
    (b) The Issuer has a duly authorized and outstanding 
    capitalization as set forth in the Offering Statement, its 
    capital stock conforms to the description contained in the 
    Offering Statement and the Stock conforms to the description 
    contained in the Offering Statement and the Stock, when issued
    and delivered pursuant to Subscription Agreements, shall be 
    duly and validly issued, fully paid and non-assessable;
    
    (c) The Issuer shall prepare and file the Offering Statement 
    with the SEC, the NASD and, to the extent required by law, the 
    Jurisdictions, and shall use its best efforts to cause the 
    registration or exemption with each such regulatory agency to 
    become effective, as well as those of any other jurisdiction in 
    which the Stock is to be offered and sold;
    
    (d) The Offering Statement does not contain any untrue statement 
    of a material fact or omit to state any material fact required 
    to be stated or necessary to make the statements in the Offering 
    Statement, in light of the circumstances under which they are 
    made, not misleading;
    
    (e) The consolidated financial statements and schedules filed 
    with, and as part of, the Offering Statement present fairly the 
    cost of the assets, the liabilities and the capital stock of the 
    Issuer as of the dates of the statements and schedules, all in 
    conformity with generally accepted accounting principles ("GAAP") 
    applied on a consistent basis throughout the entire periods 
    involved, except that those of such financial statements and 
    schedules that are unaudited do not contain the notes normally 
    required by GAAP and are subject to audit adjustments, and since 
    the respective dates of the financial statements and schedules 
    there has been no material adverse change in the condition or 
    general affairs of the Issuer, financial or otherwise, other than 
    as referred to in, or contemplated by, the Offering Statement;
    
    (f) The execution and delivery of this Agreement, the 
    consummation of the transactions contemplated in this Agreement 
    and compliance with the terms and provision of this Agreement 
    shall not conflict with, or result in a breach of, any of the 
    terms or provisions of, or constitute a default under, the 
    Articles of Incorporation, as amended, or the Bylaws of the 
    Issuer or any of its subsidiaries, or any indenture, mortgage or 
    other agreement or instrument to which the Issuer or any of its 
    subsidiaries is a party or by which any of their respective 
    assets or properties are bound, or any applicable law, rule, 
    regulation, judgment, order or decree of any government, 
    governmental instrumentality or court, domestic or foreign, 
    having jurisdiction over the Issuer or any of its subsidiaries or 
    any of their respective assets or properties, except for 
    instances where not material to the Issuer:
    
    (g) This Agreement has been duly authorized, executed and 
    delivered on behalf of the Issuer, and is the valid, binding and 
    enforceable obligation of the Issuer; and
 
    (h) No authorization, approval, consent or license of any 
    regulatory body or authority is required for the valid 
    authorization, issuance, sale and delivery of the Stock, or, if 
    so required, all authorizations, approvals, consents and licenses 
    have been obtained and are in full force and effect, except for 
    instances where not material to the Issuer.
    
    12. Covenants of the Issuer. The Issuer covenants that:
    
    (a) The Issuer shall not at any time make or file any amendment 
    or supplement to the Offering Statement of which the Agent 
    previously has not been advised and furnished a copy, or to 
    which the Agent reasonably may object in writing. The Issuer 
    shall prepare and file any amendments or supplements to the 
    Offering Statement that in the reasonable opinion of counsel for 
    the Agent may be necessary in connection with the offering and 
    sale of the Stock by the Agent, and shall use its best efforts 
    to cause each such amendment or supplement to become effective 
    as promptly as possible.
    
    (b) The Issuer shall deliver to the Agent a confidential listing 
    of potential investors for the Offering, including contact 
    information for each such potential investor (the "Confidential 
    Investor List"). The Issuer shall also deliver to the Agent, 
    without charge, from time to time during the term of this 
    Agreement as many copies of the Offering Statement, the Offering 
    Circular included therein (as amended from time to time, the 
    "Circular") and any other documents as the Aqent reasonably may 
    request.
    
    (c) The Issuer shall use its best efforts to comply with, and to 
    continue to comply with, all applicable state and federal 
    securities and other laws so as to permit the continuation of 
    the offering and sale of the Stock.
    
    (d) The Issuer promptly shall notify the Agent in the event of 
    (i) the issuance by any federal or state securities commission or 
    authority of any stop order suspending the effectiveness of the 
    Offering Statement, or (ii) the institution or notice of the 
    intended institution of any action or proceeding for that 
    purpose. The Issuer shall make every reasonable effort to prevent 
    the issuance of such a stop order, and, if such a stop order is 
    issued at any time, to obtain the withdrawal of the order at the 
    earliest possible time.
    
    (e) The Issuer will cooperate with the Agent in connection with, 
    and shall make available to the Agent such documents and other 
    information as the Agent shall reasonably require to satisfy, its 
    reasonable due diligence requirements.
   
    13. Representations and Warranties of the Agent. The Agent 
    represents and warrants to, and agrees with the Issuer that:
    
    (a) The Agent is a member in good standing of the NASD and is 
    currently licensed in the jurisdictions in which the offering 
    will be sold;
    
    (b) The Agent and all persons employed by it or who work for it 
    as agents have all necessary permits, licenses and permissions 
    to enable it and them to act as agent for the Issuer in the 
    offering and sale of the Stock as required by applicable state 
    and federal securities and other laws; and
    
    (c) Neither the Agent nor any partner, director or officer of 
    the Agent is disqualified under Rule 262 promulgated under the 
    Securities Act or any applicable disqualification provision of 
    any Jurisdiction's law.
    
    14. Covenants of the Agent. The Agent covenants that:
    
    (a) The Agent shall not sell the stock offered pursuant to the 
    Offering Statement in any manner that violates the conditions 
    imposed by applicable state or federal securities laws in 
    connection with an offer and sale of securities pursuant to 
    registrations pertaining to the Offering and under the 
    Securities Act and the registrations and/or exemptions therefrom 
    in each of the Jurisdictions.
    
    (b) The Agent shall use its best efforts to contact all of the 
    potential investors listed in the Confidential Investor List to 
    be provided by the Issuer for purposes of Offering and selling 
    the Stock in the Offering. However, the Agent shall not be 
    limited to offering the Stock solely to the potential investors 
    listed in the Confidential Investor List, and the Agent shall 
    not be required to contact any additional potential investors 
    listed in the Confidential Investor List not already contacted 
    by the Agent, after the Issuer has accepted Subscription 
    Agreements from investors for the total amount of stock in the 
    Offering.
    
    15. Termination of Aqreement. This Agreement may, subject to the 
    other Provisions hereof, be terminated as follows:
    
    (a) At any time prior to the commencement of the Offering, the 
    Issuer may, by notice to the Agent, terminate this Agreement; and 
    at any time prior to the commencement of the Offering, the Agent 
    may, by notice to the Issuer, terminate this Aqreement;
    
    (b) By the Agent at any time by notice to the Issuer because of 
    any failure on the part of the Issuer to comply with any of the 
    terms and provisions, or to fulfill any of the conditions
    hereof, or if for any reason the Issuer is unable to perform its 
    obligations hereunder;
    
    (c) By the Issuer at any time by notice to the Agent because of 
    any failure on the part of the Agent to comply with any of the 
    terms and provisions, or to fulfill any of the conditions 
    hereof, or if for any reason the Agent is unable to perform its 
    obligations hereunder;
    
    (d) By the Issuer at any time by notice to the Agent because of 
    disapproval of the terms of this Agreement by the NASD, SEC, or 
    any state securities regulatory authority charged with approving 
    such agreements or the registration of the Offering or any 
    exemption therefrom. However, without first terminating this 
    Agreement, the Issuer and the Agent, by mutual written consent, 
    may amend this Agreement, by adding, deleting, or modifying any 
    of the provisions hereof if necessary to obtain approval of this 
    Agreement or of the offering by the NASD, SEC, or any state 
    securities regulatory authority.
    
    (e) Upon the occurrence and satisfactory completion of the 
    offering and sale of all of the Stock and the distribution of 
    the proceeds to the Agent.
    
    16. Indemnification. The Issuer shall indemnify and hold 
    harmless the Agent and each person, if any, who controls the Agent 
    within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities Act from and 
    against any and all losses, claims, damages, expenses or liabilities, 
    joint or several, to which they or any of them may become subject 
    under the Securities Act or under any other statute or at common law 
    or otherwise, and, except as provided below, shall reimburse the Agent 
    and each controlling person, if any, for any legal or other expenses 
    reasonably incurred by them or any of them in connection with 
    investigating or defending any actions whether or not resulting in any 
    liability, insofar as the losses, claims, damages, expenses, 
    liabilities actions or expenses (collectively, "Losses") arising out 
    of or are based upon any untrue statement or alleged untrue statement 
    of a material fact contained in the Offering Statement, or arising out 
    of or based upon the omission or alleged omission to state a material 
    fact contained in the Offering Statement, or arising out of or based 
    upon the omission or alleged omission to state a material fact 
    required to be stated in the Offering Statement necessary in order to 
    make the statements in the Offering Statement not misleading, unless 
    the untrue statement or omission was made in the Offering Statement in 
    reliance upon and in conformity with information furnished in writing 
    to the Issuer by the Agent directly or through counsel expressly for 
    the purpose of inclusion therein. However, this indemnification 
    provision shall not benefit the Agent or any person controlling the 
    Agent if the Agent failed to send or give a copy of the Offering 
    Statement to a person at or prior to the time an offer of Stock was 
    made to that person, or acted in violation of any covenants made by it 
    herein.
    
    Promptly after receipt by the Agent or any person controlling 
    the Agent of notice of the commencement of any action with respect to 
    which indemnification may be sought from the Issuer under this 
    Section, the Agent shall notify the Issuer in writing of the 
    commencement, and, subject to the provisions stated below, the Issuer 
    shall assume the defense of the action (including the employment of 
    counsel and the payment of expenses) in so far as the action relates 
    to any alleged Losses with respect to which indemnification may be 
    sought from the Issuer. The Agent or any person controlling the Agent 
    shall have the right to employ separate counsel in any action and to 
    participate in the defense of the action, but the fees and expenses 
    of such counsel must be specifically authorized in writing by the 
    Issuer before being incurred. The Issuer shall not be liable, and 
    shall not be required, to indemnify any person in connection with any 
    settlement of any action effected without the Issuer's consent in 
    writing.
    
    The Agent shall indemnify and hold harmless the Issuer, each of 
    its directors, each of its officers, and each person, if any, who 
    controls the Issuer within the meaning of Section 15 of the Securities 
    Act from and against any and all Losses to which they or any of them 
    may become subject under the Securities Act or under any other statute 
    or at common law or otherwise, and, except as provided below, shall 
    reimburse the Issuer and each director, officer or controlling person, 
    if any, for any legal or other expenses reasonably incurred by them or 
    any of them in connection with investigating or defending any actions 
    whether or not resulting in any liability, (i) insofar as the Losses 
    arise out of or are based upon any untrue statement or alleged untrue 
    statement of a material fact contained the Offering Statement, or 
    arise out of or are based upon the omission or alleged omission to 
    state a material fact required to be stated in the Offering Statement 
    or necessary in order to make the statements in the Offering Statement 
    not misleading, but only in so far as the untrue statement or omission 
    was made in the Offering Statement in reliance upon and in conformity 
    with information furnished in writing to the Issuer by the Agent 
    directly or through counsel expressly for the purpose of inclusion 
    therein, or (ii) in so far as the Losses arise out of or are based 
    upon any statements made or action taken in connection with an offer 
    or sale in connection with the offering and under the Securities Act 
    and the registrations and/or exemptions therefrom in each of the 
    Jurisdictions.
    
    Promptly after receipt of notice of the commencement of any 
    action with respect to which indemnification may be sought from the 
    Agent under this Section, the Issuer shall notify the Agent in writing 
    of the commencement, and, subject to the provisions stated below, the 
    Agent shall assume the defense of the action (including the employment 
    of counsel and the payment of expenses) in so far as
    the action relates to any alleged Losses with respect to which 
    indemnification may be sought from the Agent. The Issuer and 
    each director, officer or controlling person shall have the 
    right to employ separate counsel in any action and to 
    participate in the defense of the action, but the fees and 
    expenses of the counsel shall not be the expense of the Agent 
    unless the employment of the counsel has been specifically 
    authorized in writing by the Agent. The Agent shall not be 
    liable, and shall not be required, to indemnify any person in 
    connection with any settlement of any action effected without 
    the Agent's consent in writing.
    
    17. Contribution. If the indemnity referred to in Section 
    17 should be, for any reason whatsoever, unenforceable, 
    unavailable or otherwise insufficient to hold each indemnified 
    person harmless, the indemnified person shall pay to or on 
    behalf of each indemnified person contributions for Losses so 
    that each indemnified person ultimately bears only a portion of 
    such Losses as is appropriate (i) to reflect the relative 
    benefits received by each such indemnified person, 
    respectively, on the one hand and the indemnifying person on 
    the other hand in connection with the transaction, or (ii) if 
    the allocation of that basis is not permitted by applicable 
    law, to reflect not only the relative fault of each such 
    indemnified person, respectively, and the indemnifying person 
    as well as any other relevant equitable considerations. The 
    respective relative benefits received by the Agent and the 
    Issuer shall be deemed to be in the same proportion as the 
    aggregate commission paid to the Agent bears to the total gross 
    proceeds of the Offering. The relative fault of each 
    indemnifying person shall be determined by reference to, among 
    other things, whether the actions or omissions to act were by 
    such indemnifying person and the parties' relative intent, 
    knowledge, access to information and opportunity to correct or 
    prevent such action or omission to act.
    
    18. Provisions to Survive Delivery. The representations, 
    warranties, covenants, indemnities, understandings, agreements, 
    and other statements of the Issuer and the Agent contemplated 
    by, set forth in, or made pursuant to, this Agreement and the 
    indemnification agreements of the Issuer and the Agent shall 
    survive delivery of, and payment for, the Stock.
    
    19. Arbitration. Any dispute arising out this Agreement or 
    breach hereof shall, at the election of a party hereto, by 
    written notice to the other (the "Non-electing Party"), be 
    referred to the American Arbitration Association (the "AAA") to 
    be settled by arbitration in the city and state where the 
    Non-electing Party, or its principal executive office, is 
    located under the then existing Commercial Arbitration Rules of 
    the AAA. Any arbitration conducted pursuant hereto shall be 
    conducted by a recognized independent and impartial arbitrator 
    mutually agreed to by the Issuer and the Agent involved in such 
    dispute, or, if they cannot agree, by three (3) arbitrators, one 
    chosen by the Issuer, one chosen by the Agent and the third 
    (who shall be a recognized independent and impartial
    arbitrator and who shall act as chairperson of the arbitrators) 
    selected by the first two arbitrators; provided, however, that if 
    either party fails to appoint an arbitrator within fifteen (15) 
    calendar days of its receipt of written notice by the other that the 
    other has appointed an arbitrator, the arbitration shall be conducted 
    by an arbitrator selected by the AAA. If the arbitrators selected by 
    the issuer and the Agent fail to agree on a third arbitrator, the 
    third arbitrator shall be appointed by the AAA. All costs of each 
    arbitration pursuant to this Section (including, without limitation, 
    all fees of the arbitrator(s) and attorneys' fees) shall be borne by 
    the party whose last written offer of settlement (or claim if no offer 
    of settlement was made by such party) differed by a greater amount 
    from the award made by the arbitrator(s), or in the case of an 
    arbitration to determine a matter other than a dollar amount or 
    percentage, by the party against whom the decision of the 
    arbitration(s) shall be rendered, as such issue is determined by the 
    arbitrator(s); provided, however, that no offer of settlement shall be 
    disclosed by a party to the arbitrator(s) until after the 
    arbitrator(s) has (have) rendered an award or decision on the merits.
    
    Any award granted or decision reached pursuant to arbitration 
    hereunder shall be final and binding upon the parties and payment 
    shall be made as so determined within seven calendar days of the date 
    of the award or decision. Judgment upon the arbitration award or 
    decision may be entered in any court having competent jurisdiction.
    
    20. Governing Law. This Agreement shall be construed in 
    accordance with the laws of the State of North Carolina without 
    regard to conflict of law principles.
        
    21. Assignment. Neither this Agreement nor any interest of any 
    party herein may be assigned, pledged or transferred without the 
    prior written consent of the parties hereto.
    
    22. Binding Effect. This Agreement inures to the benefit of, and 
    is binding upon, the parties hereto, and their respective heirs, 
    representatives, successors, assigns and controlling person, but 
    nothing herein shall be construed as an authorization or right of any 
    party to assign its rights and obligations hereunder. A successor or 
    an assign does not include a purchaser of Stock of the Issuer solely 
    by reason of that purchase.
    
    23. Waiver. No waiver of any provision hereof is valid unless it 
    is in writing and signed by the person against whom it is charged.
    
    24. Notice. Any notice required or permitted to be given 
    pursuant hereto must be in writing addressed to the person at the 
    address specified herein, or at an address changed in this manner.

    25.  Entire Agreement.  This Agreement, including all exhibits,
    constitutes the entire agreement among parties with respect to
    subject matter hereof.
    
    IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties  hereto have executed this 
    Agreement on the day, month and year first written above.
    
    
    The ISSUER:			International Heritage, Inc

				By /s/ Stanley Van Etten
				Its President and CEO
              
    
				WIN Capital Corporation
    THE  AGENT:		
				By /s/ Barry Hawk
				Its President 



                          ESCROW AGREEMENT
                          PUBLIC OFFERING
    AGREEMENT made 28th day of August, 1996 by and among the Issuer
    and the Underwriter whose names and addresses appear on the
    Information Sheet (as defined herein) attached to this Agreement
    and Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company (the "Escrow
    Agent") with a principal place of business located at:  2
    Broadway, New York, New York 10004.

				W I T N E S S E T H	

    WHEREAS, the Issuer has filed with the Securities and Exchange
    Commission (the "Commission") a registration statement (the
    "Registration Statement") covering a proposed public offering of
    its securities as described on the Information Sheet;

    WHEREAS, the Underwriter proposed to offer the Securities, as
    agent for the Issuer, for sale to the public on a "best
    efforts," minimum/maximum basis with respect to the Minimum
    Securities Amount and Minimum Dollar Amount and at the price per
    share or other unit all as set forth on the Information Sheet;

    WHEREAS, the Issuer and the Underwriter propose to establish an
    escrow account (the "Escrow Account"), to which subscription
    monies which are received by the Escrow Agent from the
    Underwriter in connection with such public offering are to be
    credited, and the Escrow Agent is willing to establish the
    Escrow Account on the terms and subject to the conditions
    hereinafter set forth; and

    WHEREAS, the Escrow Agent has an agreement with Chase Bank to
    establish a special bank account (the "Bank Account") into which
    the subscription monies, which are received by the Escrow Agent
    from the Underwriter and credited to the Escrow Account, are to
    be deposited; NOW,

    THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and mutual covenants
    herein contained, the parties hereto hereby agree as follows:

	    1.  Information Sheet.  Each capitalized term not otherwise
    defined in this Agreement shall have the meaning set forth for
    such term on the information sheet which is attached to this
    Agreement and is incorporated by reference herein and made a
    part hereof (the "Information Sheet").

    2. Establishment of the Bank Account.
    
	    2.1 The Escrow Agent shall establish a non-interest-bearing
    bank account at the branch of Chase Bank selected by the Escrow
    Agent, and bearing the designation set forth on the Information
    Sheet (heretofore defined as the "Bank Account").  The purpose
    of the Bank Account is for (a) the deposit of all subscription
    monies (checks, cash or wire transfers) which are received by
    Issuer from the Underwriter from prospective purchasers of the
    Securities and are delivered by the Underwriter to the Escrow
    Agent, (b) the holding of amounts of subscription monies which
    are collected through the banking system, and (c) the
    disbursement of collected funds, all as described herein.
    	
	2.2 On or before the date of the initial deposit in the Bank
    Account pursuant to this Agreement, the Underwriter shall notify
    the Escrow Agent in writing of the effective date of the
    Registration Statement (the "Effective Date"), and the Escrow
    Agent shall not be required to accept any amounts for credit to
    the Escrow Account or for deposit in the Bank Account prior to
    its receipt of such notification.

        2.3 The Offering Period, which shall be deemed to commence
    on the Effective Date, shall consist of the number of calendar
    days or business days set forth on the Information Sheet.  The
    Offering Period shall be extended by an Extension Period only
    if the Escrow Agent shall have received written notice thereof
    at least five (5) business days prior to the expiration of the
    Offering Period.  The Extension Period, which shall be deemed
    to commence on the next calendar day following the expiration
    of the Offering Period, shall consist of the number of calendar
    days or business days set forth on the Information Sheet.  The
    last day of the Offering Period, or the last day of the Exten-
    sion Period (if the Escrow Agent has received written notice
    thereof as hereinabove provided), is referred to herein as the
    "Termination Date."  Except as provided in Section 4.3 hereof,
    after the Termination Date the Underwriter shall not deposit,
    and the Escrow Agent shall not accept, any additional amounts
    representing payments by prospective purchasers.

    3. Deposits to the Bank Account.
3.1 The Underwriter shall promptly deliver to the Escrow Agent all
    	monies which it receives from prospective purchasers of the
    	Securities, which monies shall be in the form of checks,
    	cash, or wire transfers.  Upon the Escrow Agent's receipt of
    	such monies, they shall be credited to the Escrow Account.
    	All checks delivered to the Escrow Agent shall be made
    	payable to "Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company, as
    	Escrow Agent for the offering by International Heritage,
    	Inc."  Any check payable other than to the Escrow Agent as
    	required hereby shall be returned to the prospective
    	purchaser, or if the Escrow Agent has insufficient
    	information to do so, then to the Underwriter (together with
    	any Subscription Information, as defined below or other
    	documents delivered therewith) by noon of the next business
    	day following receipt of such check by the Escrow Agent, and
    	such check shall be deemed not to have been delivered to the
    	Escrow Agent pursuant to the terms of this Agreement.
    
3.2 Promptly after receiving subscription monies as described in
    Section 3.1 the Escrow Agent shall deposit the same into the
    Bank Account.  Amounts of monies so deposited are hereinafter
    referred to as "Escrow Amounts."  The Escrow Agent shall cause
    Chase Bank to process all Escrow Amounts for collection through
    the banking system.  Simultaneously with each deposit to the
    Escrow Account, the Underwriter (or the Issuer, if such deposit
    is made by the Issuer) shall inform the Escrow Agent in writing
    of the name and address of the prospective purchaser, the amount
    of Securities subscribed for by such purchaser, and the
    aggregate dollar amount of such subscription (collectively, the
    "Subscription Information").
    
            3.3 The Escrow Agent shall not be required to accept for
    credit to the Escrow Account or for deposit into the Bank Account
    checks which are not accompanied by the appropriate Subscription
    Information.  Wire transfers and cash representing payments by
    prospective purchasers shall not be deemed deposited in the
    Escrow Account until the Escrow Agent has received in writing
    the Subscription Information required with respect to such
    payments.

	    3.4 The Escrow Agent shall not be required to accept in the
    Escrow Account any amounts representing payments by prospective
    purchasers, whether by check, cash or wire, except during the
    Escrow Agent's regular business hours

	    3.5 Only those Escrow Amounts, which have been deposited in
    the Bank Account and which have cleared the banking system and
    have been collected by the Escrow Agent, are herein referred to
    as the "Fund "

	    3.6 If the proposed offering is terminated before the
    Termination Date, the Escrow Agent shall refund any portion of
    the Fund prior to disbursement of the Fund in accordance with
    Article 4 hereof upon instructions in writing signed by both the
    Issuer and the Underwriter.

    4.  Disbursement from the Bank Account.

	    4.1 Subject to Section 4.3 below, if by the close of regular
    banking hours on the Termination Date the Escrow Agent
    determines that the amount in the Fund is less than the Minimum
    Dollar Amount or the Minimum Securities Amount, as indicated by
    the Subscription Information submitted to the Escrow Agent, then
    in either case, the Escrow Agent shall promptly refund to each
    prospective purchaser the amount of payment received from such
    purchaser which is then held in the Fund or which thereafter
    clears the banking system, without interest thereon or deduction
    therefrom, by drawing checks on the Bank Account for the amounts
    of such payments and transmitting them to the purchasers.  In
    such event, the Escrow Agent shall promptly notify the Issuer
    and the Underwriter of its distribution of the Fund.

	    4.2 Subject to Section 4.3 below, if at any time up to the
    close of regular banking hours on the Termination Date, the
    Escrow Agent determines that the amount in the Fund is at least
    equal to the Minimum Dollar Amount and represents the sale of
    not less than the Minimum Securities Amount, the Escrow Agent
    shall promptly notify the Issuer and the Underwriter of such
    fact in writing.  The Escrow Agent shall promptly disburse the
    Fund, by drawing checks on the Bank Account in accordance with
    instructions in writing signed by both the Issuer and the
    Underwriter as to the disbursement of the Fund, promptly after
    it receives such instructions.
              
	    4.3 [This provision applies only if a Collection Period has
    been provided for by the appropriate indication on the
    Information Sheet.] If the Escrow Agent or the Underwriter has
    on hand at the close of business on the Termination Date any
    uncollected amounts which then added to the Fund would raise the
    amount in the Fund to the Minimum Dollar Amount, and result in
    the Fund representing the sale of the Minimum Securities Amount,
    the Collection Period (consisting of the number of business days
    set forth on the Information Sheet) shall be utilized to allow
    such uncollected amounts to clear the banking system.  During
    the Collection Period, the Underwriter (and the Issuer) shall
    not deposit, and the Escrow Agent shall not accept, any
    additional amounts; provided, however, that such amounts as were
    received by the Underwriter (or the Issuer) by the close of
    business on the Termination Date may be deposited with the
    Escrow Agent by noon of the next business day following the
    Termination Date.  If at the close of business on the last day
    of the Collection Period an amount sufficient to raise the
    amount in the Fund to the Minimum Dollar Amount and which would
    result in the Fund representing the sale of the Minimum
    Securities Amount shall not have cleared the banking system, the
    Escrow Agent shall promptly notify the Issuer and the
    Underwriter in writing of such fact and shall promptly return
    all amounts then in the Fund, and any amounts which thereafter
    clear the banking system, to the prospective purchasers as
    provided in Section 4.2 hereof.

	    4.4 Upon disbursement of the Fund pursuant to the terms of
    this Article 4, the Escrow Agent shall be relieved of all
    further obligations and released from all liability under this
    Agreement.  It is expressly agreed and understood that in no
    event shall the aggregate amount of payments made by the Escrow
    Agent exceed the amount of the Fund.
	
    5.  Rights, Duties and Responsibilities of Escrow Agent.  It is
    understood and agreed that the duties of the Escrow Agent are
    purely ministerial in nature, and that:

	    5.1 The Escrow Agent shall notify the Underwriter, on a
    daily basis, of the Escrow Amounts which have been deposited in
    the Bank Account and of the amounts, constituting the Fund,
    which have cleared the banking system and have been collected by
    the Escrow Agent.

	    5.2 The Escrow Agent shall not be responsible for or be
    required to enforce any of the terms or conditions of the
    Underwriting Agreement or any other agreement between the
    Underwriter and the Issuer nor shall the Escrow Agent be
    responsible for the performance by the Underwriter or the Issuer
    of their respective obligations under this Agreement.
	 
           5.3 The Escrow Agent shall not be required to accept from the
    Underwriter (or the Issuer) any Subscription Information
    pertaining to prospective purchasers unless such Subscription
    Information is accompanied by checks, cash, or wire transfers
    meeting the requirements of Section 3.1, nor shall the Escrow
    Agent be required to keep records of any information with
    respect to payments deposited by the Underwriter (or the Issuer)
    except as to the amount of such payments; however, the Escrow
    Agent shall notify the Underwriter within a reasonable time of
    any discrepancy between the amount set forth in any Subscription
    Information and the amount delivered to the Escrow Agent
    therewith.  Such amount need not be accepted for deposit in the
    Escrow Account until such discrepancy has been resolved.

	    5.4 The Escrow Agent shall be under no duty or
    responsibility to enforce collection of any check delivered to
    it hereunder.  The Escrow Agent, within a reasonable time, shall
    return to the Underwriter any check received which is
    dishonored, together with the Subscription Information, if any
    which accompanied such check.

            5.5 The Escrow Agent shall be entitled to rely upon the accu-
    racy, act in reliance upon the contents, and assume the genuineness of
    any notice, instruction, certificate, signature, instrument or other
    document which is given to the Escrow Agent pursuant to this
    Agreement without the necessity of the Escrow Agent verifying the
    truth or accuracy thereof.  The Escrow Agent shall not be obligated
    to make any inquiry as to the authority, capacity, existence or
    identity of any person purporting to give any such notice or
    instructions or to execute any such certificate, instrument or other
    document.

	    5.6 If the Escrow Agent is uncertain as to its duties or
    rights hereunder or shall receive instructions with respect to
    the Bank Account, the Escrow Amounts or the Fund which, in its
    sole determination, are in conflict either with other
    instructions received by it or with any provision of this
    Agreement, it shall be entitled to hold the Escrow Amounts, the
    Fund, or a portion thereof, in the Bank Account pending the
    resolution of such uncertainty to the Escrow Agent's sole
    satisfaction, by final judgment of a court or courts of
    competent jurisdiction or otherwise; or the Escrow Agent, at its
    sole option, may deposit the Fund (and any other Escrow Amounts
    that thereafter become part of the Fund) with the Clerk of a
    court of competent jurisdiction in a proceeding to which all
    parties in interest are joined.  Upon the deposit by the Escrow
    Agent of the Fund with the Clerk of any court, the Escrow Agent
    shall be relieved of all further obligations and released from
    all liability hereunder unless due to the Escrow Agent's willful
    misconduct or gross negligence.

	    5.7 The Escrow Agent shall not be liable for any action
    taken or omitted hereunder, or for the misconduct of any
    employee, agent or attorney appointed by it, except in the case
    of willful misconduct or gross negligence.  The Escrow Agent
    shall be entitled to consult with counsel of its own choosing
    and shall not be liable for any action taken, suffered or
    omitted by it in accordance with the advice of such counsel.

        5.8 The Escrow Agent shall have no responsibility at any time
    to ascertain whether or not any security interest exists in the
    Escrow Amounts, the Fund or any part thereof or to file any
    financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code with
    respect to the Fund or any part thereof.
    
    6.  Amendment.  This Agreement may be altered or amended only
    with the written consent of the Issuer, the Underwriter and the
    Escrow Agent.
    
    7.  Representations and Warranties.  The Issuer and the
    Underwriter hereby jointly and severally represent and warrant
    to the Escrow Agent that:

	    7.1 No party other than the parties hereto and the
    prospective purchasers have, or shall have, any lien, claim or
    security interest the Escrow Amounts or the Fund or any part
    thereof.

	    7.2 No financing statement under the Uniform Commercial Code
    is on file in any jurisdiction claiming a security interest in
    or describing (whether specifically or generally) the Escrow
    Amounts or the Fund or any part thereof.

	    7.3 The Subscription Information submitted with each deposit
    shall, at the time of submission and at the time of the
    disbursement of the Fund, be deemed a representation and
    warranty that such deposit represents a bona fide payment by the
    purchaser described therein for the amount of Securities set
    forth in such Subscription Information.

	    7.4 All of the information contained in the Information
    Sheet is, as of the date hereof, and will be, at any time of any
    disbursement of the Fund, true and correct.

    	8.  Fees and Expenses.  The Escrow Agent shall be entitled
    to the Escrow Agent Fees set forth on the Information Sheet,
    payable as and when stated therein.  In addition, the Issuer and
    the Underwriter jointly and severally agree to reimburse the
    Escrow Agent for any reasonable expenses incurred in connection
    with this Agreement, including, but not limited to, reasonable
    counsel fees.  Upon receipt of the Minimum Dollar Amount, the
    Escrow Agent shall have a lien upon the Fund to the extent of
    its fees for services as Escrow Agent.
	
	    9.  Indemnification and Contribution.
	
	    9.1 The Issuer and the Underwriter (collectively referred to
    as the "Indemnitors") jointly and severally agree to indemnify
    the Escrow Agent and its officers, directors, employees, agents
    and shareholders (collectively referred to as the "Indemnitees")
    against, and hold them harmless of and from, any and all loss,
    liability cost, damage and expense, including without
    limitation, reasonable counsel fees, which the Indemnitees may
    suffer or incur by reason of any action, claim or proceeding
    brought against the Indemnitees by a third party arising out of
    or relating in any way to this Agreement or any transaction to
    which this Agreement relates, unless such action, claim or
    proceeding is the result of the willful misconduct or gross
    negligence of the Indemnitees.

	    9.2 If the indemnification provided for in Section 9.1 is
    applicable, but for any reason is held to be unavailable, the
    Indemnitors shall contribute such amounts as are just and
    equitable to pay, or to reimburse the Indemnitees for, the
    aggregate of any and all losses, liabilities, costs, damages and
    expenses, including counsel fees, actually incurred by the
    Indemnitees as a result of or in connection with, and any amount
    paid in settlement of, any action, claim or proceeding arising
    out of or relating in any way to act actions or omissions of the
    Indemnitors.

	    9.3 The provisions of this Article 9 shall survive any
    termination of this Agreement, whether by disbursement of the
    Fund, resignation of the Escrow Agent or otherwise.

	    10.  Governing Law and Assignment.  This Agreement shall be
    construed in accordance with and governed by the laws of the
    State of New York and shall be binding upon the parties hereto
    and their respective successors and assigns; provided, however,
    that any assignment or transfer by any party of its rights under
    this Agreement or with respect to the Escrow Amounts or the Fund
    shall be valid upon the written consent of the parties hereto.

	    11.  Notices.  All notices required to be given in
    connection with this Agreement shall be sent by registered or
    certified mail, return receipt requested, or by hand delivery
    with receipt acknowledged, or by the Express Mail service
    offered by the United States Post Office, and addressed, if to
    the Issuer or the Underwriter, at their respective addresses set
    forth on the Information Sheet, and if to the Escrow Agent, at
    its address set forth above, to the attention of the Trust
    Department.

	    12.  Severability.  If any provision of this Agreement or
    the application thereof to any person or circumstances shall be
    determined to be invalid or unenforceable, the remaining
    provisions of this Agreement or the application of such
    provision to persons or circumstances other than those to which
    it is held invalid or unenforceable shall not be affected
    thereby and shall be valid and enforceable to the fullest extent
    permitted by law.

	    13.  Execution in Several Counterparts.  This Agreement may
    be executed in several counterparts or by separate instruments,
    and all of such counterparts and instruments shall constitute
    one agreement, binding on all of the parties hereto.
    

	    14.  Entire Agreement.  This agreement constitutes the
    entire agreement between the parties hereto with respect to the
    subject matter hereof and supersedes all prior agreements and
    understandings (written or oral) of the parties in connection
    therewith.  
    
    IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the undersigned have executed
    this Agreement as of the day and year first above written.

    THE ISSUER:  International Heritage, INC.		CONTINENTAL STOCK
							TRANSFER & TRUST COMPANY
						 
    By:     /s/ Stanley Van Etten
 
    THE UNDERWRITER: WIN CAPITAL CORPORATION
    By:  /s/Barry Hawk


    ESCROW AGREEMENT INFORMATION SHEET
     1.  The Issuer
    
         Name: International Heritage, Inc.
         Address:  2626 Glenwood Avenue, Suite 200, Raleigh, North
         Carolina 27608 State of incorporation or organization:
         North Carolina
    
     2.  The Underwriter
         Name:  WIN Capital Corporation Address:  26 Ludlam Avenue,
         Bayville, New York 11709 State of incorporation or
         organization:  New York

    3.  The Securities
         Description of the Securities to be offered (e.g., shares
         of or warrants for common stock, debentures, units
         consisting shares and warrants, etc.):  2,500,000 shares
         of common stock Par value, if any:  $0.001 Offering price
         per share/unit/other:  $10.00
    
 4.  Minimum Amounts Required for Disbursement of the Escrow Account
         Aggregate dollar amount which must be collected before the
            Escrow Account may be disbursed to the Issuer ("Minimum
            Dollar Amount"):  $5,000,000 Total amount of securities
            which must be subscribed for before the Escrow Account
            may be disbursed to the Issuer ("Minimum Securities
            Amount"):  500,000 shares

 5.  Plan of Distribution of the Securities
        Offering Period: 120 calendar days
         Extension Period, if any: none
         Collection Period if any:
         calendar/business days

 6.  Title of Escrow Account:  "Continental Stock Transfer & Trust
         Company, Escrow Agent for the offering by International
         Heritage, Inc."
         
 7.  Escrow Agent Fees
    Amount due on execution of the Escrow Agreement:  $1,000.00 and
    $1,000.00 upon completion of the escrow.  Fee for each check
    disbursed pursuant to the terms of the Escrow Agreement $ Fee
    for each cheek returned pursuant to the terms of the Escrow
    Agreement $







  		STOCK SUBSCRIPTION AGREEMENT
                INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                            
     ARTICLE I

                            SUBSCRIPTION
    The undersigned SUBSCRIBER, (the "SUBSCRIBER") hereby applies to
    subscribe to shares of Common Stock, (the "SHARES") of
    International Heritage, Inc., a North Carolina corporation (the
    "CORPORATION"), in consideration for Ten and 00/100 Dollars
    ($10.00) per share.  Enclosed with this application is a check
    payable to International Heritage, Inc., as a tender of the
    total purchase price of the shares subscribed for in the total
    sum of DOLLARS ($ ), in accordance with the terms and conditions
    of the Prospectus ( ) dated , 1996 (the "PROSPECTUS").


    THE SUBSCRIBER ACKNOWLEDGES THAT THE SHARES BEING SUBSCRIBED FOR
    HEREUNDER ARE OFFERED SUBJECT TO ALL OF THE TERMS AND CONDITIONS
    SET FORTH IN THE PROSPECTUS, A COPY OF WHICH THE SUBSCRIBER HAS
    BEEN FURNISHED.  THE SUBSCRIBER ALSO ACKNOWLEDGES THAT THIS
    SUBSCRIPTION AGREEMENT IS SUBJECT TO THE UNCONDITIONAL RIGHT OF
    THE CORPORATION TO ACCEPT OR REJECT THE SAME IN WHOLE OR PART.
    ACCEPTANCE SHALL BE EFFECTIVE UPON CORPORATION'S TRANSMITTAL OF
    NOTICE TO SUBSCRIBER AT THE ADDRESS SPECIFIED HEREIN.

                                 ARTICLE II
                       REPRESENTATIONS BY SUBSCRIBER

    A. The SUBSCRIBER has received and read the PROSPECTUS relating
    to this offering (the "OFFERING") of the SHARES, and has relied
    only on the information contained therein.

    B. The SUBSCRIBER understands that the PROSPECTUS is part of a
    Registration Statement filed with the Securities and Exchange
    Commission and the respective state regulatory divisions that
    regulate the sale of securities in Alabama, Florida, Georgia,
    Kansas, Louisiana, Maryland, North Carolina, Oklahoma, Oregon,
    Pennsylvania, South Carolina, Tennessee, Texas, and Virginia
    (the "DIVISION(s)") and that such registration does not
    constitute approval of the merits of this OFFERING by the
    respective Division nor does it indicate the offering is
    complete or accurate.

    C. The SUBSCRIBER (and the SUBSCRIBER's representative(s), (if
    any), has such knowledge and experience in financial and
    business matters as to be capable of evaluating the merits and
    risks of this investment which represents A SUBSTANTIAL RISK OF
    LOSS.  The SUBSCRIBER represents and warrants that:

    (1) the SUBSCRIBER has adequate means of providing for the
    SUBSCRIBER's current needs and possible personal contingencies:

    (2) the SUBSCRIBER has no need for liquidity with respect to
    this investment:

    (3) the SUBSCRIBER has no reason to anticipate any change in the
    SUBSCRIBER's personal circumstances, financial or otherwise,
    which may cause or require any sale or distribution of the
    SUBSCRIBER's SHARES; and

    (4) the SUBSCRIBER is able to bear the economic risk of this
    investment--specifically, the SUBSCRIBER is able to bear the
    COMPLETE LOSS OF THIS INVESTMENT (i.e., the full purchase price
    of the SUBSCRIBER's SHARES and any additional capital
    contributions, if applicable).

    D. The SUBSCRIBER (and the SUBSCRIBER's representative, if any),
    has been given:  (1) a copy of the PROSPECTUS, (2) any additional
    information requested, and (3) the opportunity to communicate
    directly with the officers and directors of the CORPORATION, in
    order to verify the accuracy of, or amplify upon, the
    information in the PROSPECTUS.

    E. SUBSCRIBER understands that SUBSCRIBER's payment will be
    deposited with Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company as
    CORPORATION's escrow agent (the "BANK") in connection with the
    CORPORATION'S best efforts offering and will not be released to
    CORPORATION until a minimum of $5,000,000 has been received by
    the BANK.  (A copy of the entire agreement will be provided to
    the Subscriber upon request.)  Once a minimum of $5,000,000 has
    been sold, the proceeds will be released to the CORPORATION by
    the BANK.  THEREAFTER, UPON THE COMPLETION OF THE OFFERING, ANY
    AND ALL AMOUNTS RECEIVED BY THE BANK IN EXCESS OF THE $5,000,000
    REFERRED TO ABOVE WILL BE RELEASED TO THE CORPORATION BY THE
    BANK.  IF THE MINIMUM OFFERING OF $5,000,000 IS NOT SOLD, THE
    BANK WILL RETURN TO EACH INVESTOR THE AMOUNT THAT INVESTOR
    INVESTED WITHOUT INTEREST.

    F. As a condition of the right to subscribe for the SHARES, the
    SUBSCRIBER acknowledges that the SHARES are offered solely by
    the PROSPECTUS, dated , 1996, and on the terms and conditions
    described herein.  IF ANY REPRESENTATIONS HAVE BEEN MADE OTHER
    THAN THOSE MADE IN THE PROSPECTUS, SUCH REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT
    BE RELIED ON AS HAVING

    BEEN AUTHORIZED BY THE CORPORATION.
              (initial)
              
      G.  I will hold title to my SHARES as follows:

         _____Community Property with___________

         _____Tenants in Common with ___________
   
     Joint Tenants, with Right of Survivorship, with _
                                  .
    Separate Property

    Other (corporation, partnership, trust, etc 
 (please indicate)
    (initial)



     Section 14 of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, (the
    "Act") provides that any condition, stipulation, or provision
    binding any person acquiring any security to waive compliance
    with any provision of the Act or of the rules and regulations of
    the Securities and Exchange Commission shall be void.

                               Signatory Page
                        (Corporation or Partnership)
                                      
    The undersigned, _________________________________________
    (herein "SUBSCRIBER") hereby certifies that the foregoing
    information is true and correct to the best of his/her knowledge
    and that he/she has read the entire Stock Subscription Agreement
    and has full authority to execute this document.

    DATED:		19       .   TIME:    
	NAME OF CORPORATION	
	OR PARTNERSHIP

    Signature: BY:
    Printed Name:
    Title:

     Address to which correspondence 
     should be directed:
     Street:
     City:                          State:               Zip:
     Telephone:
     Tax Identification:

    WHEN COMPLETED AND SIGNED THIS SUBSCRIPTION AGREEMENT AND THE 
    SUBSCRIBER'S CHECK SHOULD BE DELIVERED TO:
    International Heritage, Inc.
    2626 Glenwood Avenue: Suite 200
    Raleigh. North Carolina 27608
    
    MAKE CHECK PAYABLE TO: CONTINENTAL STOCK TRANSFER & TRUST COMPANY, 
    N.A., Escrow Account






    Section 14 of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, (the 
    "Act") provides that any condition, stipulation, or provision binding 
    any person acquiring any security to waive compliance with any 
    provision of the Act or of the rules and regulations of the 
    Securities and Exchange Commission shall be void.

                               Signatory Page
                        	     (Individual)
                                      
    The undersigned, _________________________________________ 
    (herein "SUBSCRIBER") hereby certifies that the foregoing information 
    is true and correct to the best of his/her knowledge and that he/she 
    has read the entire Stock Subscription Agreement and has full 
    authority to execute this document.

    DATED:		19       .   TIME:    

    Signature: BY:
    Printed Name:
    Title:

    Address to which correspondence 
    should be directed:
    Street:
    City:                          State:               Zip:
    Telephone:
    Tax Identification:
    Social Security Number:  

    WHEN COMPLETED AND SIGNED THIS SUBSCRIPTION AGREEMENT AND THE 
    SUBSCRIBER'S CHECK SHOULD BE DELIVERED TO:
    International Heritage, Inc.
    2626 Glenwood Avenue: Suite 200
    Raleigh. North Carolina 27608
    
    MAKE CHECK PAYABLE TO: CONTINENTAL STOCK TRANSFER & TRUST COMPANY, 
    N.A., Escrow Account

 





 			   ACCEPTANCE BY CORPORATION
    International Heritage, Inc., a North Carolina 
    corporation, having offered SHARES of its Common Stock (par 
    value $.001 per share) and being authorized to issue the same 
    to the SUBSCRIBER mentioned in the foregoing Stock 
    Subscription Agreement (the "SUBSCRIPTION") in the amount 
    therein set forth, and based upon the representations and 
    warranties made by the SUBSCRIBER in that SUBSCRIPTION, hereby 
    acknowledges receipt of contributions in the amount of $10.00 
    per share for value, accepts the SUBSCRIPTION, and agrees to 
    issue said SHARES to SUBSCRIBER.


     DATED this _____ day of	______	, 19____.
    
    
    Attest: INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
    
    
    
    Stanley H. VanEtten, President







			THE ESCROW AGENT FOR THE OFFERING IS:

                        CONTINENTAL STOCK TRANSFER & TRUST 
                                  COMPANY
                                      
                                      
                   ALL CHECKS ARE TO BE MADE PAYABLE TO:
    
    
    CONTINENTAL STOCR TRANSFER & TRUST COMPANY, AS ESCROW AGENT FOR
    THE OFFERING BY INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
         
    THE UNDERSIGNED ACKNOWLEDGES THAT CONTINENTAL STOCK 
    TRANSFER AND TRUST COMPANY IS ACTING ONLY AS AN ESCROW AGENT 
    IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFERING OF THE SECURITIES DESCRIBED 
    HERE AND HAS NOT ENDORSED, RECOMMENDED OR GUARANTEED THE 
    PURCHASE, VALUE OR REPAYMENT OF SUCH SECURITIES.
    
    
    
    ____________________________________
    SUBSCRIBER(S)

    Exhibit 1.1


                                  WOOD & FRANCIS, PLLC
                                                                               
                                            
                             ATTORNEYS & COUNSELORS AT LAW
                                            
BRENT E. WOOD              TWO HANNOVER SQUARE          MAILING ADDRESS:
CHARLES T. FRANCIS     434 FAYETVILLLE STREET MALL      Post Office Box 164
LORI G. CHRISTIAN                SUITE 2300             Raleigh, NC 27602
VICTOR  S. LEE           RALEIGH, NORTH CAROLINA 27601

                               TELEPHONE (919) 828-0801
                               TELECOPY (919) 828-0804
                                  September 3, 1996
    
    
    International Heritage, Inc.
    2626 Glenwood Avenue, Suite 200
    Raleigh, North Carolina 27608

    Re: International Heritage, Inc.

    Gentlemen:
	
	We have represented International Heritage, Inc. (the "Company") in
    connection with its preparation of a Registration Statement on
    Form S- 1 and filing of such Registration Statement on Form S-1
    and filing of such Registration Statement with the Securities
    and Exchange Commission covering the offering (the "Offering")
    of shares of Common Stock (the "Common Stock") of the Company.

    We advise you that in our opinion, when the Common Stock is
    issued pursuant to the Offering, such Common Stock will be
    legally issued, fully paid and non assessable shares of Common
    Stock of the Company.

	We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to the
    Registration Statement (File No. 333-5268) relating to Common
    Stock referred to above and to the use of our name and to the
    references to our firm in said Registration Statement.
    
    
    Very truly yours,
    WOOD & FRANCIS, PLLC
    By: /s/ Charles T. Francis
               Charles T. Francis

    Exhibit 5.1
        



        STATE OF
	NORTH 			Department Of The
        CAROLINA                Secretary of State

	To all whom these presents shall come, Greetings:

	I, Rufus L. Edmisten, Secretary of State of the State of 
	North Carolina, do hereby certify the following and hereto
 	attached to be a true copy of

			ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION
				OF
			INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.

        the original of which was filed in this office on the 28th day of 
        April, 1995.




			IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I have herunto set my
			hand and affixed my official seal at the City of 
			Raleigh, this 28th day of April, 1995.

			/s/ Rufus L. Edmisten
			     Secretary of State


	Exhibit 3.1



                                                  C. 0367869
																								  F I L E D
                                                9:00 AM
                                                April 28, 1995
                                                EFFECTIVE
                                                RUFUS EDMINSTEN

						
			         ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION 
                                           OF
			        INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC
                                              


	    Pursuant to North Carolina General Statute  55-2-02, the
    undersigned does hereby submit these Articles of Incorporation
    for the purpose of forming a business corporation.



	                                ARTICLE 1: NAME

          	The name of the Corporation is INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                        

	                              ARTICLE 11: DURATION

            	The Corporation shall have perpetual existence.

	                        ARTICLE 111: PURPOSE AND POWERS

	To Conduct Business To own, operate, manage and/or administer
    any legal corporate entity, more specifically, but not limited
    to, a multi-level marketing company.  Initially, the company
    shall own, operate and manage a multi-level marketing company.
    
    	To Act As Agent To manage or administer as agent the
    business of property of any corporation, firm, or person
    carrying on any authorized business and to sell or dispose of,
    receive and make disbursements for, or arrange for the
    management or administration of the whole or any part of the
    business or property of any corporation, firm, or person, and to
    act as agent, broker, consignee, or factor of others in buying
    and selling all manner and kind of goods, and to make contracts
    with others in reference to the handling and disposing of the
    same, and to deliver goods on bills of lading in the name of
    this Corporation, to draw drafts against such bills of lading,
    and to carry insurance in the name of this Corporation on goods
    consigned for sale, and to develop and extend the business
    interests of any corporation, firm, or person.
    
    	To Borrow Money To borrow or raise money without limit as to
    amount; to sell, create security interests in, pledge, and
    otherwise dispose of and realize upon book accounts and other
    choses in action; to make, draw, accept, endorse, execute, and
    issue bonds, debentures, notes, or other obligations of any
    nature or in any manner for money borrowed or in payment for
    property purchased or for any other of the objects or purposes
    of this Corporation, and to secure the principal thereof and the
    interest thereon by mortgage upon, or creation of security
    interests in, all or any part of the Corporation's property.
    
    	To Make Contracts To enter into, make, perform, and carry
        out contracts of every sort and kind which may be necessary
        or convenient for the business of the Corporation, or
        business of a similar nature, with any person, corporation,
        private, public or municipal body politic under the
        government of the United States, or any state, territory, or
        possession thereof, or any foreign government so far as and
        to the extent that the same may be done and performed by
        corporations organized under the Business Corporation laws
        of any state, territory, dependency, or possession of the
        United States, and in any foreign country.
	
	 To Enter into Partnership Arrangements To enter into any
        partnership, limited or general, as limited or general
        partner, or both, and to enter into any other arrangement
        for sharing profits, union of interest, unitization or
        farmout agreement, reciprocal concession, or cooperation,
        with any corporation, association, partnership, syndicate,
        entity, person, or governmental, municipal, or public
        authority, domestic or foreign, in the carrying on of any
        business which this Corporation is authorized to carry on,
        or any business or transaction deemed necessary, convenient,
        or incidental to carrying out any of the purposes of this
        Corporation.

	To Deal in Property in General To acquire, own, hold, improve,
        develop, operate, exploit, sell, convey, assign, lease,
        exchange, transfer, dispose of, pledge, mortgage, create
        security interests in, deal in, and loan or borrow money
        upon, alone or in conjunction with others, real and personal
        property, tangible and intangible, of every kind, character,
        and description, or any interest therein, and all kinds and
        forms of securities, shares of capital stock, scrip, bonds,
        debentures, coupons, mortgages, notes, bills of exchange,
        acceptances, assignments, accounts, fees, evidences of
        indebtedness, obligations, trust certificated, interim
        receipts, warrants, and certificates issued or created by or
        being claims against any corporation, association,
        partnership, syndicate, entity, or person, or governmental,
        municipal, or public subdivision, district or authority.

        To Acquire Real Property To acquire by purchase, lease, gift,
        devise, or otherwise, and to own, use, hold, sell, convey,
        exchange, lease, mortgage, work, improve, develop, divide,
        and otherwise handle, deal in, and dispose of real estate,
        real property, and any interest or right therein, whether as
        principal, agent, broker, or otherwise, and to manage,
        operate, service, equip, furnish, alter, and keep in repair
        real and personal property of every kind, nature and
        description, whether as principal, agent, broker or
        otherwise, and generally to do anything and everything
        necessary and proper, and to the extent permitted by law, in
        connection with the owning, managing, leasing and operating
        real and personal property of any and all kinds.
       
       To Deal in All Classes of Property To acquire by purchase,
       exchange, lease, or otherwise, and to own, hold, use,
       develop, operate, sell, assign, lease, transfer, convey,
       exchange, mortgage, create security interests in, pledge, or
       otherwise dispose of, deal in and with, real and personal
       property of every class or description and rights and
       privileges therein wheresoever situate.
       
       To Mortgage Assets To borrow money and contract debts; to make,
       issue, and dispose of bonds, debentures, notes, and other
       obligations, secured or unsecured; and to make any lawful
       contract of guaranty, suretyship, or of any kind whatsoever
       in connection with, or in aid of, any corporation or other
       organizations any of whose securities this Corporation owns or
       in which this Corporation has an interest; to secure contracts,
       obligations, and liabilites or any thereof, in whole or in part,
       by mortgage, deed of trust, creation of security intersts in,
       pledge, or other lien, upon any or all the property of this
       Corporation wheresoever situated, acquired, or to be acquired.

 To Deal in its Own Share To purchase, hold, cancel reissue, sell,
       exchange, transfer, or otherwise deal any of its outstanding
       shares from time to time to such an extent and in such manner
       and upon such terms as the Board of Directors of the
       Corporation shall determine; provided that this Corporation
       shall not use its funds or property for the purchase of its
       own shares when such use would cause any impairment of its
       capital, except to the extent permitted by law; and provided
       further that shares of the Corporation belonging to it shall
       not be voted upon directly or indirectly.
       
 To Invest Corporate Funds To invest and deal with the funds of this
       Corporation in any manner, and to acquire by purchase or
       otherwise the stocks, bonds, notes, debentures and other
       securities and obligations of any government, state,
       municipality, corporation, association or partnership,
       domestic or foreign and, while owner of any such securities
       or obligations, to exercise all the rights, powers, and
       privileges of ownership, including among other things the
       right to vote thereon for any and all purposes.  
       
To Invest in the Shares of Other Corporations Subject to the
       restrictions or limitations imposed by law, to purchase or
       otherwise acquire, hold, sell, assign, transfer, create
       security interests in, pledge, exchange, or otherwise dispose
       of the shares, bonds, obligations, or other securities and
       evidences of indebtedness of other corporations, domestic and
       foreign, and the goodwill, rights, assets and property of any
       and every kind or any part thereof, of any person, firm, or
       corporation, domestic or foreign, and if desirable to issue
       in exchange therefor the shares, bonds, or other obligations
       of this Corporation, and while the owner of such shares to
       exercise all rights, powers, and privileges of ownership,
       including the power to vote thereon; and in furtherance of
       the corporate purposes, in the course of the transaction of
       the business and affairs of this Corporation, to acquire real
       and personal property, rights and interests of every nature,
       and to execute and issue bonds, debentures, and other
       negotiable or transferable instruments, and to mortgage and
       create a security interest in, or pledge, any or all of the
       property of the Corporation; to secure such bonds,
       debentures, or other instruments, upon such terms and
       conditions as may be set forth in the instrument or
       instruments, mortgaging, creating a security interest in, or
       pledging the same, or in any deed, contract or other
       instrument relating thereto.
       
 To Acquire Other Businesses To acquire, by purchase, exchange, or
        otherwise, all or any part of, or any interest in, the
        property, assets, business, and goodwill of any one or more
        persons, firms, associations, or corporations heretofore or
        hereinafter engaged in any business for which a corporation
        may now or hereafter be organized under the laws of this or
        any other state or country; to pay for the same in cash,
        property, its own or other securities; to hold, operate,
        reorganize, liquidate, sell, or in any manner dispose of the
        whole or any part thereof; and in connection therewith, to
        assume or guarantee performance of any liabilities,
        obligations, or contracts of such persons, firms,
        associations, or corporations, and to conduct the whole or
        part of any business thus acquired.
        
 To Assist Other Corporations To aid in any manner any corporation,
        association, or trust estate, domestic or foreign, or any
        firm or individual, any shares of stock in which or any
        bonds, debentures, notes, securities, evidences of
        indebtedness, contracts, or obligations of which are hold by
        or for this Corporation, directly or indirectly, or in
        which, or in the welfare of which, this Corporation shall
        have any interest and to do any acts designed to protect,
        preserve, improve, or enhance the value of any property at
        any time held or controlled by it or in which it may be at
        any time interested, directly or indirectly or through other
        corporations or otherwise; and to organize or promote or
        facilitate the organization of any corporation, association,
        partnership, syndicate, or entity, domestic or foreign.
        

 To Organize Other Corporations To organize or cause to be
        organized under the laws of any state of the United States,
        or of the District of Columbia, or of any territory,
        dependency, or possession of the United States, or of any
        foreign country, a corporation or corporations for the
        purpose of transacting, promoting, or carrying on any or all
        of the objects or purposes for which this Corporation is
        organized, and to dissolve, wind up, liquidate, merge, or
        consolidate any such corporation or corporations or to cause
        the same to be dissolved, wound up, liquidated, merged or
        consolidated.

To Vote Shares in Other Corporations Shares in other corporations
        held by this Corporation shall be voted by such Officer or
        Officers of this Corporation as the Board of Directors, by a
        majority vote, shall designate for that purpose, or by a
        proxy thereunto duly authorized by like vote of such Board,
        except as otherwise ordered by vote of the holders of a
        majority of the shares outstanding and entitled to vote.


 To Act as a Holding Company To purchase, own and hold the stock of
        other corporations, and to do every act and thing covered
        generally by the denomination "holding corporation," and
        especially to direct the operations of other corporations
        through the ownership of stock therein; to purchase,
        subscribe for, acquire, own, hold, sell, exchange, assign,
        transfer, create security interests in, pledge, or otherwise
        dispose of shares or voting trust certificates for shares of
        the capital stock, or any bonds, notes, securities, or
        evidences of indebtedness created by any other corporation
        or corporations organized under the laws of this state or
        any other state or district or country, nation, or
        government, and also bonds or evidences of indebtedness of
        the United States or of any state, district, territory,
        dependency or country or subdivision or municipality
        thereof; to issue in exchange thereof shares of the capital
        stock, bonds, notes or other obligations of the Corporation
        and while the owner thereof, to exercise all the rights,
        powers, and privileges of ownership including the right to
        vote on any shares of stock or voting trust certificates so
        owned; to promote, lend money to, and guarantee the
        dividends, stocks, bonds, notes, evidences of indebtedness,
        contracts or other obligations, of and otherwise aid in any
        manner which shall be lawful, any corporation or association
        of which any bonds, stocks, voting trust certificates, or
        other securities or evidences of indebtedness shall be held
        by or for this Corporation, or in which, or in the welfare
        of which, this Corporation shall have any interest, and to
        do any acts and things permitted by law and designated to
        protect, preserve, improve, or enhance the value of any such
        bonds, stocks, or other securities or evidences of
        indebtedness of the property of this Corporation.

 To Act Outside the State To carry on its operations and conduct
        business in any state, district, territory, dependency, or
        possession of the United States, and in any foreign country.
        

 To Engage in Any Lawful Act To engage in any lawful act or activity
        for which corporation may be organized under the North
        Carolina Business Corporation Act.
        

 Construction of Power Clauses The foregoing clauses shall be
        construed as and shall be powers as well as purposes, and
        the matters expressed in each clause shall, unless otherwise
        herein expressly provided, be in no wise limited by
        reference to or reference from the terms of any other clause
        but shall be regarded as independent powers and purposes; and
        the enumeration of specific powers and purposes shall not be
        construed to limit or restrict in any manner the meaning of
        general terms or other general powers of this Corporation,
        nor shall the expression of one thing be deemed to exclude
        another not expressed, although it be of like nature.  This
        Corporation shall be authorized by the North Carolina
        Business Corporation Act, and all the powers conferred by
        all acts heretofore or hereafter amendatory of or
        supplemental to that statute, and the enumeration of certain
        powers as herein specified is not intended as exclusive of
        or, as a waiver of any of the powers, rights, or privileges
        granted or conferred by that statute now or hereafter in
        force; provided, however, that nothing herein contained
        shall be deemed to authorize or permit this Corporation to
        carry on any business, to exercise any power, or to do any
        act which a corporation formed under that statute may not at
        the time lawfully carry on or do.
        
                      ARTICLE IV: CAPITAL STOCK
        	Authorized Shares The maximum number of shares of stock
        of the Corporation that may be issued is one-thousand ( 1
        ,000) shares, consisting of one-thousand (1,000) shares of
        Class A Common, voting shares with $0.01 par value.  The
        stated capital of the Corporation shall be at least equal to
        the sum of the aggregate amount of consideration received by
        the Corporation for the issuance of shares plus such amounts
        as, from time to time, by resolution of the Board of
        Directors may be transferred thereto.
        
        	Authority to Issue Warrants The Corporation is hereby
        expressly authorized and empowered, from time to time, by
        resolution of its Board of Directors, to create and issue,
        whether or not in connection with the issue and sale of any
        shares or other securities of the Corporation, rights or
        options entitling the holders or owners thereof to purchase
        or acquire from Corporation any shares of any class or
        series or other securities, whether now or hereafter
        authorized, such rights or options to be evidenced by or in
        such warrants or other instruments as shall be approved by
        the Board of Directors.  The terms upon which, the time or
        times, which may be limited or unlimited in duration, at or
        within which, and the price or prices at which any such
        shares or other securities may be purchased or acquired from
        the Corporation upon the exercise of any such rights or
        options shall be such as shall be fixed in a resolution or
        resolutions adopted by the Board of Directors providing for
        the creation and issue of such rights or option, and set
        forth or incorporated by reference in the warrants or other
        instruments evidencing such rights or options, and as shall
        be permitted by law.  The Board of Directors is hereby
        authorized and empowered to authorize the creation and issue
        of any such rights or options and any such warrant or other
        instruments from time to time, for such consideration as the
        Board of Directors may determine.  Any and all shares which
        may be purchased or acquired or issued upon the exercise of
        any such right or option shall be deemed fully paid shares
        and not liable to any further call or assessment, as the
        terms of the warrants or other instruments evidencing such
        rights or options shall provide.  Except as otherwise
        provided by law, the Board of Directors shall have full
        power and discretion to prescribe and regulate from time to
        time the procedure to be following in, and other matters
        concerning, the creation, issue, and exercise of any such
        rights and options and such warrants or other instruments,
        and the setting aside of shares of other securities for the
        purpose thereof, and the issuance of such shares or other
        securities upon the exercise thereof.

        Unissued Shares The Corporation may, at any time and from
        time to time, issue and dispose of any of the authorized and
        unissued shares of the stated capital of the Corporation for
        such consideration as may be fixed by the Board of Directors,
        subject to any provisions of law then applicable, and subject
        to the provisions of any resolutions of the shareholders of the
        Corporation relating thereto.
        
                      	          CLASS A COMMON STOCK
        Voting Rights Each holder of shares of Class A Common Stock
        shall be entitled to one vote for each share held, and as
        such shall be entitled to notice of all shareholder meetings
        of Corporation as set forth more specifically in the Bylaws
        of Corporation.
        
        Dividends The Board of Directors, in its discretion, may
        declare and pay dividends on the common stock concurrently
        with dividends on the preferred stock for any dividend
        period of any fiscal year when such dividends are applicable
        to the common stock; provided, that all accumulated
        dividends on the preferred stock of the previous dividend
        periods for the current fiscal year have been paid in full.
        
              	              ARTICLE V: PREEMPTIVE RIGHTS
        Every shareholder, upon the sale for cash of any additional
        stock of the Corporation of the same kind, class, or series
        as that which he already holds, shall have the right to
        purchase his pro rata share thereof (or as nearly as may be
        done without issuance of fractional shares) at the price at
        which such stock is offered to others.

                  ARTICLE VI: INITIAL REGISTERED OFFICE AND AGENT
        	The street address and county of the original registered
        office of the Corporation is:  2626 Glenwood Avenue, Suite
        300, Raleigh, Wake County, North Carolina 27608, and the
        name of the initial registered agent of this Corporation at
        that address is Stanley H. Van Ettten.
        

                      ARTICLE VII: INITIAL BOARD OF DIRECTORS
        The Corporation shall have three (3) directors initially.
        The number of directors may be either increased or decreased
        from time to time in accordance with the Bylaws, but shall
        never be fewer than one (1).  The names of the initial
        directors of the Corporation are:  Stanley H. Van Etten,
        Claude Savage, and Larry Smith.  All corporate powers shall
        be exercised by or under the authority of, and the business
        and affairs of the Corporation managed under the direction
        of the Board of Directors, except as may be otherwise
        limited by these Articles of Incorporation or Bylaws of
        Corporation.
        
                      ARTICLE VllI: OFFICERS
        The Officers of the Corporation shall be elected by the
        Board of Directors of the Corporation at a meeting to be
        held immediately following each annual meeting of the
        shareholders.  New offices may be created, and appointment
        may be made therefor, and any office that may become vacant
        may be filled by the Board of Directors of the Corporation
        at any regular meeting or at any special meeting called for
        that purpose.  The duties of the Officers of the Corporation
        shall be prescribed by the Bylaws.

             ARTICLE IX: INDEMNIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND OFFICERS
        Each Director and Officer in consideration for his services,
        shall be indemnified, whether then in office or not, for the
        reasonable costs and expenses incurred by him in connection
        with the defense of, or for advice concerning, any claim
        asserted or proceeding brought against him by reason of his
        being or having been a Director or Officer of the
        Corporation, whether or not wholly owned or by reason of any
        act or omission to act as such Director or Officer, provided
        that he shall not have been derelict in the performance of
        his duty as to the matter or matters in respect of which
        claim is asserted or proceeding brought.  The foregoing
        right of indemnification shall not be exclusive, but shall
        expressly be in addition to, any other rights which any
        Director or Officer may be entitled to as a matter of law.
        
 
                    ARTICLE X: INTERESTED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
 	       No contract or other transaction between the Corporation
        and any other firm or corporation shall be affected or
        invalidated by reason of the fact that any one or more of
        the Directors or Officers of this Corporation is, or are
        interested in, or is a member, shareholder, Director, or
        Officer, or are members, shareholders, Directors or Officers
        of such other firm, partnership, association or corporation;
        and any Director or Officer or Officers, individually or
        jointly, may be a party or parties to, or may be interested
        in, any contract or transaction of this Corporation, shall
        be affected or invalidated by reason of the fact that any
        Director or Directors or Officer or Officers of this
        Corporation is a party to parties to, or are interested in
        such contract, act or association or corporation, and each
        and every person who may become a Director or Officer of
        this Corporation is hereby relieved from any liability that
        might otherwise exist from thus contracting with this
        Corporation for the benefit of himself or any firm,
        partnership, association or corporation in which he may be
        in anywise interested.

                              ARTICLE XI: INCORPORATOR

             The name of the person signing these Articles is:
                             Stanley H. Van Etten
                             Mayflower Holdings, Inc
                             2626 Glenwood Avenue
                             Suite 300
                             Raleigh, North Carolina 27608

                         ARTICLE XII: BYLAWS
                 The power the adopt, alter, amend or repeal Bylaws
        not inconsistent with these Articles of Incorporation is
        vested in the Board of Directors of the Corporation.

                        ARTICLE XIII: AMENDMENT
        The Corporation reserves the right to amend, alter, change
        or repeal any provisions contained in these Articles of
        Incorporation in the manner now or hereafter prescribed by
        law, and all rights and powers conferred herein on
        shareholders, Directors, or Officers are subject to this
        reserved power.

               IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I have hereunto set my hand, and
        acknowledge the filing of the foregoing Articles of
        Incorporation under the laws of the State of North Carolina.
       
             This the 28th day of April, 1995.
                                            
                                       /s/ Stanley Van Etten 
                                        Stanley Van Etten, Incorporator 






STATE OF 
	NORTH 			Department Of The
	 CAROLINA    		          Secretary of State

	To all whom these presents shall come, Greetings:

	I, JANICE H. FAULKNER, Secretary of State of the State of 
	North Carolina, do hereby certify the following and hereto
 	attached to be a true copy of

		ARTICLES OF AMENDMENT
		              OF
                      INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.

        the original of which was filed in this office on the 2nd day of 
        July, 1996.




			IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I have herunto set my
			hand and affixed my official seal at the City of 
			Raleigh, this 2nd day of July, 1996.

			/s/ Janice H. Faulkner
			     Secretary of State

    
							C-0367869 
                                       State of North Carolina
                                      Department of the secretary of State 
                                      ARTICLES OF AMENDMENT
                      					
       Pursuant to 55-10-06 of the General Statutes of North Carolina,
       the undersigned corporation hereby submits the following
       Articles of Amendment for the purpose of amending its
       Articles of Incorporation.

       1. The name of the corporation is: International Heritage

       2. The text of each amendment adopted is as follows:
			Article IV; Capital Stock, the paragraph entitled
        	Authorized Shares shall be deleted in its entirety and
        	in lieu thereof shall be added a new paragraph which
        	shall read as follows:

         	Authorized Shares - The maximum number of shares of
           	stock of the Corporation that may be issued is
           	Twenty-Five Million (25,000,000) shares, consisting of
           	common, voting shares with $.01 par value.  Stated
           	capital of the Corporation shall be at least equal to
           	the sum of the aggregate amount of consideration and
           	received by the Corporation for the issuance of shares
           	plus such amounts as, from time to time, by resolution
           	of the Board of Directors, may be transferred thereto.
            
        3.  If an amendment provides for an exchange,
			reclassification, or cancellation of issued shares,
			provisions for implementing the amendment, if not
			contained in the amendment itself, are as follows:

            There is no provision for an exchange,
			reclassification, or cancellation of issued shares.
	
       4.  The date adoption of each amendment was as follows:  
       		July 1, 1996.

       5. (Check either a, b, c, or d, whichever is applicable)
		a.  The amendment(s) was (were) duly adopted by the
            incorporator[ors] prior to the issuance of
            shares. 
        b.  The amendment(s) was (were) duly
             adopted by the board of directors prior to the
             issuance of shares. 
        c.  The amendments(s) was (were) duly adopted by the board
             of directors without shareholder approval as a
            shareholder approval was not required because
            (set forth a brief explanation of why
             shareholder action was not required)
  

                                 ARTICLES OF AMENDMENT
                                         Page 2
                                            
	        d.  X The amendment(s) was (were) approved by
                      shareholder action, and such shareholder
                      approval was obtained as required by Chapter
                      55 of the North Carolina General Statutes.

         6.  These articles will be effective upon
			 filing, unless a delayed time and date is specified:

             This the 1st day of July, 1996
        
		         CORPORATIONS DIVISION
                                      INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE INC.
                                      By:  /s/ Stanley H. Van Etten
                                      Stanley H. Van Etten, President

      Exhibit 3.1

      
                                  BYLAWS
                                    OF
                 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
			    INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                 * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *.* *
                ARTICLE I.OFFICES
	        Section 1.  Principal office.  The principal office of
        the corporation shall be located at such place as the Board
        of Directors may fix from time to time.
        
	        Section 2.  Registered office.  The registered office of
        the corporation required by law to be maintained in the
        State of North Carolina may be, but need not be, identical
        with the principal office.
	
	        Section 3.  Other offices.  The corporation may have
        offices at such other places, either within or without the
        State of North Carolina, as the Board of Directors may
        designate or as the affairs of the corporation may require
        from time to time.
        
              		                         ARTICLE II.
	                                MEETINGS OF SHAREHOLDERS
	 Section 1.  Place of meetings.  All meetings of shareholders
        shall be held at the principal office of the corporation, or
        at such other place, either within or without the State of
        North Carolina, as shall in each case be (i) fixed by the
        President, the Secretary, or the Board of Directors and
        designated in the notice of the meeting or (ii) agreed upon
        by a majority of the shareholders entitled to vote at the
        meeting.
        

	 Section 2.  Annual meetings.  The annual meeting of
        shareholders shall be held each year at 11:00 o'clock A.M.
        on the second Monday of the first month following the month
        in which the corporation's accounting year ends for the
        purpose of electing directors of the corporation and for the
        transaction of such other business as may be properly
        brought before the meeting.  If the day fixed for the annual
        meeting shall be a legal holiday, such meeting shall be held
        on the next succeeding business day.
        
               Section 3.  Substitute annual meeting.  If the annual
        meeting shall not be held on the day designated by these
        bylaws, a substitute annual meeting may be called in
        accordance with the provisions of Section 4 of this Article
        II.  A meeting so called shall be designated and treated for
        all purposes as the annual meeting.
        
       
               Section 4.  Special meetings.  Special meetings of the
        shareholders may be called at any time by the President, the
        Secretary, or the Board of Directors, and shall be called
        pursuant to the written request of the holders of not less
        than one-tenth of all the votes entitled to be cast on any
        issue proposed to be considered at the meeting.

	Section 5.  Notice of meetings.  Written notice stating the
        date, time, and place of the meeting shall be given not less
        than ten (10) nor more than sixty (60) days before the date
        of any shareholders' meeting, either by personal delivery,
        or by telegraph, teletype, or other form of wire or wireless
        communication, or by facsimile transmission or by mail or
        private carrier, by or at the direction of the Board of
        Directors, the President, the Secretary, or other person
        calling the meeting, to each shareholder entitled to vote at
        such meeting; provided that such notice must be given to all
        shareholders with respect to any meeting at which a merger
        or share exchange is to be considered and in such other
        instances as required by law.  If mailed, such notice shall
        be deemed to be effective when deposited in the United
        States mail, correctly addressed to the shareholder at the
        shareholder's address as it appears on the current record of
        shareholders of the corporation, with postage thereon
        prepaid.

        In the case of a special meeting, the notice of meeting
        shall include a description of the purpose or purposes for
        which the meeting is called; but, in the case of an annual
        or substitute annual meeting, the notice of meeting need not
        include a description of the purpose or purposes for which
        the meeting is called unless such a description is required
        by the provisions of the North Carolina Business Corporation
        Act.

        When a meeting is adjourned to a different date, time, or
        place, notice need not be given of the new date, time, or
        place if the new date, time, or place is announced at the
        meeting before adjournment and if a new record date is not
        fixed for the adjourned meeting; but if a new record date is
        fixed for the adjourned meeting (which must be done if the
        new date is more than one hundred twenty (120) days after
        the date of the original meeting), notice of the adjourned
        meeting must be given as provided in this section to persons
        who are shareholders as of the new record date.

        	Section 6.  Waiver of notice.  Any shareholder may waive
        notice of any meeting before or after the meeting.  The
        waiver must be in writing, signed by the shareholder, and
        delivered to the corporation for inclusion in the minutes or
        filing with the corporate records.  A shareholder's
        attendance, in person or by proxy, at a meeting (a) waives
        objection to lack of notice or defective notice of the
        meeting, unless the shareholder or his proxy at the
        beginning of the meeting objects to holding the meeting or
        transacting business at the meeting, and (b) waives
        objection to consideration of a particular matter at the
        meeting that is not within the purpose or purposes described
        in the meeting notice, unless the shareholder or his proxy
        objects to considering the matter before it is voted upon.

         	Section 7.  Shareholders' list.  Before each meeting of
         shareholders, the Secretary of the corporation shall
         prepare an alphabetical list of the shareholders entitled
         to notice of such meeting.  The list shall be arranged by
         voting group (and within each voting group by class or
         series of shares) and show the address of and number of
         shares held by each shareholder.  The list shall be kept on
         file at the principal office of the corporation, or at a
         place identified in the meeting notice in the city where
         the meeting will be held, for the period beginning two (2)
         business days after notice of the meeting is given and
         continuing through the meeting, and shall be available for
         inspection by any shareholder, his agent or attorney, at
         any time during regular business hours.  The list shall
         also be available at the meeting and shall be subject to
         inspection by any shareholder, his agent or attorney, at
         any time during the meeting or any adjournment thereof.

	 Section 8.  Voting group.  All shares of one or more classes or
        series that under the articles of incorporation or the North
        Carolina Business Corporation Act are entitled to vote and
        be counted together collectively on a matter at a meeting of
        shareholders constitute a voting group.  All shares entitled
        by the articles of incorporation or the North Carolina
        Business Corporation Act to vote generally on a matter are
        for that purpose a single voting group.  Classes or series
        of shares shall not be entitled to vote separately by voting
        group unless expressly authorized by the articles of
        incorporation or specifically required by law.
        

 	 Section 9.  Quorum.  Shares entitled to vote as a separate
        voting group may take action on a matter at the meeting only
        if a quorum of those shares exists, in person or by proxy.
        A majority of the votes entitled to be cast on the matter by
        the voting group constitutes a quorum of that voting group
        for action on that matter.
        
        	Once a share is represented for any purpose at a
        meeting, it is deemed present for quorum purposes for the
        remainder of the meeting and for any adjournment of that
        meeting unless a new record date is or must be set for that
        adjourned meeting.

	In the absence of a quorum at the opening of any meeting of
        shareholders, such meeting may be adjourned from time to
        time by the vote of a majority of the votes cast on the
        motion to adjourn; and, subject to the provisions of Section
        5 of this Article II, at any adjourned meeting any business
        may be transacted that might have been transacted at the
        original meeting if a quorum exists with respect to the
        matter proposed.

	 Section 10.  Proxies.  Shares may be voted either in person or
        by one (1) or more proxies authorized by a written
        appointment of proxy signed by the shareholder or by his
        duly authorized attorney in fact.  An appointment of proxy
        is valid for eleven (11) months from the date of its
        execution, unless a different period is expressly provided
        in the appointment form.
        
        	Section 11.  Voting of shares.  Subject to the
        provisions of the articles of incorporation, each
        outstanding share shall be entitled to one vote on each
        matter voted on at a meeting of shareholders.
        
        	Except in the election of directors as governed by the
        provisions of Section 3 of Article III, if a quorum exists,
        action on a matter by a voting group is approved if the
        votes cast within the voting group favoring the action
        exceed the votes cast opposing the action, unless a greater
        vote is required by law or the articles of incorporation or
        these bylaws.
        
	Absent special circumstances, shares of the corporation are not
        entitled to vote if they are owned, directly or indirectly,
        by another corporation in which the corporation owns,
        directly or indirectly, a majority of the shares entitled to
        vote for directors of the second corporation; provided that
        this provision does not limit the power of the corporation
        to vote its own shares held by it in a fiduciary capacity.
 
        	Section 12.  Informal action by shareholders.  Any
        action that is required or permitted to be taken at a
        meeting of the shareholders may be taken without a meeting
        if one (1) or more written consents, describing the action
        so taken, shall be signed by all of the shareholders who
        would be entitled to vote upon such action at a meeting, and
        delivered to the corporation for inclusion in the minutes or
        filing with the corporate records.

	 If the corporation is required by law to give notice to
        nonvoting shareholders of action to be taken by unanimous
        written consent of the voting shareholders, then the
        corporation shall give the nonvoting shareholders, if any,
        written notice of the proposed action at least ten (10) days
        before the action is taken.

                                   ARTICLE III.
                               BOARD OF DIRECTORS

        Section 1.  General powers.  All corporate powers shall be
        exercised by or under the authority of, and the business and
        affairs of the corporation shall be managed under the
        direction of, the Board of Directors.

        Section 2.  Number and qualifications.  The number of
        directors constituting the Board of Directors shall be not
        less than one (1) nor more than seven (7) as may be fixed or
        changed from time to time, within the minimum and maximum,
        by the shareholders or by the Board of Directors.  Directors
        need not be residents of the State of North Carolina or
        shareholders of the corporation.

        Section 3.  Election.  Except as provided in Section 6 of
        this Article III, the directors shall be elected at the
        annual meeting of shareholders.  Those persons who receive
        the highest number of votes at a meeting at which a quorum
        is present shall be deemed to have been elected.

        Section 4.  Term of directors.  Each initial director shall
        hold office until the first shareholders' meeting at which
        directors are elected, or until such director's death,
        resignation, or removal.  The term of every other director
        shall expire at the next annual shareholders' meeting
        following the director's election or upon such director's
        death, resignation, or removal.  The term of a director
        elected to fill a vacancy expires at the next shareholders'
        meeting at which directors are elected.  A decrease in the
        number of directors does not shorten an incumbent director's
        term.  Despite the expiration of a director's term, such
        director shall continue to serve until a successor shall be
        elected and qualifies or until there is a decrease in the
        number of directors.
              
        Section 5.  Removal.  Any director may be removed at any
        time with or without cause by a vote of the shareholders if
        the number of votes cast to remove such director exceeds the
        number of votes cast not to remove him.  If a director is
        elected by a voting group of shareholders, only the
        shareholders of that voting group may participate in the
        vote to remove him.  A director may not be removed by the
        shareholders at a meeting unless the notice of the meeting
        states that the purpose, or one of the purposes, of the
        meeting is removal of the director.  If any directors are so
        removed, new directors may be elected at the same meeting.

        Section 6.  Vacancies.  Any vacancy occurring in the Board
        of Directors, including without limitation a vacancy
        resulting from an increase in the number of directors or
        from the failure by the shareholders to elect the full
        authorized number of directors, may be filled by the
        shareholders or by the Board of Directors, whichever group
        shall act first.  If the directors remaining in office do
        not constitute a quorum, the directors may fill the vacancy
        by the affirmative vote of a majority of the remaining
        directors.  If the vacant office was held by a director
        elected by a voting group, only the remaining director or
        directors elected by that voting group or the holders of
        shares of that voting group are entitled to fill the
        vacancy.

        Section 7.  Chairman of Board.  There may be a Chairman of
        the Board of Directors elected by the directors from their
        number at any meeting of the Board.  The Chairman shall
        preside at all meetings of the Board of Directors and
        perform such other duties as may be directed by the Board.

        Section 8.  Compensation.  The Board of Directors may
        provide for the compensation of directors for their services
        as such and for the payment or reimbursement of any or all
        expenses incurred by them in connection with such services.

              	                      ARTICLE IV.
              	                 MEETINGS OF DIRECTORS
        Section 1.  Regular meetings.  A regular meeting of the
        Board of Directors shall be held immediately after, and at
        the same place as, the annual meeting of shareholders.  In
        addition, the Board of Directors may provide, by resolution,
        the time and place, either within or without the State of
        North Carolina, for the holding of additional regular
        meetings.

        Section 2.  Special meetings.  Special meetings of the Board
        of Directors may be called by or at the request of the
        Chairman of the Board, if any, by the President or by a
        majority of the duly elected directors.  Such a meeting may
        be held either within or without the State of North
        Carolina, as fixed by the person or persons calling the
        meeting.

        Section 3.  Notice of meetings.  Regular meetings of the
        Board of Directors may be held without notice.  The person
        or persons calling a special meeting of the Board of
        Directors shall, at least two (2) days before the meeting,
        give or cause to be given notice thereof by any usual means
        of communication.  Such notice need not specify the purpose
        for which the meeting is called.  Any duly convened regular
        or special meeting may be adjourned by the directors to a
        later time without further notice.
        
        Section 4.  Waiver of notice.  Any director may waive notice
         of any meeting before or after the meeting.  The waiver
         must be in writing, signed by the director entitled to the
         notice, and delivered to the corporation for inclusion in
         the minutes or filing with the corporate records.  A
         director's attendance at or participation in a meeting
         waives any required notice of such meeting unless the
         director at the beginning of the meeting, or promptly upon
         arrival, objects to holding the meeting or to transacting
         business at the meeting and does not thereafter vote for or
         assent to action taken at the meeting.

         Section 5.  Quorum.  Unless the articles of incorporation
         or these bylaws provide otherwise, a majority of the number
         of directors fixed by or pursuant to these bylaws shall
         constitute a quorum for the transaction of business at any
         meeting of the Board of Directors, or if no number is so
         fixed, the number of directors in office immediately before
         the meeting begins shall constitute a quorum.

         Section 6.  Manner of acting.  Except as otherwise provided
         in the articles of incorporation or these bylaws, including
         Section 9 of this Article IV, the affirmative vote of a
         majority of the directors present at a meeting at which a
         quorum is present shall be the act of the Board of
         Directors.

         Section 7.  Presumption of assent.  A director who is
         present at a meeting of the Board of Directors or a
         committee of the Board of Directors when corporate action
         is taken is deemed to have assented to the action taken
         unless (a) he objects at the beginning of the meeting, or
         promptly upon his arrival, to holding it or to transacting
         business at the meeting, or (b) his dissent or abstention
         from the action taken is entered in the minutes of the
         meeting, or (c) he files written notice of his dissent or
         abstention with the presiding officer of the meeting before
         its adjournment or with the corporation immediately after
         the adjournment of the meeting.  Such right of dissent or
         abstention is not available to a director who votes in
         favor of the action taken.

         Section 8.  Action without meeting.  Action required or
         permitted to be taken at a meeting of the Board of
         Directors may be taken without a meeting if the action is
         taken by all members of the board.  The action must be
         evidenced by one or more written consents signed by each
         director before or after such action, describing the action
         taken, and included in the minutes or filed with the
         corporate records.

         Section 9.  Committees of the Board.  The Board of
         Directors may create an Executive Committee and other
         committees of the board and appoint members of the Board of
         Directors to serve on them.  The creation of a committee of
         the board and appointment of members to it must be approved
         by the greater of (a) a majority of the number of directors
         in office when the action is taken or (b) the number of
         directors required to take action pursuant to Section 6 of
         this Article IV.  Each committee of the board must have two
         (2) or more members and, to the extent authorized by law
         and specified by the Board of Directors, shall have and may
         exercise all of the authority of the Board of Directors in
         the management of the corporation.  Each committee member
         serves at the pleasure of the Board of Directors.  The
         provisions in these bylaws governing meetings, action
         without meetings, notice and waiver of notice, and quorum
         and voting requirements of the Board of Directors apply to
         committees of the board established under this section.

                                           ARTICLE V.
                            		   OFFICERS
        Section 1.  Officers of the corporation.  The officers of
        the corporation shall consist of a President, a Secretary, a
        Treasurer, and such Vice-Presidents, Assistant Secretaries,
        Assistant Treasurers, and other officers as may from time to
        time be appointed by or under the authority of the Board of
        Directors.  Any two (2) or more offices may be held by the
        same person, but no officer may act in more than one (1)
        capacity where action of two (2) or more officers is
        required.

        Section 2.  Appointment and term.  The officers of the
        corporation shall be appointed by the Board of Directors or
        by a duly appointed officer authorized by the Board of
        Directors to appoint one (1) or more officers or assistant
        officers.  Each officer shall hold office until his death,
        resignation, retirement, removal, disqualification, or his
        successor shall have been appointed.

        Section 3.  Compensation of officers.  The compensation of
        all officers of the corporation shall be fixed by or under
        the authority of the Board of Directors, and no officer
        shall serve the corporation in any other capacity and
        receive compensation therefor unless such additional
        compensation shall be duly authorized.  The appointment of
        an officer does not itself create contract rights.

         Section 4.  Removal.  Any officer may be removed by the
         Board at any time with or without cause; but such removal
         shall not itself affect the officer's contract rights, if
         any, with the corporation.

        Section 5.  Resignation.  An officer may resign at any time
        by communicating his resignation to the corporation, orally
        or in writing.  A resignation is effective when communicated
        unless it specifies in writing a later effective date.  If a
        resignation is made effective at a later date that is
        accepted by the corporation, the Board of Directors may fill
        the pending vacancy before the effective date if the Board
        provides that the successor does not take office until the
        effective date.  An officer's resignation does not affect the
        corporation's contract rights, if any, with the officer.

         Section 6.  Bonds.  The Board of Directors may by
         resolution require any officer, agent, or employee of the
         corporation to give bond to the corporation with sufficient
         sureties, conditioned on the faithful performance of the
         duties of his respective office or position and to comply
         with such other conditions as may from time to time be
         required by the Board of Directors.

       Section 7.  President.  The President shall be the principal
       executive officer of the corporation and, subject to the
       control of the Board of Directors, shall in general supervise
       and control all of the business and affairs of the
       corporation.  He shall, when present, preside at all meetings
       of the shareholders.  He shall sign, with the Secretary, an
       Assistant secretary, or any other proper officer of the
       corporation thereunto authorized by the Board of Directors,
       certificates for shares of the corporation, any deeds,
       mortgages, bonds, contracts, or other instruments which the
       Board of Directors has authorized to be executed, except in
       cases where the signing and execution thereof shall be
       expressly delegated by the Board of Directors or by these
       bylaws to some other officer or agent of the corporation, or
       shall be required by law to be otherwise signed or executed;
       and in general he shall perform all duties incident to the
       office of President and such other duties as may be
       prescribed by the Board of Directors from time to time.

       Section 8.  Vice Presidents.  In the absence of the president
       or in the event of his death, inability or refusal to act,
       the Vice Presidents in the order of their length of service
       as such, unless otherwise determined by the Board of
       Directors, shall perform the duties of the President, and
       when so acting shall have all the powers of and be subject to
       all the restrictions upon the President.  Any Vice President
       may sign, with the Secretary or an Assistant Secretary,
       certificates for shares of the corporation; and shall perform
       such other duties as from time to time may be prescribed by
       the President or Board of Directors.

        Section 9.  Secretary.  The Secretary shall:  (a) keep the
        minutes of the meetings of shareholders, of the Board of
        Directors, and of all committees in one (1) or more books
        provided for that purpose; (b) see that all notices are duly
        given in accordance with the provisions of these bylaws or
        as required by law; (c) maintain and authenticate the
        records of the corporation and be custodian of the seal of
        the corporation and see that the seal of the corporation is
        affixed to all documents the execution of which on behalf of
        the corporation under its seal is duly authorized; (d) sign
        with the President, or a Vice President, certificates for
        shares of the corporation, the issuance of which shall have
        been authorized by resolution of the Board of Directors; (e)
        maintain and have general charge of the stock transfer books
        of the corporation; (f) prepare or cause to be prepared
        shareholder lists prior to each meeting of shareholders as
        required by law; (g) attest the signature or certify the
        incumbency or signature of any officer of the corporation;
        and (h) in general perform all duties incident to the office
        of secretary and such other duties as from time to time may
        be prescribed by the President or by the Board of Directors.

        Section 10.  Assistant Secretaries.  In the absence of the
        Secretary or in the event of his death, inability or refusal
        to act, the Assistant Secretaries in the order of their
        length of service as Assistant Secretary, unless otherwise
        determined by the Board of Directors, shall perform the
        duties of the Secretary, and when so acting shall have all
        the powers of and be subject to all the restrictions upon
        the Secretary.  They shall perform such other duties as may
        be prescribed by the Secretary, by the President, or by the
        Board of Directors.  Any Assistant Secretary may sign, with
        the President or a Vice President, certificates for shares
        of the corporation.
              
        Section 11.  Treasurer.  The Treasurer shall:  (a) have
        charge and custody of and be responsible for all funds and
        securities of the corporation; receive and give receipts for
        moneys due and payable to the corporation from any source
        whatsoever, and deposit all such moneys in the name of the
        corporation in such depositories as shall be selected in
        accordance with the provisions of Section 4 of Article VI of
        these bylaws; (b) maintain appropriate accounting records as
        required by law; (c) prepare, or cause to be prepared,
        annual financial statements of the corporation that include
        a balance sheet as of the end of the fiscal year and an
        income and cash flow statement for that year, which
        statements, or a written notice of their availability, shall
        be mailed to each shareholder within one hundred twenty
        (120) days after the end of such fiscal year; and (d) in
        general perform all of the duties incident to the office of
        treasurer and such other duties as from time to time may be
        prescribed by the President or by the Board of Directors.

        Section 12.  Assistant Treasurers.  In the absence of the
        Treasurer or in the event of his death, inability or refusal
        to act, the Assistant Treasurers in the order of their
        length of service as such, unless otherwise determined by
        the Board of Directors, shall perform the duties of the
        Treasurer, and when so acting shall have all the powers of
        and be subject to all the restrictions upon the Treasurer.
        They shall perform such other duties as may be prescribed by
        the Treasurer, by the President, or by the Board of
        Directors.
              
                       ARTICLE VI.
            CONTRACTS, LOANS, CHECKS, AND DEPOSITS

        Section 1.  Contracts.  The Board of Directors may authorize
        any officer or officers, agent or agents, to enter into any
        contract or execute and deliver any instrument in the name
        of and on behalf of the corporation, and such authority may
        be general or confined to specific instances.

        Section 2.  Loans.  No loans shall be contracted on behalf
        of the corporation and no evidence of indebtedness shall be
        issued in its name unless authorized by the Board of
        Directors.  Such authority may be general or confined to
        specific instances.

        Section 3.  Checks and drafts.  All checks, drafts, or other
        orders for the payment of money, issued in the name of the
        corporation, shall be signed by such officer or officers,
        agent or agents of the corporation and in such manner as
        shall from time to time be determined by the Board of
        Directors.

        Section 4.  Deposits.  All funds of the corporation not
        otherwise employed shall be deposited from time to time to
        the credit of the corporation in such depositories as may be
        selected by or under the authority of the Board of
        Directors.

                               ARTICLE VII.
                             SHARES AND THEIR TRANSFER
       Section 1.  Certificates for shares.  The Board of Directors
       may authorize the issuance of some or all of the shares of
       the corporation's classes or series without issuing
       certificates to represent such shares.  If shares are
       represented by certificates, the certificates shall be in
       such form as required by law and as determined by the Board
       of Directors.  Certificates shall be signed, either manually
       or in facsimile, by the President or a Vice-President and by
       the Secretary or Treasurer or an Assistant Secretary or an
       Assistant Treasurer.  All certificates for shares shall be
       consecutively numbered or otherwise identified and entered
       into the stock transfer books of the corporation.  When
       shares are represented by certificates, the corporation shall
       issue and deliver, to each shareholder to whom such shares
       have been issued or transferred, certificates representing
       the shares owned by him.  When shares are not represented by
       certificates, then within a reasonable time after the
       issuance or transfer of such shares, the corporation shall
       send the shareholder to whom such shares have been issued or
       transferred a written statement of the information required
       by law to be on certificates.

       Section 2.  Stock transfer books.  The corporation shall keep
       a book or set of books, to be known as the stock transfer
       books of the corporation, containing the name of each
       shareholder of record, together with such shareholder's
       address and the number and class or series of shares held by
       him.  Transfers of shares of the corporation shall be made
       only on the stock transfer books of the corporation by the
       holder of record thereof or by his legal representative, who
       shall furnish proper evidence of authority to transfer, or by
       his attorney authorized to effect such transfer by power of
       attorney duly executed and filed with the Secretary, and on
       surrender for cancellation of the certificate for such shares
       (if the shares are represented by certificates).

       Section 3.  Lost certificate.  The Board of Directors may
       direct a new certificate to be issued in place of any
       certificate theretofore issued by the corporation claimed to
       have been lost or destroyed, upon receipt of an affidavit of
       such fact from the person claiming the certificate to have
       been lost or destroyed.  When authorizing such issue of a new
       certificate, the Board of Directors shall require that the
       owner of such lost or destroyed certificate, or his legal
       representative, give the corporation a bond in such sum and
       with such surety or other security as the Board may direct as
       indemnity against any claim that may be made against the
       corporation with respect to the certificate claimed to have
       been lost or destroyed, except where the Board of Directors
       by resolution finds that in the judgment of the directors the
       circumstances justify omission of a bond.

        Section 4.  Fixing record date.  The Board of Directors may
        fix a future date as the record date for one (1) or more
        voting groups in order to determine the shareholders
        entitled to notice of a shareholders' meeting, to demand a
        special meeting, to vote, or to take any other action.  Such
        record date may not be more than seventy (70) days before
        the meeting or action requiring a determination of
        shareholders.  A determination of shareholders entitled to
        notice of or to vote at a shareholders' meeting is effective
        for any adjournment of the meeting unless the Board of
        Directors fixes a new record date for the adjourned meeting,
        which it must do if the meeting is adjourned to a date more
        than one hundred twenty (120) days after the date fixed for
        the original meeting.

        If no record date is fixed by the Board of Directors for the
        determination of shareholders entitled to notice of or to
        vote at a meeting of shareholders, the close of business on
        the day before the first notice of the meeting is delivered
        to shareholders shall be the record date for such
        determination of shareholders.

        The Board of Directors may fix a date as the record date for
        determining shareholders entitled to a distribution or share
        dividend.  If no record date is fixed by the Board of
        Directors for such determination, it is the date the Board
        of Directors authorizes the distribution or share dividend.

        Section 5.  Holder of record.  Except as otherwise required
        by law, the corporation may treat the person in whose name
        the shares stand of record on its books as the absolute
        owner of the shares and the person exclusively entitled to
        receive notification and distributions, to vote, and to
        otherwise exercise the rights, powers, and privileges of
        ownership of such shares.

        Section 6.  Shares held by nominees.  The corporation shall
        recognize the beneficial owner of shares registered in the
        name of a nominee as the owner and shareholder of such
        shares for certain purposes if the nominee in whose name
        such shares are registered files with the Secretary a
        written certificate in a form prescribed by the corporation,
        signed by the nominee, indicating the following:  (i) the
        name, address, and taxpayer identification number of the
        nominee; (ii) the name, address, and taxpayer identification
        number of the beneficial owner; (iii) the number and class
        or series of shares registered in the name of the nominee as
        to which the beneficial owner shall be recognized as the
        shareholder; and (iv) the purposes for which the beneficial
        owner shall be recognized as the shareholder.

        The purposes for which the corporation shall recognize the
        beneficial owner as the shareholder may include the
        following:  (i) receiving notice of, voting at, and
        otherwise participating in shareholders' meetings; (ii)
        executing consents with respect to the shares; (iii)
        exercising dissenters' rights under Article 13 of the
        Business Corporation Act; (iv) receiving distributions and
        share dividends with respect to the shares; (v) exercising
        inspection rights; (vi) receiving reports, financial
        statements, proxy statements, and other communications from
        the corporation; (vii) making any demand upon the
        corporation required or permitted by law; and (viii)
        exercising any other rights or receiving any other benefits
        of a shareholder with respect to the shares.

        The certificate shall be effective ten (10) business days
        after its receipt by the corporation and until it is changed
        by the nominee, unless the certificate specifies a later
        effective time or an earlier termination date.

        If the certificate affects less than all of the shares
        registered in the name of the nominee, the corporation may
        require the shares affected by the certificate to be
        registered separately on the books of the corporation and be
        represented by a share certificate that bears a conspicuous
        legend stating that there is a nominee certificate in effect
        with respect to the shares represented by that share
        certificate.

                                   ARTICLE VIII.
                                  INDEMNIFICATION

        Any person who at any time serves or has served as a
        director of the corporation, or who, while serving as a
        director of the corporation, serves or has served, at the
        request of the corporation, as a director, officer, partner,
        trustee, employee, or agent of another corporation,
        partnership, joint venture, trust, limited liability company
        or other enterprise, or as a trustee or administrator under
        an employee benefit plan, shall have a right to be
        indemnified by the corporation to the fullest extent
        permitted by law against (a) reasonable expenses, including
        attorneys' fees, incurred by him in connection with any
        threatened, pending, or completed civil, criminal,
        administrative, investigative, or arbitrative action, suit,
        or proceeding (and any appeal therein), whether or not
        brought by or on behalf of the corporation, seeking to hold
        him liable by reason of the fact that he is or was acting in
        such capacity, and (b) reasonable payments made by him in
        satisfaction of any judgment, money decree, fine (including
        an excise tax assessed with respect to an employee benefit
        plan), penalty, or settlement for which he may have become
        liable in any such action, suit, or proceeding.

        The Board of Directors of the corporation shall take all
        such action as may be necessary and appropriate to authorize
        the corporation to pay the indemnification required by this
        bylaw, including, without limitation, making a determination
        that indemnification is permissible in the circumstances and
        a good faith evaluation of the manner in which the claimant
        for indemnity acted and of the reasonable amount of
        indemnity due him.  The Board of Directors may appoint a
        committee or special counsel to make such determination and
        evaluation.  To the extent needed, the Board shall give
        notice to, and obtain approval by, the shareholders of the
        corporation for any decision to indemnify.

        Any person who at any time after the adoption of this bylaw
        serves or has served in the aforesaid capacity for or on
        behalf of the corporation shall be deemed to be doing or to
        have done so in reliance upon, and as consideration for, the
        right of indemnification provided herein.  Such right shall
        inure to the benefit of the legal representatives of any
        such person and shall not be exclusive of any other rights
        to which such person may be entitled apart from the
        provision of this bylaw.

                                    ARTICLE IX.
              	                  GENERAL PROVISIONS 
        Section 1.  Distributions.  The Board of Directors may from
        time to time authorize, and the corporation may grant,
        distributions and share dividends to its shareholders
        pursuant to law and subject to the provisions of its
        articles of incorporation.

        Section 2.  Seal.  The corporate seal of the corporation
        shall be on such form as shall be approved from time to time by the
        board of directors.

        Section 3.  Fiscal year.  The fiscal year of the corporation
        shall be fixed by the Board of Directors.

        Section 4.  Amendments.  Except as otherwise provided in the
        Articles of Incorporation or by law, these bylaws may be amended or
        repealed and new bylaws may be adopted by the Board of
        Directors.

        No bylaw adopted, amended, or repealed by the shareholders shall
        be readopted, amended, or repealed by the Board of Directors, un-
        less the articles of incorporation or a bylaw adopted by the share-
        holders authorizes the Board of Directors to adopt, amend, or repeal
        that particular bylaw or the bylaws generally.

        Section 5.  Definitions.  Unless the context otherwise
        requires, terms used in these bylaws shall have the meanings
        assigned to them in the North Carolina Business Corporation
        Act to the extent defind therein.
	
        These Bylaws were duly adopted by the Board of Directors, and
        are effective this 4th day of May, 1995.

CONSENTED AND ACCEPTED:
                                 BY /s/  Stanley H. Van Etten
                                         Stanley H. Van Etten, Director
                                 BY: /s/ Claude W. Savage
                                        Claude W. Savage, Director
                            		      BY: /s/ Larry Smith
                                      Larry Smith, Director

Exhibit 3.2
 

	Number		International Heritage Incorporated  	Shares

						Common Stock

 	This certifies that_____________is the owner of_________
  						fully paid
	and non-assessable.  Of par, shares of the Capital Stock of
        International Heritage, Inc. a North Carolina corporation,
	transferable only on the books of Corporation by the holder hereof
	in person or by duly authorized Attorney upon surrender of this
	Certificate properly endorsed.  The Witness Whereof, the said
	Corporation has caused this Certificate to be signed by its duly
	authorized officers and its Corporate Seal to be herunto affixed
	this______day of_____A.D. 19__


		Secretary/Treasurer					President

         

                          EXPLANATION OF ABBREVIATIONS
	
The following abbreviations, when used in the inscription of
ownership on the face of this certificate, shall be construed as if
they were written in full according to applicable laws or
regulations.  Abbreviations, in addition to those appearing below,
may be used.

JT TEN			As joint tenants with right of survivorship	
				and not as tenants in common
TET ENT			As tenants by the entireties
UNIT GIF MIN ACT        Uniform Gifts to Minors Act
TEN COM  		As tenants in common			
CUST			Custodian for

For Value Received_________________hereby sell, asign and transfer
unto _________________shares represented by the within Certificate
and do hereby irrevocably constitute and
appoint_______________Attorney to transfer the said shares on the
books of within named Corporation with full power of substitution in
the premises.  Dated______19__
In presence of_____________________

Exhibit 4.1

For Ministry Use only                               Ontario Corporation Number
A lusage exclusif du ministere	   		Numero de la compagnie en Ontario
							1140938


Certificate			Certifcat
This is to certify that these   Ceci certifie que les presents
 articles are effective on              statuts entrent en vigueur le
July    26                      Juillet, 1995

/s/
Director/ Directeur
Business Corporations Act / Loi de sur les compagnies
                                           Trans   Line            Comp   Method
                                           Code    No.     Stat    Type   Incorp
                                           A       O       O       A       3
                                           18      20      28      29      30
                                                   Notice
                                           Share   Req'd           Jurisdiction
                                           S       N               ONTARIO
                                           31      32            33    47

				ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION
				    STATUTS CONSTITUTIFS
1.
        The name of the coporation is:   Denomination sociale de la compagnie:
	INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE OF
	CANADA, INC

2.  The address of registered office is :             Adresse du slege social:
	Suite 1001, 95 Wellington Street West
 (Street & Number or R.R. Number & Multi-office bulding give Room No.)
        (Rue et numero ou numero de la R.R. et, 
          s'll s'agit d'un edifice a bureaux, numero du bureau)

        Toronto                                              M5J2N7
        (Name of Municipality or Post Office)           (Postal Code/Code Postal
        (Nom de la municipalite ou du bureau de poste)

        Toronto
        (Name of Municipality, Geographical Township)
        (Nom de la municipalite du canton)

        in the                      Metropolitan Toronto
        (dans lefla)                (County, District, Regional Municipality)
                                    (Comte, district, municipalite, regionale)

3.  Number (or minimum and maximum number) of
     directors is:
    Nombre (ou nombres minimal et maximal)
     d'administrateurs:

	Minimum Number: 1
	Maximum Number: 5

4. The first director(s) is/are:              Premier(s) administrateur(s):
   First name, initials and surname           Residence address giving 
   Prenom, initiales et nom de famille        street & no. or RR.
                                              Municipality and postal code     
                                              Adresse peronnelle, 
                                              y compris la rue et le
                                              numero,le numero de la
                                              r.r. ou, le nom de la
                                              municipalit et le code postal

   Resident Canadian State Yes or No
   Resident Canadian Oui/Non

   Robert Stikeman

   15 McGlashan Court
   North York, Ontario, M5M 4M6

   Yes


5. Restrictions, if any, on business the corporation may       
   aux activites
   carry on or on powers the corporation may exercise.                        
   Limites, s'll y a lieu, inposees aux activites commerciales
   ou auz pouvoirs de la compagnie.

   None


6.  The classes and any maximum number of shares that                   
      sll y a lieu,
    the corporation is authorized to issue:
    Categories et nombre maximal, s'll y a lieu, d'actions
    que la compagnie est autorisee a emettre:

    The corporation is authorized to issue an unlimited number of
    shares of one class designated as Common shares and an unlimited
    number of shares of a second class designated as preference
    shares.

7.  Rights, privileges, restrictions and conditions (if any)
                 attaching to each class of shares and directors
                 authority with respect to any class of shares which
                 may no issued in series:
    Droits, privileges, restrictions et conditions, s'll y a lieu,
                 rattaches a chaque categorie d'actions et pouvoirs
                 des administrateurs relatifs a chaque categorie
                 d'actions qui peut etre emise en serie:

    7.01 the preference shares may be issued in one or more series;

    7.02 the directors are authorized to fix the number of shares in
         and to determine the designation, rights, privileges,
         restrictions and conditions attaching to the shares of each
         series except for the first series of such shares, in
         respect of which the number, designation, rights,
         privileges, restrictions and conditions are set out in
         paragraph 4 below;

    7.03 the preference shares of each series shall, with respect to
         the priority in payment of dividends and in the return of
         capital in the event of the liquidation, dissolution or
         winding up of the corporation be entitled to a preference
         over the Common shares of the corporation and over any
         other shares ranking junior to the preference shares;

    7.04 the first series of preference shares shall consist of
         50,000 shares designated as Series 'A' preference shares
         and in addition to the preferences attaching to the
         preference shares as a class set out in paragraph 3 above
         shall have attached thereto the following rights,
         privileges, restrictions and conditions:
   7.04.1 the holder of each Series "A" preference share shall be
          entitled to receive as and when declared by the directors
          out of the monies properly applicable to the payment of
          dividends preferential non-cumulative cash dividends at the
          rate of eight per cent per share per annum, of the amount
          paid to the Corporation for such share and no more;
   7.04.2 the holder of each Series "A" preference share shall have the
          right to two votes for such Series "A" preference share at
          all meetings of the shareholders other than meetings of the
          holders of another class or series of shares; and
   7.04.3 in the event of the liquidation, dissolution or winding up of
          the corporation, the holder of each Series "A" preference
          share shall be entitled to receive the amount paid to the
          corporation for such share, together with all unpaid
          dividends declared thereon.

    7.05 the holder of each Common share has the right to one vote
         for such Common shares at all meetings of the shareholders
         other than meetings of the holders of any class of shares
         and to receive the remaining property of the corporation
         upon dissolution.


   8.  The Issue, transfer or ownership of shares is/is not
       restricted and the restrictions (if any) are as follows:
       L'emission, le transfert ou la propriete d'actions est/n'est
       pas restrainte. Le restrictions, s'll y a lieu, sont les
       suivantes:

The right to transfer shares of the corporation shall be restricted
in that no shares shall be transferred without either:

             8.01 the previous consent of the directors of the
                  Corporation expressed by a resolution passed at a
                  meeting of the directors or by an instrument or
                  instruments in writing signed by a majority of the
                  directors; or
             8.02 the previous consent of the holders of at least
                  51% of the shares for the time being outstanding
                  entitled to vote expressed by resolution passed at
                  a meeting of the shareholders or by an instrument
                  or instruments in writing signed by such
                  shareholders.
                                                                              
            

     9.  Other provisions, if any, are:
         Autres dispostions, s'll y a lieu:

     9.01 that the board of directors may from time to time,
          in such amounts and on such terms as it deems expedient:
          9.01.1 borrow money on the credit of the corporation;
          9.01.2 issue, reissue, sell or pledge debt obligations (including
          bonds, debentures, notes or other similar obligations,
          secured or unsecured) of the corporation;
          9.01.3 to the extent permitted by law, give a guarantee
          on behalf of the corporation to secure
          performance of any present or future indebtedness,
          liability or obligation of any person; and
          9.01.4 charge, mortgage, hypothecate, pledge or
          otherwise create a security interest in all or
          any of the currently owned or subsequently
          acquired real or personal, movable or immovable,
          property of the corporation, including book
          debts, rights, powers, franchises and
          undertakings, to secure any debt obligations or
          any money borrowed or other debt or liability of
          the corporation;
    
                   The board of directors may from time to time
                   delegate such one or more of the directors and
                   officers of the corporation as may be designated
                   by the board all or any of the powers conferred
                   on the board above to such extent and in such
                   manner as the board shall determine at the time
                   of each such delegation;
    
            9.02 that the number of shareholders of the corporation,
                 exclusive of persons who are in the employment of
                 the corporation and exclusive of persons who,
                 having been formerly in the employment of the
                 corporation, were, while in the employment, and
                 have continued after the termination of that
                 employment to be shareholders of the corporation,
                 is limited to not more than fifty (50), two (2) or
                 more persons who are the joint registered owners of
                 one (1) or more shares being counted as one (1)
                 shareholder; and
     
            9.03 that any invitation to the public to subscribe for
                 any shares or securities of the corporation is
                 hereby prohibited.


       10. The names and addresses of the incorporators are:
           Nom et adrese des fondateurs:
               
           First name, Initials and surname or corporate name 
           Prenom, initiale et nom de famille ou denomination sociale
 
           Full residence address or address of registered
           office or of principal place of business giving
           street & No. or R.R. N., municipality and postal
           code
           Adresse personelle au complet, adresse du siege
           social ou adresse de l'etablissement principal,
           y compris la rue et la numera, la numera de la
           R.R., le nom de la municipalite et la code postal

                 Robert Stikeman	15 McGlashan Court
				North York, Ontario
				M5M 4M6



These articles are signed in duplicate.
Le presents statuts sont signees en double exemplaire.

Signatures of Incorporators
(Signatures des fondateurs)

/s/ Robert Stikeman

Exhibit 21.1 



        STATE OF NORTH CAROLINA
        COUNTY OF WAKE
        EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT
        This Employment Agreement (hereinafter "Agreement") made and
        effective as of June 1,1995, by and between International
        Heritage, Inc. and International Heritage of Canada, Inc.
        (hereinafter collectively referred to as "Employer"), both
        of which are corporations with International Heritage, Inc.
        being duly organized and existing under the laws of the
        State of North Carolina, with a place of business at 2626
        Glenwood Avenue, Suite 200, City of Raleigh, County of Wake,
        and State of North Carolina, and with International Heritage
        of Canada, Inc. being duly organized and existing under the
        laws of Canada, with a place of business at 885 West Georgia
        Street, Suite 137O, City of Vancouver, Province of British
        Columbia, and Stanley H. Van Etten (hereinafter "Employee")
        with a residence at 11816 Mt. Batten Way, City of Raleigh,
        County of Wake, and State of North Carolina.  (Throughout
        the Agreement, Employer and Employee will collectively be
        referred to as the "Parties.")

				        RECITALS
        WHEREAS, Employer is engaged in the business of multi-level
        network marketing, and desires to employ the services of
        Employee as Chief Executive Officer of its current
        operations and to assist in the opening and operation of
        additional regional offices; and WHEREAS, Employee is
        willing to be employed by Employer, and Employer is willing
        to employ Employee, on the terms, covenants, and conditions
        set forth in this Agreement.  NOW, THEREFORE, for the
        reasons set forth above, and in consideration of the mutual
        promises and agreements set forth in this Agreement,
        Employer and Employee agree as follows:

                        SECTION ONE: EMPLOYMENT
        1.  Employer hereby employs, engages, and hires Employee as
        Chief Executive Officer of Employer to assist Employer in
        becoming a successful multi-level network marketing company
        and provide financial and management services to the
        Employer, and Employee hereby accepts and agrees to such
        employment, engagement, and hiring, subject to the
        supervision of and pursuant to the orders, advice, and
        direction of the Board of Directors of the Employer.
        2.  Employee shall perform such other duties as are customarily
        performed by one holding such position in other, same, or
        similar businesses or enterprises as that engaged in by
        Employer, and shall additionally render such specific. other
        and unrelated services and duties as may be assigned to the
        Employee from time to time by the Board of Directors of the
        Employer.

                 SECTION TWO: BEST EFFORTS OF EMPLOYEE
        Employee agrees that he will at all times faithfully,
        industriously, and to the best of his ability, experience,
        and talents, perform all of the duties that may be required
        of and from him pursuant to the express and implicit terns
        of this Agreement, to the reasonable satisfaction of
        Employer.  Such duties shall be rendered at 2626 Glenwood
        Avenue, City of Raleigh, State of North Carolina, and at 995
        West Georgia Street, Suite 137O, City of Vancouver, Province
        of British Columbia, and such other place or places as
        Employer shall in good faith require on a temporary basis or
        as the interests, needs, business, or opportunities of
        Employer shall require.

		        SECTION THREE: TERM OF EMPLOYMENT
         The term of this Agreement shall be for three (3) years
         commencing June 1, 1995, and terminating May 31, 1998,
         subject, however, to prior termination as provided in this
         Agreement.  The execution of this Agreement after June 1,
         1995, in no way limits or impacts the enforceability of
         this Agreement, and Employer hereby ratifies the terms of
         this Agreement for the time period of June 1, 1995, to the
         date of execution of this Agreement, and thereafter until
         termination of this Agreement pursuant to the provisions
         herein.

        	             SECTION FOUR: COMPENSATION OF EMPLOYEE
        1.  Employer shall pay Employee, and Employee shall accept from
        Employer, in full payment of Employee's services as the
        Chief Executive Officer of Employer, a compensation equal
        to the greater of three percent (3%) of the net revenues of
        Employer, as defined by general accounting principals, or
        FOUR HUNDRED TWENTY-FIVE THOUSAND AND NO/100 DOLLARS
        ($425,000.00) per year, payable at least twice each month.(1)

         2.  Employer shall reimburse Employee, pursuant to company
         policy, for all out-ofpocket expenses that Employee shall
         incur in connection with his services for Employer
         contemplated by this Agreement on presentation by Employee
         of appropriate vouchers or receipts for such expenses to
         Employer.

         (1) As of October 31, 1995, Employee has
         received compensation in the amount of $77,905.71
         from Employer for services rendered between June 1, 1995,
         and October 31, 1995.  Employer acknowledges that the
         compensation received by the Employee during this time
         period is not payment in full pursuant to the compensation
         agreement referenced above.  Instead, the compensation
         received represents three percent (3 %) of the net revenues
         of Employer as defined by general accounting principals
         between June 1, 1995, and October 31, 1995, which is less
         than the $425,000.00 annualized minimum.  Therefore, the
         Employer acknowledges that additional compensation is owed
         to the Employee for services rendered as the Chief
         Executive Officer for the period of June 1, 1995, through
         October 31, 1995, in the amount of $99.177.62.  Pursuant
         to the terms of this Agreement, the Employer agrees to
         execute a promissory note for the balance owed as
         compensation, which promissory note shall be payable upon
         demand and shall bear interest at the rate of eight percent
         (8%) per annum.  Furthermore, the Employer agrees to
         withhold from said additional compensation the necessary
         taxes due and owing the federal and state governments with
         respect to said compensation and withhold from its own
         gross revenues the necessary matching contribution due and
         owing the federal and state governments with respect to
         said compensation.

         3.  In addition to the compensation referenced hereinabove, 
         and in partial consideration for the guarantees
         previously executed by the Employee for the benefit of
         Employer, Employee shall be entitled to a stock bonus of
         one percent (1%) of the issued and outstanding common
         stock of Employer as of December 31, 1995, provided that
         Employer is open and doing business and provided that
         Employer has achieved gross revenue in excess of
         $5,000,000.00; and a bonus of two percent (2%) of the
         issued and outstanding common stock of Employer as of
         December 31, 1996, provided that Employer is open and doing
         business and provided that Employer has achieved gross
         revenue in excess of $25,000,000.00; and a bonus of three
         percent (3%) of the issued and outstanding common stock of
         Employer as of December 1, 1997, provided that Employer is
         open and doing business and provided that Employer has
         achieved gross revenue in excess of $75,000,000.00; and a
         bonus of three percent (3%) of the issued and outstanding
         common stock of Employer as of December 31, 1998, provided
         that Employer is open and doing business and provided that
         Employer has achieved gross revenue in excess of
         $125,000,000.00; and a bonus of three percent (3%) of the
         issued and outstanding common stock of Employer as of
         December 31, 1999, provided that Employer is open and doing
         business and provided that Employer has achieved gross
         revenue in excess of $200,000,000.00; and a bonus of three
         percent (3%) of the issued and outstanding common stock of
         Employer as of December 31, 2000, provided that Employer is
         open and doing business and provided that Employer has
         achieved gross revenue in excess of $275,000,000.00.

         4. In addition to the compensation set forth hereinabove,
         Employee shall receive a semi-annual bonus, which shall be
         payable no later than July 15th and January 15th (the first
         such installment being due no later than January 15, 1996,
         for the initial seven-month term of this agreement), equal
         to three percent (3%) of the operating profits of Employer
         before taxes, debt service, and depreciation at that time
         and determined by the six-month financial statement of
         Employer as of June 30th and December 30th.  For the
         purpose of this paragraph, debt service shall include any
         loan to the Employer for the purpose of conducting business
         which is payable over a period of one (1) year or more.

                         SECTION FIVE: OTHER EMPLOYMENT
        Employee shall devote a sufficient amount of his time,
        attention, knowledge, and skills solely to the business and
        interests of Employer, Employer shall be entitled to all of
        the benefits, profits, or other issues arising from or
        incident to all work, services, and advice of Employee and
        Employee shall not, during the term of this Agreement, be
        interested directly or indirectly, in any manner, as
        partner, officer, director, shareholder, advisor, employee,
        or in any other capacity in any other business similar to
        Employer's business or any allied trade; provided, however,
        that nothing contained in this section shall be deemed to
        prevent or to limit the right of the Employee to invest any
        of his money in the capital stock or other securities of any
        corporation whose stock or securities are publicly owned or
        are regularly traded on any public exchange, nor shall
        anything contained in this section be deemed to prevent
        Employee from investing or limiting Employee's right to
        invest his money in real estate.  Furthermore, Employer
        acknowledges that the Employee currently has a substantial
        business relationship with Mayflower Holdings, Inc. and
        Mayflower Capital, LLC, which relationship the Employee
        shall not have to terminate during the term of this
        Agreement.  The Employer acknowledges that nothing contained
        in this section shall prevent or limit the right of the
        Employee to continue his relationship with Mayflower
        Holdings, Inc. and Mayflower Capital, LLC, during the term
        of this Agreement, nor shall anything contained in this
        section prevent or limit the right of the Employee to devote
        a limited amount of his time, attention, knowledge, and
        skills to Mayflower Holdings, Inc.'s and Mayflower Capital,
        LLC's business or allied trade, so long as such relationship
        does not interfere with Employee's performance under this
        Agreement.

                    SECTION SIX: EMPLOYEE'S SERVICES AS DIRECTOR
        Employee hereby consents to serve as a director of Employer
        or any parent, subsidiary, or corporation affiliated with
        Employer, if duly elected and qualified, on condition that
        Employee receive the same compensation paid to other
        directors of any such company for their services as
        directors.

                              SECTION SEVEN: VACATION
         Employee shall be entitled to twenty (20) days of paid
         vacation each year during the term of this Agreement, the
         time for such vacation to be determined by mutual agreement
         between Employer and Employee.

                     SECTION EIGHT: HEALTH AND DEATH BENEFITS
         1.  Employer agrees to provide health benefits to the
         Employee and his immediate family, which shall include the
         Employee's spouse and all children of Employee.  In the
         event Employee selects a health plan other than that
         provided to all employees of Employer, Employer shall pay
         on behalf of Employee the amount that Employee and his
         immediate family would be charged under the health care
         plan provided to all employees of Employer.  Any difference
         in health care benefit coverage shall be the responsibility
         of Employee.

         2.  Employer agrees to purchase upon the execution of this
         Agreement a key man insurance policy in the amount of
         $2,500,000.00, which will provide a death benefit of
         $1,500,000.00 to Employer and a death benefit of
         $1,000,000.00 to Employee's designated beneficiary or his
         heirs.

                      SECTION NINE: TERMINATION FOR DISABILITY
        In spite of anything in this Agreement to the contrary,
        Employer is hereby given the option to terminate this
        Agreement in the event that Employee shall, during the term
        of this Agreement, become permanently disabled as the term
        "permanently disabled" is fixed and defined in this section.
        Such option shall be exercised by Employer giving notice to
        Employee by registered mail addressed to him in care of the
        Employer at 2626 Glenwood Avenue, Suite 200, City of
        Raleigh, State of North Carolina, or at such other address
        as Employee shall designate in writing of Employer's
        intention to terminate this Agreement on the last day of the
        month during which such notice is mailed.  On the giving of
        such notice, this Agreement shall cease on the last day of
        the month for which the notice is so mailed, with the same
        force and effect as if such last day of the month were the
        date originally set forth in this Agreement as the
        termination date of this Agreement; provided, however, that
        Employee shall receive from Employer compensation pursuant
        to the terms of this Agreement for a period of one (1) year
        following the effective date of such termination.

         For the purposes of this Agreement, Employee shall be
         deemed to have become permanently disabled if, during any
         year of the term of this Agreement, because of ill health,
         physical or mental disability, or for other causes beyond
         Employee's control, he shall have been continuously unable
         or shall have failed to perform his duties under this
         Agreement for ninety (90) consecutive days, or if, during
         any year of the term of this Agreement, Employee shall have
         been unable or shall have failed to perform his duties for
         a total period of one hundred and twenty (120) days,
         irrespective of whether or not such days are consecutive.
         For the purposes of this Agreement, the term "any year of
         the term of this Agreement" is defined to mean any twelve
         (12) calendar months commencing on June 1, 1995, and
         terminating on May 31, 1998, during the term of this
         Agreement.

                           SECTION TEN INDEMNIFICATION
        In return for the services provided to Employer by Employee
        and many risks accepted by the Employee on behalf of the
        Employer in the start-up of Employer, Employer shall
        indemnify Employee to the fullest extent permitted by law
        against (1) reasonable expenses, including attorneys' fees,
        actually and necessarily incurred by Employee in connection
        with any threatened, pending, or completed action, suit, or
        proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative, or
        investigative, seeking to hold Employee liable by reason of
        the fact that Employee is or was acting in any capacity for
        Employer, and (2) payments made by Employee on behalf of
        Employer in satisfaction of any judgment, money decree,
        fine, penalty, or reasonable settlement for which Employee
        may have become liable in any such action, suit, or
        proceeding.  In the event that there is any threatened or
        pending action, suit, or proceeding initiated against the
        Employee pursuant to which the Employee may become liable,
        the Employee shall have the right to demand and obtain from
        the Employer an advance of TWELVE THOUSAND AND NO/100
        DOLLARS ($12,000.00) to insure payment of any judgment,
        money decree, fine, or penalty, which amount shall be
        deposited in the trust account of Employee's chosen counsel,
        but which shall not relieve Employer from satisfying
        Employee's attorneys' fees and expenses on a monthly basis
        while the action, suit, or proceeding is pending.

                SECTION ELEVEN:  TERMINATION OF AGREEMENT 1.  This
             Agreement may be terminated by either party on thirty
             (30) days written notice to the other; however,
             Employer can terminate this agreement "for cause" only,
             which cause must be set forth specifically within the
             written notice of termination provided to Employee.
             Within the Agreement, "for cause" termination will be
             limited to these situations when a majority of the
             Board of Directors has determined that the Employee has
             been grossly negligent with respect to his duties as
             Chief Executive Officer or determine that Employee is
             in material breach of this Agreement.  If Employer
             shall so terminate this Agreement, Employee shall be
             entitled to compensation for one (1) year pursuant to
             the terms of this Agreement from the date of
             termination.  If Employer terminates this Agreement,
             Employer will not be relieved of any obligation under
             this Agreement during the one (1) year period of full
             compensation. If Employee shall so terminate this
             Agreement, he shall be entitled to compensation for a
             period of six (6) months pursuant to the terms of this
             Agreement from the date of termination.  Furthermore,
             regardless of how or when this Agreement is terminated,
             Employer shall at no time be relieved of its obligation
             to indemnify Employee pursuant to the terms of this
             Agreement.

         2.  Even though the initial term of employment shall
         terminate on May 31, 1998, this Agreement shall
         automatically renew for successive three-year periods
         unless written notice of the termination of this Agreement
         is provided by one party to the other at least ninety (90)
         days prior to the end of the initial term of this Agreement
         or at the end of each successive term of this Agreement.
         Furthermore, the Employer agrees not to terminate this
         Agreement at the end of the initial term or any successive
         term unless good cause exists to terminate this Agreement,
         and Employer agrees to negotiate in good faith with the
         Employee at the end of the initial term of this Agreement
         and at the end of each successive term of this Agreement so
         that Employee will be provided an employment and
         compensation package consistent with the value that
         Employee provides to Employer.

                 SECTION TWELVE: AGREEMENTS OUTSIDE OF CONTRACT
        This Agreement contains the complete understanding and
        agreement concerning the employment arrangement between the
        Parties and shall, as of the effective date hereof,
        supersede all other agreements, representations, promises or
        understandings, written or oral, between the Parties with
        respect to the subject matter of this Agreement.

                   SECTION THIRTEEN: MODIFICATION OF AGREEMENT
        Any modification of this Agreement or additional obligation
        assumed by either party in connection with the Agreement
        shall be binding only if evidenced in writing signed by the
        Parties or any authorized representative of the Parties.

                           SECTION FOURTEEN: ARBITRATION
        If there is a dispute over payment of fees or expenses under
        this Agreement, the dispute will be resolved by binding
        arbitration before the American Arbitration Association, and
        Employee and Employer agree to be bound by the final
        decision of that arbitration.  Any prevailing party in
        arbitration shall have the right to recover all costs and
        fees, to include attorneys' fees incident to the
        arbitration.  A demand for arbitration shall be made within
        a reasonable time after the claim, dispute, or other matter
        in question has arisen and in no event shall the demand for
        arbitration be made after the date when the institution of
        legal or equitable proceedings based on such dispute, claim,
        or controversy would be barred by the applicable statute of
        limitations.

			SECTION FIFTEEN: EFFECT OF PARTIAL INVALIDITY
        The invalidity of any portion of this Agreement will not and
        shall not be deemed to affect the validity of any other
        provision.  In the event that any provision of this
        Agreement is held to be invalid, the Parties agree that the
        remaining provisions shall be deemed to be in full force and
        effect as if they had been executed by both Parties
        subsequent to the expungement of the invalid provision.

                          SECTION SIXTEEN: CHOICE OF LAW
        It is the intention of the Parties to this Agreement that
        the performance under this Agreement, and all suits and
        special proceedings under this Agreement be construed in
        accordance with and under and pursuant to the laws of the
        State of North Carolina in that, in any action, special
        proceeding or any other proceeding that may be brought
        arising out of, in connection, or by reason of this
        Agreement, the laws of the State of North Carolina shall be
        applicable and shall govern to the exclusion of the law of
        any other forum, without regard to the jurisdiction in which
        any action or special proceeding may be instituted.

                           SECTION SEVENTEEN: NO WAIVER
        The failure of either party to this Agreement to insist upon
        the performance of any of the terms and conditions of this
        Agreement, or the waiver of any breach of any of the terms
        and conditions of this Agreement, shall not be construed as
        thereafter waiving any such terms and conditions, but the
        same shall continue and remain in full force and effect as
        if no such forbearance or waiver had occurred.

                         SECTION EIGHTEEN: ATTORNEYS' FEES
             In the event that any action is filed in relation to
        this Agreement, the unsuccessful party in the action shall
        pay to the successful party, in addition to all sums that
        either party may be called on to pay, a reasonable sum for
        the successful party's attorneys' fees.

		         SECTION NINETEEN:  PARAGRAPH HEADINGS 
		 The titles to the paragraphs of this Agreement are solely
         for the convenience for the Parties and shall not be used
         to explain, modify, simplify, or aid in the interpretation
         of the provisions of this Agreement.

	                          SECTION TWENTY: PROMISSORY NOTE
         Pursuant to the terms of this Agreement, and simultaneous
         with the execution of this Agreement, Employer shall
         execute a Promissory Note for the benefit of Employee for
         unpaid compensation between the period of June 1, 1995, and
         October 31, 1995.  IN WITNESS WHEREOF, each party to this
         Agreement has caused it to be executed under seal and on
         the date indicated below.

	EMPLOYEE
           /s/ Stanley H. Van  Etten
         DATE SIGNED: 12/11/95
         EMPLOYER
                                     _(SEAL)
	/s/  Claude  Savage
	Claude  Savage, Director of Employer    
         DATE SIGNED: 12/11/95


            /s/ Larry Smith
           Larry Smith, Director of Employer
         DATE SIGNED: _
                                                          (CORPORATE SEAL)
                        12/18/95

Exhibit 10.2

                CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT

        THIS CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT, is made
        and entered into this 25 day of March, 1996, by and between
        International Heritage, Inc., a North Carolina corporation,
        (the "Company"), and John D. Brothers (the "Employee"), an
        individual residing in Wake County, North Carolina.

        W I T N E S S E T H:

        WHEREAS, the Company wishes to employ Employee and Employee
        wishes to be employed by the Company; and

        WHEREAS, Employee will be employed in a position of trust
        and confidence to aid the Company in its business; and

        WHEREAS, incident to and as a necessary part of Employee's
        employment by the Company, Employee will have access to the
        Company's confidential and proprietary information, and,
        therefore, the Company desires to receive from Employee a
        covenant not to disclose any information related to the
        Company's business; and

        WHEREAS, as a condition of and for and in consideration of
        the Company's employment of Employee, the Company requires
        that Employee enter into this Agreement; and

        WHEREAS, the Employee has received from the Board of
        Directors of the Company a new compensation package
        including a raise effective January 1, 1996, said raise
        being retroactively paid upon the signing of this Agreement;

        NOW,  THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing, of the
        mutual promises herein contained, and of other good and
        valuable consideration, including the employment of Employee
        by the Company, and the compensation received by Employee
        from the Company from time to time, the receipt and
        sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties
        hereto, intending to be legally bound, agree as follows:

        1.  Employment.  Employee is employed, effective as of
        January 1, 1996, as an employee-at-will of the Company,
        subject to the Company's policies, practices and procedures,
        which policies, practices and procedures may be amended by
        the Company from time to time, with or without notice.
        Further, the parties hereto acknowledge and agree that
        Employee's employment and this Agreement can be terminated,
        subject to the provisions herein, by either party, with or
        without cause.  If Employee is being terminated without
        cause, the Company shall give the Employee sixty (60) days'
        written notice and shall pay Employee through the expiration
        of the sixty (60) day notice term, at which point the
        Company shall have no further obligation to Employee.  The
        Company may elect, in its sole discretion, not to have
        Employee perform his or her duties during the sixty (60) day
        notice term.  If Employee is being terminated with cause,
        the Company shall give the Employee fifteen (15) days'
        written notice and shall pay Employee through the expiration
        of the fifteen (15) day notice term, at which time the
        Company shall have no further obligation to Employee.  The
        Company may elect, in its sole discretion, not to have
        Employee perform his or her duties during the fifteen (15)
        day notice term.  If Employee elects to terminate his or her
        employment he or she must give thirty (30) days' written
        notice to the Company and Employee must faithfully fulfill
        all of his or her duties through the expiration of the
        thirty (30) day notice term in order to be entitled to
        compensation through the expiration of said term.  The
        parties acknowledge and agree that nothing contained herein
        is or should be construed as a promise of future or
        continued employment, creating in the Employee any right to
        employment or to any cause of action on account of
        termination of employment.

       2.  Effective Date.  This Agreement is effective as of
		  January 1, 1996.

       3.  Duties.  The Employee shall serve as the Director of
       Compliance and Shareholder Relations for the Company.
       Employee shall faithfully perform all reasonable duties as
       they are prescribed, from time to time, by the President and
       CEO, or other designated parties within the Company, or the
       Board of Directors, or as may be ordinary or incident to the
       position in which Employee is employed.  Employee will devote
       his or her full time, attention and energy to the duties and
       responsibilities incident to his or her position and will not
       engage in any other business activities while an Employee of
       the Company without prior express written consent of the
       Company's President or a majority of the Board of Directors.

       4.  Confidentiality.  Employee agrees to treat all matters
       and information related to the Company's business, including,
       without limitation, trade secrets, products, systems,
       programs, procedures, manuals, guides, confidential reports
       and communications, personnel information, client and
       customer lists, Independent Retail Sales Representative's
       names and any associated information, identities, sales
       information of any nature or description, commissions paid,
       any other data incident to the Company's business, as
       confidential information entrusted to him or her solely for
       use in his or her capacity as an employee of the Company, and
       not to use, divulge, disclose or communicate such information
       in any way to any person or entity (other than to an officer,
       employee or authorized agent of the Company for use in the
       business of the Company) during or after his or her
       employment with the Company.  The Employee agrees that, in
       the event of termination of his or her employment for any
       reason, he or she will not under any circumstances retain any
       information, written or otherwise, concerning the business
       operations of the Company.  This covenant shall survive
       termination of this Agreement and termination of Employee's
       employment.

       5.  Covenant Not To Compete.  It is recognized and understood
       by all parties hereto that the Employee, through his or her
       employment with the Company, will acquire a considerable
       amount of knowledge and goodwill with respect to the business
       of the Company, which knowledge and goodwill are extremely
       valuable to the Company and which would be extremely
       detrimental to the Company if used by the Employee to compete
       with the Company.  It is, therefore, understood and agreed by
       the parties hereto that, because of the nature of the
       business of the Company, it is necessary to afford fair
       protection to the Company from such unfair competition by the
       Employee.  Consequently, the Employee covenants and agrees as
       follows:

       (A) Except as otherwise approved in writing by the Company,
          the Employee agrees:  (i) that during the
           Employee's employment with the Company, and for 
          period of one (1) year from the date of
          termination of the Employee's employment with the
          Company, whether by Employee or Company, he or she
          will not, directly or indirectly, with or throughs
          any family member or former director, officer,
          employee of the Company, or acting alone or as a
          member of a partnership, or as an officer, holder
          of or investor in five percent (5%) or more of any
          security of any class, director, employee,
          consultant, member or representative of any
          corporation or other business entity:

                       (1) engage in, perform or provide services to
                       any network marketing or distribution company
                       within a radius of twenty-five (25) miles of
                       any site upon which the Company has provided
                       services, to include product sales and
                       opportunity meetings or training by an
                       Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                       the Company, which are the same or
                       substantially similar to the services
                       performed or provided by Employee for the
                       Company, or engage in the same or
                       substantially similar business as that
                       engaged in by the Company anywhere in the
                       United States, all United States territories
                       and the provinces of Alberta, Ontario and
                       British Columbia, Canada;

                       (2) request, solicit, approach, or otherwise
                       interfere with or seek to interfere with the
                       relationship between the Company and (a) any
                       Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                       the Company during the one (1) year prior to
                       termination of the Employee's employment with
                       the Company; or (b) any suppliers or vendors
                       of the Company during the one (1) year prior
                       to termination of the Employee's employment
                       with the Company.

 	(ii) that during the Employee's employment with the Company, and
                  for a period of one (1) year from the date of
                  termination of the Employee's employment with the
                  Company, whether by Employee or Company, he or she
                  will not directly or indirectly hire, contract
                  with, induce or attempt to. influence any
                  individual who, at any time during the 180 days
                  prior to the termination of the Employee's
                  employment with the Company, was an employee,
                  agent, or Independent Retail Sales Representative
                  of the Company or any other company owned or
                  operated by the Company, to terminate his or her
                  employment or association with the Company.

             (B) The parties hereto agree that, in the event that
             either the length of time or the geographic area set
             forth in Section 5(A) of this Agreement is found to be
             unreasonable by a court, the court may reduce such
             restrictions to those which it deems reasonable under
             the circumstances.

             (C) The Company's employment of the Employee shall
             constitute sufficient and valuable consideration for
             Employee's obligations under this Agreement.

			 (D) The covenants of Sections 4 and 5 of this Agreement
        shall survive any termination of this Agreement and
        termination of Employee's employment with the Corporation.

        6.  Remedy.  Employee understands and agrees that the
        Company will suffer irreparable harm in the event that the
        Employee breaches any of his or her obligations under this
        Agreement and that monetary damages will be inadequate to
        compensate the Company for such breach.  Accordingly, the
        Employee agrees that, in the event of a breach or threatened
        breach by the Employee of any of the provisions of this
        Agreement, the Company, in addition to and not in limitation
        of any other rights, remedies or damages available to the
        Company at law or in equity, shall be entitled to an
        injunction in order to prevent or to restrain any such
        breach by the Employee, or by the Employee's partners,
        agents, representatives, servants, employers, employees
        and/or any and all persons directly or indirectly acting for
        or with him or her.  The Company shall not be required to
        post any bond to obtain any such injunction.

        7.  Indemnification.  The Company shall indemnify Employee
        who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to
        any pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether
        civil, administrative or investigative (other than an action
        by the Company), by reason of the fact that he or she is an
        Employee of the Company, or is or was serving at the request
        of the Company, against expenses (including attorneys'
        fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement
        actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection
        with such suit, action or proceeding if he or she acted in
        good faith and in a manner he or she reasonably believed to
        be in or not opposed to the best interests of the Company.
        Provided, however, that there shall be no indemnification
        for:  (i) misconduct in the performance of the Employee's
        duties to the Company; (ii) negligence in the performance of
        the Employee's duties to the Company; (iii) gross negligence
        or willful misconduct in the performance of Employee's
        duties to third parties; (iv) felony behavior, or (v)
        violations of criminal or civil statutes.

        8.  Severability.  The invalidity or unenforceability of any
        provision hereto shall in no way affect the validity or
        enforceability of any other provision.

        9.  Modification and Waiver.  This Agreement may be changed
        or modified only if consented to in writing by both parties.
        No waiver of any provision of this Agreement shall be valid
        unless the same is in writing and signed by the party
        against whom such waiver is sought to be enforced; moreover,
        no valid waiver of any other provision of this agreement at
        any time shall be deemed a waiver of any other provision of
        this Agreement at such time, nor will it be deemed a valid
        waiver of such provision at any other time.

        10.  Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and
        according to the laws of the State of North Carolina.

        11.  Benefit.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and
        shall inure to the benefit of each of the parties hereto,
        and to their respective heirs, representatives, successors,
        assigns and affiliates.

        12.  Entire Agreement.  This Agreement contains the entire
        agreement and understandings by and between the Employee and
        the Company with respect to the matters herein described and
        no representations, promises, agreement or understandings,
        written or oral, not herein contained, shall be of any force
        or effect.

         13.  Captions.  The captions in this Agreement are for
         convenience only and in no way define, bind or describe the
         scope or intent of this Agreement.

         14.  Arbitration.  Any dispute arising out of or in
         connection with this Agreement or the breach thereof shall
         be decided by arbitration to be conducted in Raleigh, North
         Carolina in accordance with the then prevailing commercial
         arbitration rules of the American Arbitration Association,
         and judgment thereof may be entered in any court having
         jurisdiction thereof.  A demand for arbitration shall be
         made within a reasonable time after the claim, dispute or
         other matter in question has arisen and in no event shall
         the demand for arbitration be made after the date when
         institution of legal or equitable proceedings based on such
         claim, dispute or other matter in question would be barred
         by the applicable state of limitations.  IN WITNESS
         WHEREOF, the parties hereto have executed this Agreement
         and affixed their respective seals as of the day and year
         first above written.

         ATTEST:
	     INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.

By: /s/ John D. Brothers
        Secretary

                                   EMPLOYEE
CORPORATE SEAL                     /s/ John D. Brothers

                                   /s/ Stanley Van Etten
                                       President and CEO

Exhibit 10.3

                             
              CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT

        THIS CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT, is made
        and entered into this 25 day of March, 1996, by and between
        International Heritage, Inc., a North Carolina corporation,
        (the "Company"), and Mary Breen (the"Employee"), an
        individual residing in Wake County, North Carolina.

                                 W I T N E S S E T H:
        WHEREAS, the Company wishes to employ Employee and Employee
        wishes to be employed by the Company; and

        WHEREAS, Employee will be employed in a position of trust
        and confidence to aid the Company in its business; and

        WHEREAS, incident to and as a necessary part of Employee's
        employment by the Company, Employee will have access to the
        Company's confidential and proprietary information, and,
        therefore, the Company desires to receive from Employee a
        covenant not to disclose any information related to the
        Company's business; and

        WHEREAS, as a condition of and for and in consideration of
        the Company's employment of Employee, the Company requires
        that Employee enter into this Agreement; and

        WHEREAS, the Employee has received from the Board of
        Directors of the Company a new compensation package
        including a raise effective January 1, 1996, said raise
        being retroactively paid upon the signing of this Agreement;

        NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing, of the
        mutual promises herein contained, and of other good and
        valuable consideration, including the employment of Employee
        by the Company, and the compensation received by Employee
        from the Company from time to time, the receipt and
        sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties
        hereto, intending to be legally bound, agree as follows:

        1.  Employment.  Employee is employed, effective as of
        January 1, 1996, as an employee-at-will of the Company,
        subject to the Company's policies, practices and procedures,
        which policies, practices and procedures may be amended by
        the Company from time to time, with or without notice.
        Further, the parties hereto acknowledge and agree that
        Employee's employment and this Agreement can be terminated,
        subject to the provisions herein, by either party, with or
        without cause.  If Employee is being terminated without
        cause, the Company shall give the Employee sixty (60) days'
        written notice and shall pay Employee through the expiration
        of the sixty (60) day notice term, at which point the
        Company shall have no further obligation to Employee.  The
        Company may elect, in its sole discretion, not to have
        Employee perform his or her duties during the sixty (60) day
        notice term.  If Employee is being terminated with cause,
        the Company shall give the Employee fifteen (15) days'
        written notice and shall pay Employee through the expiration
        of the fifteen (15) day notice term, at which time the
        Company shall have no further obligation to Employee.  The
        Company may elect, in its sole discretion, not to have Employee
        perform his or her duties during the fifteen (15) day notice
        term. If Employee elects to terminate his or her employment he
        or she must give thirty (30) days' written notice to the Company
        and Employee must faithfully fulfill all of his or her duties
        through the expiration of the thirty (30) day notice term in
        order to be entitled to compensation through the expiration of
        said term. The parties acknowledge and agree that nothing con-
        tained herein is or should be construed as a promise of future
        or continued employment, creating in the Employee any right to
        employment or to any cause of action on account of termination
        of employment.

        2.  Effective Date.  This Agreement is effective as of January 1,
        1996.

        3.  Duties.  The Employee shall serve as the Director of Represen-
        tative Services and Data Processing for the Company. Employee shall
        faithfully perform all reasonable duties as they are prescribed,
        from time to time, by the President and CEO, or other designated
        parties within the Company, or the Board of Directors, or as may be
        ordinary or incident to the position in which Employee is employed.
        Employee will devote his or her full time, attention and energy to
        the duties and responsibilities incident to his or her position and
        will not engage in any other business activities while an Employee
        of the Company without prior written consent of the Company's
        President or a majority of the Board of Directors.

        4.  Confidentiality.  Employee agrees to treat all matters and infor-
        mation related to the Company's business, including, without limitation,
        trade secrets, products, systems, programs, procedures, manuals, guides,
        confidential reports and communications, personnel information, client
        and customer lists, Independent Retail Sales Representatives' names and
        any associated information, identities, sales information of any nature
        or description, commissions paid, any other data incident to the
        Company's business, as confidential information entrusted to him or her
        solely for use in his or her capacity as an employee of the Company, and
        not to use, divulge, disclose or communicate such information in any way
        to any person or entity (other than to an officer, employee or 
        authorized agent of the Company for use in the business of the 
        Company) during or after his or her employment with the Companyl The 
        Employee agrees that, in the event of 
        termination of his or her employment for any reason, he
        or she will not under any circumstances retain any information, written
        or otherwise, concerning the business operations of the Company. This
        covenant shall survive termination of this Agreement and termination of
        Employee's employment.

        5.  Covenant Not To Compete.  It is recognized and understood by all
        parties hereto that the Employee, through his or her employment with the
        Company, will acquire a considerable amount of knowledge and goodwill
        with respect to the business of the Company, which knowledge and 
        goodwill are extremely valuable to the Company and which would be 
        extremely detrimental to the Company if used by the Employee to 
        compete with the Company. It is, therefore, understood and agreed by the
        parties hereto
        that, because of the nature of the business of the Company, it is
        necessary to afford fair protection to the Company from such unfair
        competition by the Employee. Consequently, the Employee covenants and
        agrees as follows:

        (A) Except as otherwise approved in writing by the Company, the Employee
        agrees:

	(i) that during the Employee's employment with the Company, and
                 for a period of one (1) year from the date of
                 termination of the Employee's employment with the
                 Company, whether by Employee or Company, he or she
                 will not, directly or indirectly, with or through
                 any family member or former director, officer,
                 employee of the Company, or acting alone or as a
                 member of a partnership, or as an officer, holder
                 of or investor in five percent (5 %) or more of any
                 security of any class, director, employee,
                 consultant, member or representative of any
                 corporation or other business entity:
    
                       (1) engage in, perform or provide services to
                       any network marketing or distribution company
                       within a radius of twenty-five (25) miles of
                       any site upon which the Company has provided
                       services, to include product sales and
                       opportunity meetings or training by an
                       Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                       the Company, which are the same or
                       substantially similar to the services
                       performed or provided by Employee for the
                       Company, or engage in the same or
                       substantially similar business as that
                       engaged in by the Company anywhere in the
                       United States, all United States territories
                       and the provinces of Alberta, Ontario and
                       British Columbia, Canada;
    
                       (2) request, solicit, approach, or otherwise
                       interfere with or seek to interfere with the
                       relationship between the Company and (a) any
                       Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                       the Company during the one (1) year prior to
                       termination of the Employee's employment with
                       the Company; or (b) any suppliers or vendors
                       of the Company during the one (1) year prior
                       to termination of the Employee's employment
                       with the Company.

	 (ii) that during the Employee's employment with the Company,
                  and for a period of one (1) year from the date of
                  termination of the Employee's employment with the
                  Company, whether by Employee or Company, he or she
                  will not directly or indirectly hire, contract
                  with, induce or attempt to, influence any
                  individual who, at any time during the 180 days
                  prior to the termination of the Employee's
                  employment with the Company, was an employee,
                  agent, or Independent Retail Sales Representative
                  of the Company or any other company owned or
                  operated by the Company, to terminate his or her
                  employment or association with the Company.
    
             (B) The parties hereto agree that, in the event that
             either the length of time or the geographic area set
             forth in Section 5(A) of this Agreement is found to be
             unreasonable by a court, the court may reduce such
             restrictions to those which it deems reasonable under
             the circumstances.
    
             (C) The Company's employment of the Employee shall
             constitute sufficient and valuable consideration for
             Employee's obligations under this Agreement.
    
             (D) The covenants of Sections 4 and 5 of this Agreement
             shall survive any termination of this Agreement and
             termination of Employee's employment with the
             Corporation.
    
        6.  Remedy.  Employee understands and agrees that the
        Company will suffer irreparable harm in the event that the
        Employee breaches any of his or her obligations under this
        Agreement and that monetary damages will be inadequate to
        compensate the Company for such breach.  Accordingly, the
        Employee agrees that, in the event of a breach or threatened
        breach by the Employee of any of the provisions of this
        Agreement, the Company, in addition to and not in limitation
        of any other rights, remedies or damages available to the
        Company at law or in equity, shall be entitled to an
        injunction in order to prevent or to restrain any such
        breach by the Employee, or by the Employee's partners,
        agents, representatives, servants, employers, employees
        and/or any and all persons directly or indirectly acting for
        or with him or her.  The Company shall not be required to
        post any bond to obtain any such injunction.
    
        7.  Indemnification.  The Company shall indemnify Employee
        who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to
        any pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether
        civil, administrative or investigative (other than an action
        by the Company), by reason of the fact that he or she is an
        Employee of the Company, or is or was serving at the request
        of the Company, against expenses (including attorneys'
        fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement
        actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection
        with such suit, action or proceeding if he or she acted in
        good faith and in a manner he or she reasonably believed to
        be in or not opposed to the best interests of the Company.
        Provided, however, that there shall be no indemnification
        for:  (i) misconduct in the performance of the Employee's
        duties to the Company; (ii) negligence in the performance of
        the Employee's duties to the Company; (iii) gross negligence
        or willful misconduct in the performance of Employee's
        duties to third parties; (iv) felony behavior, or (v)
        violations of criminal or civil statutes.
    
        8.  Severability.  The invalidity or unenforceability of any
           provision hereto shall in no way affect the validity or
           enforceability of any other provision.

        9.  Modification and Waiver.  This Agreement may be changed
        or modified only if consented to in writing by both
        parties.  No waiver of any provision of this Agreement shall
        be valid unless the same is in writing and signed by the
        party against whom such waiver is sought to be enforced;
        moreover, no valid waiver of any other provision of this
        agreement at any time shall be deemed a waiver of any other
        provision of this Agreement at such time, nor will it be
        deemed a valid waiver of such provision at any other time.

        10.  Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and
        according to the laws of the State of North Carolina.

        11.  Benefit.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and
        shall inure to the benefit of each of the parties hereto,
        and to their respective heirs, representatives, successors,
        assigns and affiliates.

         12.  Entire Agreement.  This Agreement contains the entire
         agreement and understandings by and between the Employee
         and the Company with respect to the matters herein
         described and no representations, promises, agreement or
         understandings, written or oral, not herein contained,
         shall be of any force or effect.

        13.  Captions.  The captions in this Agreement are for
        convenience only and in no way define, bind or describe the
        scope or intent of this Agreement.

        14.  Arbitration.  Any dispute arising out of or in
        connection with this Agreement or the breach thereof shall
        be decided by arbitration to be conducted in Raleigh, North
        Carolina in accordance with the then prevailing commercial
        arbitration rules of the American Arbitration Association,
        and judgment thereof may be entered in any court having
        jurisdiction thereof.  A demand for arbitration shall be
        made within a reasonable time after the claim, dispute or
        other matter in question has arisen and in no event shall
        the demand for arbitration be made after the date when
        institution of legal or equitable proceedings based on such
        claim, dispute or other matter in question would be barred
        by the applicable state of limitations.  IN WITNESS WHEREOF,
        the parties hereto have executed this Agreement and affixed
        their respective seals as of the day and year first above
        written.

        ATTEST:
        By: /s/ John Brothers
                Secretary

		CORPORATE SEAL
		INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                            /s/ Stanley H. Van Etten											
                                              	Stanley H. Van Etten
                                                President and CEO
                                      EMPLOYEE
                                           /s/ Mary Breen

Exhibit 10.4

                      CONFIDENTIALITY AND NONCOMPETITION AGREEMENT

         THIS CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT, is made
         and entered into this 25 day of March, 1996, by and between
         International Heritage, Inc., a North Carolina corporation,
         (the "Company), and Dwight Hallman (the "Employee"), an
         individual residing in Wake County, North Carolina.

             		                    W I T N E S S E T H:

         WHEREAS, the Company wishes to employ Employee and Employee
         wishes to be employed by the Company; and

         WHEREAS, Employee will be employed in a position of trust
         and confidence to aid the Company in its business; and

         WHEREAS, incident to and as a necessary part of Employee's
         employment by the Company, Employee will have access to the
         Company's confidential and proprietary information, and,
         therefore, the Company desires to receive from Employee a
         covenant not to disclose any information related to the
         Company's business; and

         WHEREAS, as a condition of and for and in consideration of
         the Company's employment of Employee, the Company requires
         that Employee enter into this Agreement; and

         WHEREAS, the Employee has received from the Board of
         Directors of the Company a new compensation package
         including a raise effective January 1, 1996, said raise
         being retroactively paid upon the signing of this
         Agreement;

         NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing, of the
         mutual promises herein contained, and of other good and
         valuable consideration, including the employment of
         Employee by the Company, and the compensation received by
         Employee from the Company from time to time, the receipt
         and sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the
         parties hereto, intending to be legally bound, agree as
         follows:

         1.  Employment.  Employee is employed, effective as of
         January 1, 1996, as an employee-at-will of the Company,
         subject to the Company's policies, practices and
         procedures, which policies, practices and procedures may be
         amended by the Company from time to time, with or without
         notice.  Further, the parties hereto acknowledge and agree
         that Employee's employment and this Agreement can be
         terminated, subject to the provisions herein, by either
         party, with or without cause.  If Employee is being
         terminated without cause, the Company shall give the
         Employee sixty (60) days' written notice and shall pay
         Employee through the expiration of the sixty (60) day
         notice term, at which point the Company shall have no
         further obligation to Employee.  The Company may elect, in
         its sole discretion, not to have Employee perform his or
         her duties during the sixty (60) day notice term.  If
         Employee is being terminated with cause, the Company shall
         give the Employee fifteen (15) days' written notice and
         shall pay Employee through the expiration of the fifteen
         (15) day notice term, at which time the Company shall have
         no further obligation to Employee.  The Company may elect,
         in its sole discretion, not to have Employee perform his or
         her duties during the fifteen (15) day notice term.  If
         Employee elects to terminate his or her employment he or
         she must give thirty (30) days' written notice to the
         Company and Employee must faithfully fulfill all of his or
         her duties through the expiration of the thirty (30) day
         notice term in order to be entitled to compensation through
         the expiration of said term.  The parties acknowledge and
         agree that nothing contained herein is or should be
         construed as a promise of future or continued employment,
         creating in the Employee any right to employment or to any
         cause of action on account of termination of employment.

        2.  Effective Date.  This Agreement is effective as of
			January 1, 1996.

        3.  Duties.  The Employee shall serve as the Director of
        Operations for the Company.  Employee shall faithfully
        perform all reasonable duties as they are prescribed, from
        time to time, by the President and CEO, or other designated
        parties within the Company, or the Board of Directors, or as
        may be ordinary or incident to the position in which
        Employee is employed.  Employee will devote his or her full
        time, attention and energy to the duties and
        responsibilities incident to his or her position and will
        not engage in any other business activities while an
        Employee of the Company without prior express written
        consent of the Company's President or a majority of the
        Board of Directors.

        4.  Confidentiality.  Employee agrees to treat all matters
        and information related to the Company's business,
        including, without limitation, trade secrets, products,
        systems, programs, procedures, manuals, guides, confidential
        reports and communications, personnel information, client
        and customer lists, Independent Retail Sales
        Representative's names and any associated information,
        identities, sales information of any nature or description,
        commissions paid, any other data incident to the Company's
        business, as confidential information entrusted to him or
        her solely for use in his or her capacity as an employee of
        the Company, and not to use, divulge, disclose or
        communicate such information in any way to any person or
        entity (other than to an officer, employee or authorized
        agent of the Company for use in the business of the Company)
        during or after his or her employment with the Company.  The
        Employee agrees that, in the event of termination of his or
        her employment for any reason, he or she will not under any
        circumstances retain any information, written or otherwise,
        concerning the business operations of the Company.  This
        covenant shall survive termination of this Agreement and
        termination of Employee's employment.

        5.  Covenant Not To Compete.  It is recognized and
        understood by all parties hereto that the Employee, through
        his or her employment with the Company, will acquire a
        considerable amount of knowledge and goodwill with respect
        to the business of the Company, which knowledge and goodwill
        are extremely valuable to the Company and which would be
        extremely detrimental to the Company if used by the Employee
        to compete with the Company.  It is, therefore, understood
        and agreed by the parties hereto that, because of the nature
        of the business of the Company, it is necessary to afford
        fair protection to the Company from such unfair competition
        by the Employee.  Consequently, the Employee covenants and
        agrees as follows:

        (A) Except as otherwise approved in writing by the Company,
			the Employee agrees:

        (i) that during the Employee's employment with the Company,
            and for a period of one (1) year from the date of
            termination of the Employee's employment with the
            Company, whether by Employee or Company, he or she will
            not, directly or indirectly, with or through any family
            member or former director, officer, employee of the
            Company, or acting alone or as a member of a
            partnership, or as an officer, holder of or investor in
            five percent (5%) or more of any security of any class,
            director, employee, consultant, member or representative
            of any corporation or other business entity:

                       (1) engage in, perform or provide services to
                       any network marketing or distribution company
                       within a radius of twenty-five (25) miles of
                       any site upon which the Company has provided
                       services, to include product sales and
                       opportunity meetings or training by an
                       Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                       the Company, which are the same or
                       substantially similar to the services
                       performed or provided by Employee for the
                       Company, or engage in the same or
                       substantially similar business as that
                       engaged in by the Company anywhere in the
                       United States, all United States territories
                       and the provinces of Alberta, Ontario and
                       British Columbia, Canada;

                       (2) request, solicit, approach, or otherwise
                       interfere with or seek to interfere with the
                       relationship between the Company and (a) any
                       Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                       the Company during the one (1) year prior to
                       termination of the Employee's employment with
                       the Company; or (b) any suppliers or vendors
                       of the Company during the one (1) year prior
                       to termination of the Employee's employment
                       with the Company.

                  (ii) that during the Employee's employment with
                  the Company, and for a period of one (1) year from
                  the date of termination of the Employee's
                  employment with the Company, whether by Employee
                  or Company, he or she will not directly or
                  indirectly hire, contract with, induce or attempt
                  to influence any individual who, at any time
                  during the 180 days prior to the termination of
                  the Employee's employment with the Company, was an
                  employee, agent, or Independent Retail Sales
                  Representative of the Company or any other company
                  owned or operated by the Company, to terminate his
                  or her employment or association with the Company.

             (B) The parties hereto agree that, in the event that
             either the length of time or the geographic area set
             forth in Section 5(A) of this Agreement is found to be
             unreasonable by a court, the court may reduce such
             restrictions to those which it deems reasonable under
             the circumstances.

             (C) The Company's employment of the Employee shall
             constitute sufficient and valuable consideration for
             Employee's obligations under this Agreement.

             (D) The covenants of Sections 4 and 5 of this Agreement
             shall survive any termination of this Agreement and
             termination of Employee's employment with the
             Corporation.

       6.  Remedy.  Employee understands and agrees that the Company
       will suffer irreparable harm in the event that the Employee
       breaches any of his or her obligations under this Agreement
       and that monetary damages will be inadequate to compensate
       the Company for such breach.  Accordingly, the Employee
       agrees that, in the event of a breach or threatened breach by
       the Employee of any of the provisions of this Agreement, the
       Company, in addition to and not in limitation of any other
       rights, remedies or damages available to the Company at law
       or in equity, shall be entitled to an injunction in order to
       prevent or to restrain any such breach by the Employee, or by
       the Employee's partners, agents, representatives, servants,
       employers, employees and/or any and all persons directly or
       indirectly acting for or with him or her.  The Company shall
       not be required to post any bond to obtain any such
       injunction.

        7.  Indemnification.  The Company shall indemnify Employee
        who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to
        any pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether
        civil, administrative or investigative (other than an action
        by the Company), by reason of the fact that he or she is an
        Employee of the Company, or is or was serving at the request
        of the Company, against expenses (including attorneys'
        fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement
        actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection
        with such suit, action or proceeding if he or she acted in
        good faith and in a manner he or she reasonably believed to
        be in or not opposed to the best interests of the Company.
        Provided, however, that there shall be no indemnification
        for:  (i) misconduct in the performance of the Employee's
        duties to the Company; (ii) negligence in the performance of
        the Employee's duties to the Company; (iii) gross negligence
        or willful misconduct in the performance of Employee's
        duties to third parties; (iv) felony behavior, or (v)
        violations of criminal or civil statutes.

        8.  Severability.  The invalidity or unenforceability of any
        provision hereto shall in no way affect the validity or
        enforceability of any other provision.

        9.  Modification and Waiver.  This Agreement may be changed
        or modified only if consented to in writing by both parties.
        No waiver of any provision of this Agreement shall be valid
        unless the same is in writing and signed by the party
        against whom such waiver is sought to be enforced; moreover,
        no valid waiver of any other provision of this agreement at
        any time shall be deemed a waiver of any other provision of
        this Agreement at such time, nor will it be deemed a valid
        waiver of such provision at any other time.

        10.  Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and
        according to the laws of the State of North Carolina.

        11.  Benefit.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and
        shall inure to the benefit of each of the parties hereto,
        and to their respective heirs, representatives, successors,
        assigns and affiliates.

        12.  Entire Agreement.  This Agreement contains the entire
        agreement and understandings by and between the Employee and
        the Company with respect to the matters herein described and
        no representations, promises, agreement or understandings,
        written or oral, not herein contained, shall be of any force
        or effect.

        13.  Captions.  The captions in this Agreement are for
        convenience only and in no way define, bind or describe the
        scope or intent of this Agreement.

        14.  Arbitration.  Any dispute arising out of or in
        connection with this Agreement or the breach thereof shall
        be decided by arbitration to be conducted in Raleigh, North
        Carolina in accordance with the then prevailing commercial
        arbitration rules of the American Arbitration Association,
        and judgment thereof may be entered in any court having
        jurisdiction thereof.  A demand for arbitration shall be
        made within a reasonable time after the claim, dispute or
        other matter in question has arisen and in no event shall
        the demand for arbitration be made after the date when
        institution of legal or equitable proceedings based on such
        claim, dispute or other matter in question would be barred
        by the applicable state of limitations.  IN WITNESS WHEREOF,
        the parties hereto have executed this Agreement and affixed
        their respective seals as of the day and year first above
        written.

        ATTEST:

           By:/s/John Brothers
               Secretary

CORPORATE SEAL
                                           INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                            Stanley H. Van Etten
                                            President and CEO
EMPLOYEE
/s/ Dwight Hallman

Exhibit 10.5


                 CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT

        THIS CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT, is made
        and entered into this 25 day of March, 1996, by and between
        International Inc., a North Carolina corporation, (the
        "Company"), and Clark Jones (the "Employee"), an individual
        residing in Wake County, North Carolina.

                                WITNESSETH:

        WHEREAS, the Company wishes to employ Employee and Employee
        wishes to be employed by the Company; and

        WHEREAS, Employee will be employed in a position of trust
        and confidence to aid the Company in its business; and

        WHEREAS, incident to and as a necessary part of Employee's
        employment by the Company, Employee will have access to the
        Company's confidential and proprietary information, and,
        therefore, the Company desires to receive from Employee a
        covenant not to disclose any information related to the
        Company's business; and

        WHEREAS, as a condition of and for and in consideration of
        the Company's employment of Employee, the Company requires
        that Employee enter into this Agreement; and

        WHEREAS, the Employee has received from the Board of
        Directors of the Company a new compensation package
        including a raise effective January 1, 1996, said raise
        being retroactively paid upon the signing of this Agreement;

        NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing, of the
        mutual promises herein contained, and of other good and
        valuable consideration, including the employment of Employee
        by the Company, and the compensation received by Employee
        from the Company from time to time, the receipt and
        sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties
        hereto, intending to be legally bound, agree as follows:

        1.  Employment.  Employee is employed, effective as of
        January 1, 1996, as an employee-at-will of the Company,
        subject to the Company's policies, practices and procedures,
        which policies, practices and procedures may be amended by
        the Company from time to time, with or without notice.
        Further, the parties hereto acknowledge and agree that
        Employee's employment and this Agreement can be terminated,
        subject to the provisions herein, by either party, with or
        without cause.  If Employee is being terminated without
        cause, the Company shall give the Employee sixty (60) days'
        written notice and shall pay Employee through the expiration
        of the sixty (60) day notice term, at which point the
        Company shall have no further obligation to Employee.  The
        Company may elect, in its sole discretion, not to have
        Employee perform his or her duties during the sixty (60) day
        notice term.  If Employee is being terminated with cause,
        the Company shall give the Employee fifteen (15) days'
        written notice and shall pay Employee through the expiration
        of the fifteen (15) day notice term, at which time the
        Company shall have no further obligation to Employee.  The
        Company may elect, in its sole discretion, not to have
        Employee perform his or her duties during the fifteen (15)
        day notice term.  If Employee elects to terminate his or her
        employment he or she must give thirty (30) days' written
        notice to the Company and Employee must faithfully fulfill
        all of his or her duties through the expiration of the
        thirty (30) day notice term in order to be entitled to
        compensation through the expiration of said term.  The
        parties acknowledge and agree that nothing contained herein
        is or should be construed as a promise of future or
        continued employment, creating in the Employee any right to
        employment or to any cause of action on account of
        termination of employment.

        2.  Effective Date.  This Agreement is effective as of
			January 1, 1996.

        3.  Duties.  The Employee shall serve as the Controller for
        the Company.  Employee shall faithfully perform all
        reasonable duties as they are prescribed, from time to time,
        by the President and CEO, or other designated parties within
        the Company, or the Board of Directors, or as may be
        ordinary or incident to the position in which Employee is
        employed.  Employee will devote his or her full time,
        attention and energy to the duties and responsibilities
        incident to his or her position and will not engage in any
        other business activities while an Employee of the Company
        without prior express written consent of the Company's
        President or a majority of the Board of Directors.

         4.  Confidentiality.  Employee agrees to treat all matters
         and information related to the Company's business,
         including, without limitation, trade secrets, products,
         systems, programs, procedures, manuals, guides,
         confidential reports and communications, personnel
         information, client and customer lists, Independent Retail
         Sales Representative's names and any associated
         information, identities, sales information of any nature or
         description, commissions paid, any other data incident to
         the Company's business, as confidential information
         entrusted to him or her solely for use in his or her
         capacity as an employee of the Company, and not to use,
         divulge, disclose or communicate such information in any
         way to any person or entity (other than to an officer,
         employee or authorized agent of the Company for use in the
         business of the Company) during or after his or her
         employment with the Company.  The Employee agrees that, in
         the event of termination of his or her employment for any
         reason, he or she will not under any circumstances retain
         any information, written or otherwise, concerning the
         business operations of the Company.  This covenant shall
         survive termination of this Agreement and termination of
         Employee's employment.

         5.  Covenant Not To Compete.  It is recognized and
         understood by all parties hereto that the Employee, through
         his or her employment with the Company, will acquire a
         considerable amount of knowledge and goodwill with respect
         to the business of the Company, which knowledge and
         goodwill are extremely valuable to the Company and which
         would be extremely detrimental to the Company if used by
         the Employee to compete with the Company.  It is,
         therefore, understood and agreed by the parties hereto
         that, because of the nature of the business of the Company,
         it is necessary to afford fair protection to the Company
         from such unfair competition by the Employee.
         Consequently, the Employee covenants and agrees as follows:

        (A) Except as otherwise approved in writing by the Company,
			the Employee agrees:

        (i) that during the Employee's employment with the Company, and
            for a period of one (1) year from the date of
            termination of the Employee's employment with the
            Company, whether by Employee or Company, he or she will
            not, directly or indirectly, with or through any family
            member or former director, officer, employee of the
            Company, or acting alone or as a member of a
            partnership, or as an officer, holder of or investor in
            five percent (5%) or more of any security of any class,
            director, employee, consultant, member or representative
            of any corporation or other business entity:

                        (1) engage in, perform or provide services
                        to any network marketing or distribution
                        company within a radius of twenty-five (25)
                        miles of any site upon which the Company has
                        provided services, to include product sales
                        and opportunity meetings or training by an
                        Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                        the Company, which are the same or
                        substantially similar to the services
                        performed or provided by Employee for the
                        Company, or engage in the same or
                        substantially similar business as that
                        engaged in by the Company anywhere in the
                        United States, all United States territories
                        and the provinces of Alberta, Ontario and
                        British Columbia, Canada;

                        (2) request, solicit, approach, or otherwise
                        interfere with or seek to interfere with the
                        relationship between the Company and (a) any
                        Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                        the Company during the one (1) year prior to
                        termination of the Employee's employment
                        with the Company; or (b) any suppliers or
                        vendors of the Company during the one (1)
                        year prior to termination of the Employee's
                        employment with the Company.

            (ii) that during the Employee's employment with the
                  Company, and for a period of one (1) year from the
                  date of termination of the Employee's employment
                  with the Company, whether by Employee or Company,
                  he or she will not directly or indirectly hire,
                  contract with, induce or attempt to influence any
                  individual who, at any time during the 180 days
                  prior to the termination of the Employee's
                  employment with the Company, was an employee,
                  agent, or Independent Retail Sales Representative
                  of the Company or any other company owned or
                  operated by the Company, to terminate his or her
                  employment or association with the Company.

              (B) The parties hereto agree that, in the event that
              either the length of time or the geographic area set
              forth in Section 5(A) of this Agreement is found to be
              unreasonable by a court, the court may reduce such
              restrictions to those which it deems reasonable under
              the circumstances.

              (C) The Company's employment of the Employee shall
              constitute sufficient and valuable consideration for
              Employee's obligations under this Agreement.

              (D) The covenants of Sections 4 and 5 of this Agreement
             shall survive any termination of this Agreement and
             termination of Employee's employment with the
             Corporation.

        6.  Remedy.  Employee understands and agrees that the
        Company will suffer irreparable harm in the event that the
        Employee breaches any of his or her obligations under this
        Agreement and that monetary damages will be inadequate to
        compensate the Company for such breach.  Accordingly, the
        Employee agrees that, in the event of a breach or threatened
        breach by the Employee of any of the provisions of this
        Agreement, the Company, in addition to and not in limitation
        of any other rights, remedies or damages available to the
        Company at law or in equity, shall be entitled to an
        injunction in order to prevent or to restrain any such
        breach by the Employee, or by the Employee's partners,
        agents, representatives, servants, employers, employees
        and/or any and all persons directly or indirectly acting for
        or with him or her.  The Company shall not be required to
        post any bond to obtain any such injunction.

        7.  Indemnification.  The Company shall indemnify Employee
        who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to
        any pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether
        civil, administrative or investigative (other than an action
        by the Company), by reason of the fact that he or she is an
        Employee of the Company, or is or was serving at the request
        of the Company, against expenses (including attorneys'
        fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement
        actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection
        with such suit, action or proceeding if he or she acted in
        good faith and in a manner he or she reasonably believed to
        be in or not opposed to the best interests of the Company.
        Provided, however, that there shall be no indemnification
        for:  (i) misconduct in the performance of the Employee's
        duties to the Company; (ii) negligence in the performance of
        the Employee's duties to the Company; (iii) gross negligence
        or willful misconduct in the performance of Employee's
        duties to third parties; (iv) felony behavior, or (v)
        violations of criminal or civil statutes.

        8.  Severability.  The invalidity or unenforceability of any
        provision hereto shall in no way affect the validity or
        enforceability of any other provision.

        9.  Modification and Waiver.  This Agreement may be changed
        or modified only if consented to in writing by both parties.
        No waiver of any provision of this Agreement shall be valid
        unless the same is in writing and signed by the party
        against whom such waiver is sought to be enforced; moreover,
        no valid waiver of any other provision of this agreement at
        any time shall be deemed a waiver of any other provision of
        this Agreement at such time, nor will it be deemed a valid
        waiver of such provision at any other time.

        10.  Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and
        according to the laws of the State of North Carolina.

        11.  Benefit.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and
        shall inure to the benefit of each of the parties hereto,
        and to their respective heirs, representatives, successors,
        assigns and affiliates.

        12.  Entire Agreement.  This Agreement contains the entire
        agreement and understandings by and between the Employee and
        the Company with respect to the matters herein described and
        no representations, promises, agreement or understandings,
        written or oral, not herein contained, shall be of any force
        or effect.

        13.  Captions.  The captions in this Agreement are for
        convenience only and in no way define, bind or describe the
        scope or intent of this Agreement.

        14.  Arbitration.  Any dispute arising out of or in
        connection with this Agreement or the breach thereof shall
        be decided by arbitration to be conducted in Raleigh, North
        Carolina in accordance with the then prevailing commercial
        arbitration rules of the American Arbitration Association,
        and judgment thereof may be entered in any court having
        jurisdiction thereof.  A demand for arbitration shall be
        made within a reasonable time after the claim, dispute or
        other matter in question has arisen and in no event shall
        the demand for arbitration be made after the date when
        institution of legal or equitable proceedings based on such
        claim, dispute or other matter in question would be barred
        by the applicable state of limitations.  IN WITNESS WHEREOF,
        the parties hereto have executed this Agreement and affixed
        their respective seals as of the day and year first above
        written.
        ATTEST:

  By:/s/John Brothers
        Secretary

				INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE INC.
                                /s/ Stanley H. Van Ellen
                                    President and CEO


                                      EMPLOYEE
                                      /s/ Clark Jones
CORPORATE SEAL

Exhibit 10.6



                  CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT

        THIS CONFIDENTLALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT, is made
        and entered into this 25 day of March, 1996, by and between
        International Heritage, Inc., a North Carolina corporation,
        (the"Company"), and Dawn McIntyre (the "Employee"), an
        individual residing in Wake County, North Carolina.

                                 W I T N E S S E T H:
        WHEREAS, the Company wishes to employ Employee and Employee
        wishes to be employed by the Company; and

        WHEREAS, Employee will be employed in a position of trust
        and confidence to aid the Company in its business; and

        WHEREAS, incident to and as a necessary part of Employee's
        employment by the Company, Employee will have access to the
        Company's confidential and proprietary information, and,
        therefore, the Company desires to receive from Employee a
        covenant not to disclose any information related to the
        Company's business; and

        WHEREAS, as a condition of and for and in consideration of
        the Company's employment of Employee, the Company requires
        that Employee enter into this Agreement; and

        WHEREAS, the Employee has received from the Board of
        Directors of the Company a new compensation package
        including a raise effective January 1, 1996, said raise
        being retroactively paid upon the signing of this Agreement;

        NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing, of the
        mutual promises herein contained, and of other good and
        valuable consideration, including the employment of Employee
        by the Company, and the compensation received by Employee
        from the Company from time to time, the receipt and
        sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties
        hereto, intending to be legally bound, agree as follows:

        1.  Employment.  Employee is employed, effective as of
        January 1, 1996, as an employee-at-will of the Company,
        subject to the Company's policies, practices and procedures,
        which policies, practices and procedures may be amended by
        the Company from time to time, with or without notice.
        Further, the parties hereto acknowledge and agree that
        Employee's employment and this Agreement can be terminated,
        subject to the provisions herein, by either party, with or
        without cause.  If Employee is being terminated without
        cause, the Company shall give the Employee sixty (60) days'
        written notice and shall pay Employee through the expiration
        of the sixty (60) day notice term, at which point the
        Company shall have no further obligation to Employee.  The
        Company may elect, in its sole discretion, not to have
        Employee perform his or her duties during the sixty (60) day
        notice term.  If Employee is being terminated with cause,
        the Company shall give the Employee fifteen (15) days'
        written notice and shall pay Employee through the expiration
        of the fifteen (15) day notice term, at which time the
        Company shall have no further obligation to Employee.  The
        Company may elect, in its sole discretion, not to have
        Employee perform his or her duties during the fifteen (15)
        day notice term.  If Employee elects to terminate his or her
        employment he or she must give thirty (30) days' written
        notice to the Company and Employee must faithfully fulfill
        all of his or her duties through the expiration of the
        thirty (30) day notice term in order to be entitled to
        compensation through the expiration of said term.  The
        parties acknowledge and agree that nothing contained herein
        is or should be construed as a promise of future or
        continued employment, creating in the Employee any right to
        employment or to any cause of action on account of
        termination of employment.

        2.  Effective Date.  This Agreement is effective as of
        January 1, 1996.

        3.  Duties.  The Employee shall serve as the Director of
        Marketing and Fulfillment for the Company.  Employee shall
        faithfully perform all reasonable duties as they are
        prescribed, from time to time, by the President and CEO, or
        other designated parties within the Company, or the Board of
        Directors, or as may be ordinary or incident to the position
        in which Employee is employed.  Employee will devote his or
        her full time, attention and energy to the duties and
        responsibilities incident to his or her position and will
        not engage in any other business activities while an
        Employee of the Company without prior express written
        consent of the Company's President or a majority of the
        Board of Directors.

        4.  Confidentiality.  Employee agrees to treat all matters
        and information related to the Company's business,
        including, without limitation, trade secrets, products,
        systems, programs, procedures, manuals, guides, confidential
        reports and communications, personnel information, client
        and customer lists, Independent Retail Sales
        Representative's names and any associated information,
        identities, sales information of any nature or description,
        commissions paid, any other data incident to the Company's
        business, as confidential information entrusted to him or
        her solely for use in his or her capacity as an employee of
        the Company, and not to use, divulge, disclose or
        communicate such information in any way to any person or
        entity (other than to an officer, employee or authorized
        agent of the Company for use in the business of the Company)
        during or after his or her employment with the Company.  The
        Employee agrees that, in the event of termination of his or
        her employment for any reason, he or she will not under any
        circumstances retain any information, written or otherwise,
        concerning the business operations of the Company.  This
        covenant shall survive termination of this Agreement and
        termination of Employee's employment.

        5.  Covenant Not To Compete.  It is recognized and
        understood by all parties hereto that the Employee, through
        his or her employment with the Company, will acquire a
        considerable amount of knowledge and goodwill with respect
        to the business of the Company, which knowledge and goodwill
        are extremely valuable to the Company and which would be
        extremely detrimental to the Company if used by the Employee
        to compete with the Company.  It is, therefore, understood
        and agreed by the parties hereto that, because of the nature
        of the business of the Company, it is necessary to afford
        fair protection to the Company from such unfair competition
        by the Employee.  Consequently, the Employee covenants and
        agrees as follows:

        (A) Except as otherwise approved in writing by the Company,
			the Employee agrees:
	
        (i) that during the Employee's employment with the Company,
                   and for a period of one (1) year from the date of
                   termination of the Employee's employment with the
                   Company, whether by Employee or Company, he or
                   she will not, directly or indirectly, with or
                   through any family member or former director,
                   officer, employee of the Company, or acting alone
                   or as a member of a partnership, or as an
                   officer, holder of or investor in five percent
                   (5%) or more of any security of any class,
                   director, employee, consultant, member or
                   representative of any corporation or other
                   business entity:
   
   (1) engage in, perform or provide services to any network marketing
    or distribution company within a radius of twenty-five (25) miles of any
    site upon which the Company has provided services, to include product
    sales and opportunity meetings or training by an Independent Retail Sales
    Representative of the Company, which are the same or substantially
    similar to the services performed or provided by Employee for the
    Company, or engage in the same or substantially similar business as that
    engaged in by the Company anywhere in the United States, all United
    States territories and the provinces of Alberta, Ontario and British
    Columbia, Canada;

                        (2) request, solicit, approach, or otherwise
                        interfere with or seek to interfere with the
                        relationship between the Company and (a) any
                        Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                        the Company during the one (1) year prior to
                        termination of the Employee's employment
                        with the Company; or (b) any suppliers or
                        vendors of the Company during the one (1)
                        year prior to termination of the Employee's
                        employment with the Company.
    
                   (ii) that during the Employee's employment with
                   the Company, and for a period of one (1) year
                   from the date of termination of the Employee's
                   employment with the Company, whether by Employee
                   or Company, he or she will not directly or
                   indirectly hire, contract with, induce or attempt
                   to influence any individual who, at any time
                   during the 180 days prior to the termination of
                   the Employee's employment with the Company, was
                   an employee, agent, or Independent Retail Sales
                   Representative of the Company or any other
                   company owned or operated by the Company, to
                   terminate his or her employment or association
                   with the Company.
    
              (B) The parties hereto agree that, in the event that
              either the length of time or the geographic area set
              forth in Section 5(A) of this Agreement is found to be
              unreasonable by a court, the court may reduce such
              restrictions to those which it deems reasonable under
              the circumstances.
    
              (C) The Company's employment of the Employee shall
              constitute sufficient and valuable consideration for
              Employee's obligations under this Agreement.
    
             (D) The covenants of Sections 4 and 5 of this Agreement
             shall survive any termination of this Agreement and
             termination of Employee's employment with the
             Corporation.
    
        6.  Remedy.  Employee understands and agrees that the
        Company will suffer irreparable harm in the event that the
        Employee breaches any of his or her obligations under this
        Agreement and that monetary damages will be inadequate to
        compensate the Company for such breach.  Accordingly, the
        Employee agrees that, in the event of a breach or threatened
        breach by the Employee of any of the provisions of this
        Agreement, the Company, in addition to and not in limitation
        of any other rights, remedies or damages available to the
        Company at law or in equity, shall be entitled to an
        injunction in order to prevent or to restrain any such
        breach by the Employee, or by the Employee's partners,
        agents, representatives, servants, employers, employees
        and/or any and all persons directly or indirectly acting for
        or with him or her.  The Company shall not be required to
        post any bond to obtain any such injunction.

        7.  Indemnification.  The Company shall indemnify Employee
        who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to
        any pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether
        civil, administrative or investigative (other than an action
        by the Company), by reason of the fact that he or she is an
        Employee of the Company, or is or was serving at the request
        of the Company, against expenses (including attorneys'
        fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement
        actually and reasonably incurred by him or her in connection
        with such suit, action or proceeding if he or she acted in
        good faith and in a manner he or she reasonably believed to
        be in or not opposed to the best interests of the Company.
        Provided, however, that there shall be no indemnification
        for:  (i) misconduct in the performance of the Employee's
        duties to the Company; (ii) negligence in the performance of
        the Employee's duties to the Company; (iii) gross
        negligence or willful misconduct in the performance of
        Employee's duties to third parties; (iv) felony behavior, or
        (v) violations of criminal or civil statutes.

        8.  Severability.  The invalidity or unenforceability of any
        provision hereto shall in no way affect the validity or
        enforceability of any other provision.

        9.  Modification and Waiver.  This Agreement may be changed
        or modified only if consented to in writing by both parties.
        No waiver of any provision of this Agreement shall be valid
        unless the same is in writing and signed by the party
        against whom such waiver is sought to be enforced; moreover,
        no valid waiver of any other provision of this agreement at
        any time shall be deemed a waiver of any other provision of
        this Agreement at such time, nor will it be deemed a valid
        waiver of such provision at any other time.

        10.  Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and
        according to the laws of the State of North Carolina.

        11.  Benefit.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and
        shall inure to the benefit of each of the parties hereto,
        and to their respective heirs, representatives, successors,
        assigns and affiliates.

        12.  Entire Agreement.  This Agreement contains the entire
        agreement and understandings by and between the Employee and
        the Company with respect to the matters herein described and
        no representations, promises, agreement or understandings,
        written or oral, not herein contained, shall be of any force
        or effect.

        13.  Captions. The captions in this Agreement are for
        convenience only and in no way define, bind or describe the
        scope or intent of this Agreement.

        14.  Arbitration.  Any dispute arising out of or in
        connection with this Agreement or the breach thereof shall
        be decided by arbitration to be conducted in Raleigh, North
        Carolina in accordance with the then prevailing commercial
        arbitration rules of the American Arbitration Association,
        and judgment thereof may be entered in any court having
        jurisdiction thereof.  A demand for arbitration shall be
        made within a reasonable time after the claim, dispute or
        other matter in question has arisen and in no event shall
        the demand for arbitration be made after the date when
        institution of legal or equitable proceedings based on such
        claim, dispute or other matter in question would be barred
        by the applicable state of limitations.  IN WITNESS WHEREOF,
        the parties hereto have executed this Agreement and affixed
        their respective seals as of the day and year first above
        written.

        ATTEST:
        By./s/ John Brothers
               Secretary


                                       INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                       By /s/ Stanley H. Van Etten
                                              President and CEO

CORPORATE SEAL

                                              
                                       EMPLOYEE
                                       /s/Dawn McIntyre

Exhibit 10.7

              CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT

        THIS CONFIDENTIALITY AND NON-COMPETITION AGREEMENT, is made
        and entered into this 29 day of April, 1996, by and between
        International Heritage, Inc., a North Carolina corporation,
        (the "Company"), and Stephanie Harris (the "Employee"), an
        individual residing in Wake County, North Carolina.

               	                  WITNESSETH:
        WHEREAS, the Company wishes to employ Employee and Employee
        wishes to be employed by the Company; and

        WHEREAS, Employee will be employed in a position of trust
        and confidence to aid the Company in its business; and

        WHEREAS, incident to and as a necessary part of Employee's
        employment by the Company, Employee will have access to the
        Company's confidential and proprietary information, and,
        therefore, the Company desires to receive from Employee a
        covenant not to disclose any information related to the
        Company's business; and

        WHEREAS, as a condition of and for and in consideration of
        the Company's employment of Employee, the Company requires
        that Employee enter into this Agreement; and

        WHEREAS, the Employee has received a raise from the Company
        effective April 19, 1996, and upon successful completion of
        a month-long intensive training with 20/21 shall receive a
        subsequent raise; and

        NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the foregoing, of the
        mutual promises herein contained, and of other good and
        valuable consideration, including the employment of Employee
        by the Company, and the compensation received by Employee
        from the Company from time to time, the receipt and
        sufficiency of which are hereby acknowledged, the parties
        hereto, intending to be legally bound, agree as follows:

        1.  Employment.  Employee is employed, effective as the
        execution of this Agreement, as an employee-at-will of the
        Company, subject to the Company's policies, practices and
        procedures, which policies, practices and procedures may be
        amended by the Company from time to time, with or without
        notice.  Further, the parties hereto acknowledge and agree
        that Employee's employment and this Agreement can be
        terminated, subject to the provisions herein, by either
        party, with or without cause.  If Employee is being
        terminated without cause, the Company shall give the
        Employee sixty (60) days' written notice and shall pay
        Employee through the expiration of the sixty (60) day notice
        term, at which point the Company shall have no further
        obligation to Employee.  The Company may elect, in its sole
        discretion, not to have Employee perform his or her duties
        during the sixty (60) day notice term.  If Employee is being
        terminated with cause, the Company shall give the Employee
        fifteen (15) days' written notice and shall pay Employee
        through the expiration of the fifteen (15) day notice term,
        at which time the Company shall have no further obligation
        to Employee.  The Company may elect, in its sole discretion,
        not to have Employee perform his or her duties during the
        fifteen (15) day notice term.  If Employee elects to
        terminate his or her employment he or she must give thirty
        (30) days' written notice to the Company and Employee must
        faithfully fulfill all of his or her duties through the
        expiration of the thirty (30) day notice term in order to be
        entitled to compensation through the expiration of said
        term.  The parties acknowledge and agree that nothing
        contained herein is or should be construed as a promise of
        future or continued employment, creating in the Employee any
        right to employment or to any cause of action on account of
        termination of employment.

        2.  Effective Date.  This Agreement is effective as of date
        of execution.

        3.  Duties.  The Employee shall serve as the Data Systems
        Manager for the Company.  Employee shall faithfully perform
        all reasonable duties as they are prescribed, from time to
        time, by the President and CEO, or other designated parties
        within the Company, or the Board of Directors, or as may be
        ordinary or incident to the position in which Employee is
        employed.  Employee will devote his or her full time,
        attention and energy to the duties and responsibilities
        incident to his or her position and will not engage in any
        other business activities while an Employee of the Company
        without prior express written consent of the Company's
        President or a majority of the Board of Directors.

        4.  Confidentiality.  Employee agrees to treat all matters
        and information related to the Company's business,
        including, without limitation, trade secrets, products,
        systems, programs, procedures, manuals, guides, confidential
        reports and communications, personnel information, client
        and customer lists, Independent Retail Sales
        Representative's names and any associated information,
        identities, sales information of any nature or description,
        commissions paid, any other data incident to the Company's
        business, as confidential information entrusted to him or
        her solely for use in his or her capacity as an employee of
        the Company, and not to use, divulge, disclose or
        communicate such information in any way to any person or
        entity (other than to an officer, employee or authorized
        agent of the Company for use in the business of the Company)
        during or after his or her employment with the Company.  The
        Employee agrees that, in the event of termination of his or
        her employment for any reason, he or she will not under any
        circumstances retain any information, written or otherwise,
        concerning the business operations of the Company.  This
        covenant shall survive termination of this Agreement and
        termination of Employee's employment.

        5. Covenant Not To Compete.
        It is recognized and understood by all parties
        hereto that the Employee, through his or her employment with
        the Company, will acquire a considerable amount of knowledge
        and goodwill with respect to the business of the Company,
        which knowledge and goodwill are extremely valuable to the
        Company and which would be extremely detrimental to the
        Company if used by the Employee to compete with the Company.
        It is, therefore, understood and agreed by the parties
        hereto that, because of the nature of the business of the
        Company, it is necessary to afford fair protection to the
        Company from such unfair competition by the Employee.
        Consequently, the Employee covenants and agrees as follows:
               
              (A) Except as otherwise approved in writing by the
                  Company, the Employee agrees: (i) that during the
                  Employee's employment with the Company, and for a
                  period of one (1) year from the date of
                  termination of the Employee's employment with the
                  Company, whether by Employee or Company, he or she
                  will not, directly or indirectly, with or through
                  any family member or former director, officer,
                  employee of the Company, or acting alone or as a
                  member of a partnership, or as an officer, holder
                  of or investor in five percent (5 %) or more of
                  any security of any class, director, employee,
                  consultant, member or representative of any
                  corporation or other business entity:  (1) engage
                  in, perform or provide services to any network
                  marketing or distribution company within a radius
                  of twenty-five (25) miles of any site upon which
                  the Company has provided services, to include
                  product sales and opportunity meetings or training
                  by an Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                  the Company, which are the same or substantially
                  similar to the services performed or provided by
                  Employee for the Company, or engage in the same or
                  substantially similar business as that engaged in
                  by the Company anywhere in the United States, all
                  United States territories and the provinces of
                  Alberta, Ontario and British Columbia, Canada;

                        (2) request, solicit, approach, or otherwise
                        interfere with or seek to interfere with the
                        relationship between the Company and (a) any
                        Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                        the Company during the one (1) year prior to
                        termination of the Employee's employment
                        with the Company; or (b) any suppliers or
                        vendors of the Company during the one (1)
                        year prior to termination of the Employee's
                        employment with the Company.  (ii) that
                        during the Employee's employment with the
                        Company, and for a period of one (1) year
                        from the date of termination of the
                        Employee's employment with the Company,
                        whether by Employee or Company, he or she
                        will not directly or indirectly hire,
                        contract with, induce or attempt to
                        influence any individual who, at any time
                        during the 180 days prior to the termination
                        of the Employee's employment with the
                        Company, was an employee, agent, or
                        Independent Retail Sales Representative of
                        the Company or any other company owned or
                        operated by the Company, to terminate his or
                        her employment or association with the
                        Company.

              (B) The parties hereto agree that, in the event that
              either the length of time or the geographic area set
              forth in Section 5(A) of this Agreement is found to be
              unreasonable by a court, the court may reduce such
              restrictions to those which it deems reasonable under
              the circumstances.

              (C) The Company's employment of the Employee shall
              constitute sufficient and valuable consideration for
              Employee's obligations under this Agreement.

             (D) The covenants of Sections 4 and 5 of this Agreement
              shall survive any termination of this Agreement and
              termination of Employee's employment with the
              Corporation.

         6.  Remedy.  Employee understands and agrees that the
         Company will suffer irreparable harm in the event that the
         Employee breaches any of his or her obligations under this
         Agreement and that monetary damages will be inadequate to
         compensate the Company for such breach.  Accordingly, the
         Employee agrees that, in the event of a breach or
         threatened breach by the Employee of any of the provisions
         of this Agreement, the Company, in addition to and not in
         limitation of any other rights, remedies or damages
         available to the Company at law or in equity, shall be
         entitled to an injunction in order to prevent or to
         restrain any such breach by the Employee, or by the
         Employee's partners, agents, representatives, servants,
         employers, employees and/or any and all persons directly or
         indirectly acting for or with him or her.  The Company
         shall not be required to post any bond to obtain any such
         injunction.

         7.  Indemnification. The Company shall indemnify Employee
         who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party
         to any pending or completed action, suit or proceeding,
         whether civil, administrative or investigative (other than
         an action by the Company), by reason of the fact that he or
         she is an Employee of the Company, or is or was serving at
         the request of the Company, against expenses (including
         attorneys' fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in
         settlement actually and reasonably incurred by him or her
         in connection with such suit, action or proceeding if he or
         she acted in good faith and in a manner he or she
         reasonably believed to be in or not opposed to the best
         interests of the Company.  Provided, however, that there
         shall be no indemnification for:  (i) misconduct in the
         performance of the Employee's duties to the Company; (ii)
         negligence in the performance of the Employee's duties to
         the Company; (iii) gross negligence or willful misconduct in
         the performance of Employee's duties to third parties; (iv)
         felony behavior, or (v) violations of criminal or civil
         statutes.

         8.  Severability.  The invalidity or unenforceability of
         any provision hereto shall in no way affect the validity or
         enforceability of any other provision.

         9.  Modification and Waiver.  This Agreement may be changed
         or modified only if consented to in writing by both
         parties.  No waiver of any provision of this Agreement
         shall be valid unless the same is in writing and signed by
         the party against whom such waiver is sought to be
         enforced; moreover, no valid waiver of any other provision
         of this agreement at any time shall be deemed a waiver of
         any other provision of this Agreement at such time, nor
         will it be deemed a valid waiver of such provision at any
         other time.

         10.  Governing Law. This Agreement shall be governed by and
         according to the laws of the State of North Carolina.

         11.  Benefit.  This Agreement shall be binding upon and
         shall inure to the benefit of each of the parties hereto,
         and to their respective heirs, representatives, successors,
         assigns and affiliates.

        12.  Entire Agreement.  This Agreement contains the entire
        agreement and understandings by and between the Employee and
        the Company with respect to the matters herein described and
        no representations, promises, agreement or understandings,
        written or oral, not herein contained shall be of any force
        or effect.
        
        13.  Captions.  The captions in this Agreement are for
        convenience only and in no way define, bind or describe the
        scope or intent of this Agreement.

        14.  Arbitration.  Any dispute arising out of or in
        connection with this Agreement or the breach thereof shall
        be decided by arbitration to be conducted in Raleigh, North
        Carolina in accordance with the then prevailing commercial
        arbitration rules of the American Arbitration Association,
        and judgment thereof may be entered in any court having
        jurisdiction thereof.  A demand for arbitration shall be
        made within a reasonable time after the claim, dispute or
        other matter in question has arisen and in no event shall
        the demand for arbitration be made after the date when
        institution of legal or equitable proceedings based on such
        claim, dispute or other matter in question would be barred
        by the applicable state of limitations.  IN WITNESS WHEREOF,
        the parties hereto have executed this Agreement and affixed
        their respective seals as of the day and year first above
        written.

        ATTEST:
         By:/s/John D. Brothers
               Secretary


CORPORATE SEAL
                                       INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE, INC.
                                           By: /s/ Stanley H. Van Etten
                                                   President and CEO

                                       EMPLOYEE
                                       /s/Stephanie Harris

Exhibit 10.8



                                BY-LAW NO. 1

A by-law relating generally to the conduct of the business and
affairs of INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE OF CANADA, INC.
(herein called the "Corporation").

BE IT ENACTED as a by-law of the Corporation as follows:
1. INTERPRETATION
            In this by-law and all other by-laws and resolutions of
            the Corporation, unless the context otherwise requires:

      1.01 "Act" means the Business Corporations Act, R.S.O. 1990,
            c.  B16, as amended from time to time, and any statute
            that may be substituted therefore, and includes the
            Regulations made pursuant thereto;

      1.02 "appointee includes "elect" and vice versa;

      1.03 "articles" means the original or restated articles of
            incorporation, articles of amalgamation, articles of
            continuance, articles of reorganization, letters
            patent, or other instrument of incorporation of the
            Corporation, as amended from time to time; 

      1.04 "board" means the board of directors of the
            Corporation;

      1.05 "by-laws" means all by-laws, including special
            by-laws, of the Corporation as amended from time to
            time;

      1.06 "Corporation" means this Corporation;

      1.07 "meeting of shareholders" includes an annual meeting
            of shareholders and a special meeting of shareholders;

      1.08 "non-business day" means Saturday, Sunday and any
            other day that is a holiday as defined in the
            Interpretation Act (Ontario);

      1.09 "recorded address" means, in the case of a
            shareholder, his address as recorded in the securities
            register, and in the case of joint shareholders, the
            address appearing in the securities register in
            respect of such joint holding or the first address so
            appearing if there are more than one; and in the case
            of a director, officer, auditor or member of a
            committee of the Board, his latest address as recorded
            in the records of the Corporation;

1.10 "person" includes an individual, sole proprietorship,
      partnership, unincorporated association,
      unincorporated syndicate, unincorporated organization,
      trust, body corporate, and a natural person in his
      capacity as trustee, executor, administrator, or other
      legal representative;

1.11 "signing officer" means, in relation to any
      instrument, any person authorized to sign the same on
      behalf of the Corporation under this by-law or by a
      resolution passed pursuant to this by-law; and

  1.12 "unanimous shareholders agreement" means a written agreement
	among all the shareholders of the Corporation, or among all such
	shareholders and a person who is not a shareholder, or a written
	declaration of the beneficial owner of all of the issued shares
	of the Corporation, that restricts, in whole or in part, the
	powers of the directors to manage the business and affairs of
        the Corporation, as from time to time amended,

        In this by-law, where the context requires, words importing the
        singular include the plural, and vice versa, and words importing
        gender include masculine, feminine and neuter genders, and vice
        versa.  All the words and terms appearing in this by-law shall
        have the same definitions and application as in the Act.

2. DIRECTORS

2.01 Powers
     Subject to any unanimous shareholders agreement, the business
              and affairs of the Corporation shall be managed or
              supervised by a board of directors being composed of:

              A variable board of not fewer than 1 and not more than
              5 directors.

              The number of directors may be varied by a special
              resolution of the shareholders, or if the directors are
              empowered by a special resolution to determine the number, by a
              resolution of the board within the minimum and maximum set in
              the articles.

2.02 Resident Canadians
     Except where the Corporation is a non-resident
              Corporation, a majority of the directors shall be resident
              Canadians, but where the Corporation has only one or two
              directors, one director shall be a resident Canadian.

2.03 Qualifications
             Any individual, whether a shareholder or not, may be
             a director of the Corporation, except a person who:

2.03.1 is less than eighteen years of age;

2.03.2 is of unsound mind and has been so found by
	   a court in Canada or elsewhere; or

2.03.3 has the status of a bankrupt.

2.04 Election and Term
	The election of directors shall take place at the
	first meeting of shareholders and at each succeeding annual
	meeting at which an election of directors is required. Incumbent
        directors, if qualified, shall be eligible for re-election. If
        an election of directors is not held at the proper time the
	directors shall continue in office until their successors are
	elected.

2.05 Resignation
	A director who is not named in the articles may resign
	from office upon giving a written resignation to the Corporation
	and such resignation becomes effective when received by the
	Corporation or at the time specified in the resignation,
	whichever is later.

	A director named in the articles shall not be
	permitted to resign his office unless at the time the
	resignation is to become effective a successor is elected or
	appointed.

2.06 Removal
	Subject to clause (f) of section 120 of the Act, the
	shareholders may, by ordinary resolution at an annual meeting
	remove any director or directors from office before the
	expiration of his term and may, by a majority of the votes cast
	at the meeting, elect any person in his place for the remainder
	of his term.

2.07 Vacation of Office
    A director ceases to hold office when he dies, is
    removed from office by the shareholders, or ceases to have the
    necessary qualifications, or earlier if he shall have submitted
    his resignation; in which last-mentioned event he shall cease to
    hold office at the later of (i) the time when such written
    resignation is sent or delivered to the Corporation and (ii) the
    time, if any, specified in such resignation as the effective
    time of such resignation.

2.08 Vacancies
      Subject to the exceptions in section 124 of the Act,
      where a vacancy occurs on the board, a quorum of the directors
      then in office may appoint a person to fill the vacancy for the
      remainder of the term, except in the case of a vacancy resulting
      from an increase in the number of directors or the maximum
      number of directors required to be elected at any meeting of
      shareholders, in which case a quorum of the board may appoint an
      additional director if such appointment would not result in a
      total number of directors greater than one and one third times
      the number of directors required to have been elected at the
      last annual meeting of the shareholders.

      If there is not a quorum of directors or if there has
      been a failure to elect the number of directors required by the
      articles or in the case of a variable board as required by
      special resolution, the directors then in office shall forthwith
      call a special meeting of shareholders to fill the vacancy and,
      if they fail to call a meeting or if there are no directors then
      in office, the meeting may be called by any shareholder.

      Where there is a vacancy in the board, the remaining
      directors may exercise all the powers of the board so long as a
      quorum remains in office. Where the corporation has only one
      director, that director may constitute a meeting.

3. MEETINGS OF DIRECTORS
3.01 Place of meetings
       Meetings of the board may be held at the registered
       office of the Corporation or at any other place within or
       outside of Ontario, but, except where the Corporation is a
       non-resident corporation, or the articles or the by-laws
       otherwise provide, in any financial year of the Corporation a
       majority of the meetings of the board shall be held at a place
       within Canada.
3.02 Meetings by Communications Facilities
     Where all the directors present at or participating in
     the meeting have consented thereto, any director may participate
     in a meeting of the board by means of conference telephone,
     electronic or other communication facilities as permit all
     persons participating in the meeting to communicate with each
     other simultaneously and instantaneously and a director
     participating in such a meeting by such means is deemed for the
     purposes of the Act and these by-laws to be present at the
     meeting. Any such consent shall be effective whether given
     before or after the meeting to which it relates and may be given
     with respect to all board or committee meetings.

     If a majority of the directors participating in such
     a meeting are in Canada, the meeting shall be deemed to have
     been held in Canada.

3.03 Calling of Meetings
     Meetings of the board shall be held from time to time
     at such place, at such time and on such day as the president or
     a vice-president who is a director or any two directors may
     determine, and the secretary shall call meetings when directed
     or authorized by the president or by a vice-president who is a
     director or by any two directors.

     Notice of every meeting so called shall be given to
     each director not less than 48 hours (excluding any part of a
     Sunday and of a holiday as defined by the Interpretation Act)
     before the time when the meeting is to be held, except that no
     notice of meeting shall be necessary if all the directors are
     present or if those absent have waived notice of or otherwise
     signified their consent to the holding of such meeting.

     A notice of a meeting of directors need not specify
     the purpose of or the business to be transacted at the meeting
     except where the Act requires such purpose or business to be
     specified.

3.04 Regular Meetings
     The board may appoint a day or days in any month or
     months for regular meetings at a place and hour to be named.

     A copy of any resolution of the board fixing the place
     and time of regular meetings of the board shall be sent to each
     director forthwith after being passed, but no other notice shall
     be required for any such regular meetings.

3.05 Attendance of Auditors
     The auditors of the Corporation, if any, shall be
     entitled to attend and be heard at meetings of the board, on
     matters relating to their duties as auditors.

3.06 First Meeting of New Board
     Each newly elected board may without notice hold its
     first meeting for the purpose of organization and the election
     and appointment of officers immediately following a meeting of
     shareholders at which such board is elected, provided that a
     quorum of directors is present.

3.07 Quorum
     Where the Corporation has only one director, that
     director may constitute a quorum for the transaction of business
     at any meeting of the board.

     Where the Corporation has two directors both directors
     of the Corporation must be present at any meeting of the board
     to constitute a quorum.

     Subject to the articles or by-laws of the Corporation,
     a majority of the number of directors or minimum number of
     directors required by the articles constitutes a quorum at any
     meeting of directors, but in no case shall a quorum be less than
     two-fifths of the number of directors or less than the minimum
     number of directors, as the case may be.

3.08 Resident Canadians
     Directors shall not transact business at a meeting of
     the board unless a majority of the directors present are
     resident Canadians.

     However, directors may transact business at a meeting of
     the board where not present if,

3.08.1 a resident Canadian director who is unable to be present approves in
     writing or by telephone or other communications facilities the business
     transacted at the meeting, and

3.08.2 a majority of resident Canadian directors would have been present had
    the director been present at the meeting.

3.09 Chairman
     The Chairman of any meeting of the board shall be the
     first mentioned of such of the following officers as have been
     appointed and is a director and is present at the meeting:

3.09.1 Chairman of the Board,

3.09.2 President, or

3.09.3 A Vice-President who is a director.

      If no such officer is present, the directors present
      shall choose one of their number to be Chairman.

3.10 Votes to Govern
     At all meetings of the board, every question shall be
     decided by a majority of the votes cast on the question.

3.11 Casting Vote
     In the case of an equality of votes on any question at
     a meeting of the board, the Chairman of the meeting shall not be
     entitled to a second or casting vote.

3.12 Disclosure of Interests in Contracts
     Every director or officer of the Corporation who is a
     party to a material contract or proposed material contract with
     the Corporation, or is a director or officer or has a material
     interest in any corporation which is party to a material
     contract or proposed material contract with the Corporation,
     shall disclose in writing to the Corporation or request to have
     entered in the minutes of the meeting of directors the nature
     and extent of his interest as required by section 132 of the Act.

3.13 Resolution in Lieu of Meeting
     A resolution in writing, signed by all the directors
     entitled to vote on that resolution at a meeting of directors or
     a committee of directors, is as valid as if it had been passed
     at a meeting of directors or committee of directors. A copy of
     every such resolution shall be kept with the minutes.

3.14 Delegation
     Directors may appoint from their number a managing
     director who is a resident Canadian or a committee of directors
     and delegate to such managing director or committee any of the
     powers of the directors.

     If the directors appoint a committee of directors, a
     majority of the members of the committee must be resident
     Canadians.

     Unless otherwise determined by the board, each
     committee shall have the power to fix its quorum at not less
     than a majority of its members, to elect its chairman and to
     regulate its procedure.

4. REMUNERATION AND INDEMNIFICATION

4.01 Remuneration
     Subject to the articles, the by-laws or any unanimous
     shareholders agreement, the board may fix the remuneration of
     the directors.

     Such remuneration shall be in addition to any salary
     or professional fees payable to a director who serves the
     Corporation in any other capacity.
                   
     In addition, directors shall be paid sums in respect
     of their out-of-pocket expenses incurred in attending board,
     committee or shareholders' meetings or otherwise in respect of
     the performance by them of their duties as the board may from
     time to time determine.
     
4.02 Limitation of Liability
      No director or officer shall be liable for the acts,
      receipts, neglects or defaults of any other director or officer
      or employee, or for joining in any receipt or other act for
      conformity, or for any loss, damage or expense happening to the
      Corporation through the insufficiency or deficiency of title to
      any property acquired for or on behalf of the Corporation, or
      for the insufficiency or deficiency of any security in or upon
      which any of the monies of the Corporation shall be invested, or
      for any loss or damage arising from the bankruptcy, insolvency
      or tortious acts of any person with whom any of the monies,
      securities or effects of the Corporation shall be deposited, or
      for any loss occasioned by any error of judgment or oversight on
      his part, or for any other loss, damage or misfortune whatever
      which shall happen in the execution of the duties of his office
      or in relation thereto, unless the same are occasioned by his
      own wilful neglect or default; provided that nothing herein
      shall relieve any director or officer from the duty to act in
      accordance with the Act or from liability for any breach
      thereof.

4.03 Indemnity of Directors and Officers
     Except as provided in section 136 of the Act, every
     director and officer of the Corporation, every former director
     or officer of the Corporation or a person who acts or acted at
     the Corporation's request as a director or officer of a body
     corporate of which the Corporation is or was a shareholder or
     creditor, and his heirs and legal representatives shall, from
     time to time, be indemnified and saved harmless by the
     Corporation from and against all costs, charges and expenses,
     including an amount paid to settle an action or satisfy a
     judgment, reasonably incurred by him in respect of any civil,
     criminal or administrative action or proceeding to which he is
     made a party by reason of being or having been a director or
     officer of such Corporation or body corporate if,

4.03.1 he acted honestly and in good faith with a
      view to the best interests of the Corporation; and

4.03.2 in the case of a criminal or administrative
      action or proceeding that is enforced by a
      monetary penalty, he had reasonable grounds
      for believing that his action was lawful.

4.04 Insurance
     Subject to the limitations contained in the Act, the
     Corporation may purchase and maintain such insurance for the
     benefit of its directors and officers as such, as the board may
     from time to time determine.

5. OFFICERS

5.01 Election or Appointment
     At the first meeting of the board after each election
     of directors, the board shall elect or appoint a president, and
     a secretary and, if deemed advisable, may appoint one or more
     vice-presidents, a general manager, a treasurer and such other
     officers as the board may determine including one or more
     assistants to any of the officers so appointed.

     None of the said officers need be a director or
     shareholder.

     Any two of the said offices may be held by the same
     person. If the same person holds the office of secretary and
     treasurer, he may, but need not, be known as the secretary-treasurer.

5.02 Term, Remuneration and Removal 
     The terms of employment and remuneration of all
     officers elected or appointed by the board (including the
     president) shall be determined from time to time by resolution
     of the board.

     The fact that an officer or employee is a director or
     shareholder of the Corporation shall not disqualify him from
     receiving such remuneration as may be determined.

     All officers, in the absence of agreement to the
     contrary, shall be subject to removal by resolution of the board
     at any time with or without cause, without prejudice to such
     officer's rights under any employment contract. Otherwise, each
     officer elected or appointed by the board shall hold office
     until his or her successor is elected or appointed.

5.03 President
     The President shall be the chief executive officer of the Corporation.

     He shall, if present, preside at all meetings of the
     shareholders and of the board of directors and shall be charged
     with the general supervision of the business and affairs of the
     Corporation except the power to do anything referred to in
     sub-section 127(3) of the Act.

     Except where the board has appointed a general manager
     or managing director, the president shall also have the powers
     and be charged with the duties of that office except the power
     to do anything referred to in sub-section 127(3) of the Act.

5.04 Vice-President
     The vice-president, or if there are more than one, the
     vice-presidents in order of seniority (as determined by the
     board), shall be vested with all the powers and shall perform
     all the duties of the president in the absence or disability or
     refusal to act of the president, except that he shall not
     preside at meetings of the directors or shareholders unless he
     is qualified to attend meetings of directors or shareholders as
     the case may be.

     If a vice-president exercises any such duty or power,
     the absence or inability of the president shall be presumed with
     reference thereto.

     A vice-president shall also perform such duties and
     exercise such powers as the president may from time to time
     delegate to him or the board may prescribe.

5.05 General Manager
    The general manager, if one is appointed, shall have
    the general management and direction, subject to the authority
    of the board and the supervision of the president, of the
    Corporation's business and affairs and the power to appoint and
    remove any and all officers, employees and agents of the
    Corporation not elected or appointed directly by the board and
    to settle the terms of their employment and remuneration but
    shall not have the power to do any of the things set forth in
    sub-section 127(3) of the Act.

    If and so long as the general manager is a director,
    he may but need not be known as the managing director.

5.06 Secretary
    The secretary shall attend all meetings of the
    directors, shareholders and committees of the board and shall
    enter or cause to be entered in books kept for that purpose
    minutes of all proceedings at such meetings; he shall give, or
    cause to be given, when instructed, notices required to be given
    to shareholders, directors, auditors and members of committees;
    he shall be the custodian of the stamp or mechanical device
    generally used for affixing the corporate seal of the
    Corporation and of all books, papers, records, documents and
    other duties as may from time to time be prescribed by the
    board.

5.07 Treasurer
    The treasurer shall keep, or cause to be kept, proper
    accounting records as required by the Act; he shall deposit, or
    cause to be deposited, all monies received by the Corporation in
    the Corporation's bank account; he shall, under direction of the
    board, supervise the safekeeping of securities and the
    disbursements of the funds of the Corporation;

5.07.1 he shall render to the board, whenever
    required, an account of all his transactions
    as treasurer and of the financial position
    of the Corporation; and

5.07.2 he shall perform such other duties as may
     from time to time be prescribed by the
     board.

5.08 Other Officers
     The duties of all other officers of the Corporation
     shall be such as the terms of their engagement call for or the
     board requires of them.

     Any of the powers and duties of an officer to whom an
     assistant has been appointed may be exercised and performed by
     such assistant, unless the board otherwise directs.

5.09 Variation of Duties
     From time to time the board may vary, add to or limit
     the powers and duties of any officer or officers, but shall not
     delegate to any officer any of the powers set forth in
     sub-section 127(3) of the Act.

5.10 Agents and Attorneys
     The board shall have power from time to time to
     appoint agents or attorneys for the Corporation in or out of
     Ontario with such powers of management or otherwise (including
     the power to sub-delegate) as may be thought fit.

5.11 Fidelity Bonds
     The board may require such officers, employees and
     agents of the Corporation as it deems advisable to furnish bonds
     for the faithful performance of their duties, in such form and
     with such surety as the board may from time to time prescribe.

6. MEETINGS OF SHAREHOLDERS

6.01 Annual Meetings
     The directors shall call the first annual meeting of
     shareholders not later than eighteen months after the
     Corporation comes into existence and subsequently not later than
     fifteen months after holding the last preceding annual meeting.

     The annual meeting of shareholders of the Corporation
     shall be held at such time and on such day each year as the
     board may from time to time determine, for the purpose of
     receiving the reports and statements required by the Act to be
     laid before the annual meeting, electing directors, appointing
     auditors and fixing or authorizing the board to fix their
     remuneration, and for the transaction of such other business as
     may properly be brought before the meeting.

6.02 Special Meetings
     The board may at any time call a special meeting of
     shareholders for the transaction of any business which may
     properly be brought before such meeting of shareholders.

     All business transacted at an annual meeting of
     shareholders, except consideration of financial statements,
     auditor's report, election of directors and reappointment of the
     incumbent auditor, is deemed to be special business.

6.03 Place of Meeting
     Meetings of shareholders shall be held at the
     registered office of the Corporation, or at such other place
     within or outside Ontario as the board from time to time
     determines.

6.04 Notice of Meeting
     Notice of the time and place of each meeting of
     shareholders shall be sent not less than 10 days and not more
     than 50 days before the date of the meeting to the auditor of
     the Corporation (if any), to each director, and to each person
     whose name appears on the records of the Corporation at the
     close of business on the day next preceding the giving of the
     notice as a shareholder entitled to vote at the meeting.

6.05 Notice of a special meeting of shareholders shall
     state:
6.05.1 the nature of the business to be transacted
     at the meeting in sufficient detail to
     permit the shareholder to form a reasonable
     judgment thereon; and
6.05.2 the text of any special resolution or by-law
     to be submitted to the meeting.

6.06 Persons Entitled to be Present
     The only persons entitled to attend a meeting of
     shareholders shall be those entitled to vote thereat, the
     directors and the auditors of the Corporation, and others who,
     although not entitled to vote, are entitled or required to be
     present at the meeting.

     Any other persons may be admitted only on the
     invitation of the chairman of the meeting or with the consent of
     the meeting.

6.07 Record Date for Notice
     The board may fix in advance a time and date,
     preceding the date of any meeting of shareholders by not more
     than 50 days and not fewer than 10 days, as the record date for
     the determination of the shareholders entitled to notice of the
     meeting. If no such record date for notice is fixed by the
     board, the record date for notice shall be at the close of
     business on the day next preceding the day on which notice is
     given.

6.08 Meetings Without Notice
     A meeting of shareholders may be held at any time and
     at any place permitted by the Act or the articles or the by-laws
     without notice or on shorter notice than that provided for
     herein, and proceedings thereat shall not thereby be
     invalidated:

6.08.1 if all the shareholders entitled to vote
     thereat are present in person or represented
     by proxy or if those not so present or
     represented by proxy have received notice
     or, before or after the meeting or the time
     prescribed for notice thereof, in writing
     waive notice of or accept short notice of
     such meeting, and
6.08.2 if the auditors, if any, and the directors
     are present or if those not present have
     received notice or, before or after the time
     prescribed for notice thereof, in writing
     waive notice of or accept notice of such
     meeting.

6.09 Quorum
     The holders of a majority of the shares entitled to
     vote at a meeting of shareholders present in person or by proxy
     constitutes a quorum for the transaction of business at any
     meeting of shareholders.

6.10 One Shareholder Meeting
     If the Corporation has only one shareholder, or only
     one shareholder of any class or series of shares, the
     shareholder present in person or by proxy constitutes a meeting.

6.11 Right to Vote
     At any meeting of shareholders, unless the articles
     otherwise provide, each share of the Corporation entitles the
     holder thereof to one vote at a meeting of shareholders.

6.12 Joint Shareholders
     Where two or more persons hold the same share or
     shares jointly, any one of such persons present at a meeting of
     shareholders may in the absence of the others vote the shares
     but, if two or more of such persons who are present in person or
     by proxy, vote, they shall vote as one on the shares jointly
     held by them.

6.13 Record Date for Voting
     The board may fix in advance a time and date,
     preceding the date of any meeting of shareholders by not more
     than 2 days, excluding non-business days, as the record date for
     the determination of the shareholders entitled to vote at the
     meeting. Such date shall be specified in the notice calling the
     meeting. Where no record date is so fixed, the record date for
     voting shall be the time of the taking of the vote.

6.14 Proxies
     Every shareholder entitled to vote at a meeting of
     shareholders may by means of a proxy appoint a proxy holder or
     one or more alternate proxy holders, who are not required to be
     shareholders, to attend and act at the meeting in the manner and
     to the extent authorized by the proxy and with the authority
     conferred by the proxy.

     A proxy shall be in writing and executed by the
     shareholder or by his attorney authorized in writing.

     Subject to the requirements of the Act, the instrument
     may be in such form as the directors from time to time prescribe
     or in such other form as the chairman of the meeting may accept
     as sufficient.

     It shall be deposited with the Corporation before any
     vote is taken under its authority, or at such earlier time not
     exceeding 48 hours, excluding non-business days, and in such
     manner as the board by resolution prescribes. An instrument
     appointing a proxy shall be acted upon only if, prior to the
     time so fixed and specified in the notice calling the meeting,
     it shall have been so deposited.

6.15 Scrutineers
     At each meeting of shareholders, one or more
     scrutineers may be appointed by a resolution of the meeting or
     by the chairman with the consent of the meeting to serve at the
     meeting.

     Such scrutineers need not be shareholders of the Corporation.

6.16 Votes to Govern
     Unless otherwise required by the Act, or the articles
     or by-laws of the Corporation, all questions proposed for the
     consideration of the shareholders at a meeting shall be decided
     by a majority of the votes cast thereon.

6.17 Show of Hands
     At all meetings of shareholders, every question shall
     be decided by a show of hands unless a ballot thereon be
     required by the chairman or be demanded by a shareholder or
     proxyholder present and entitled to vote.

     Upon a show of hands, every person present and
     entitled to vote has one vote regardless of the number of shares
     he represents.

     After a show of hands has been taken upon any
     question, the chairman may require or any shareholder or
     proxyholder present and entitled to vote may demand a ballot
     thereon.

     Whenever a vote by show of hands shall have been taken
     upon a question, unless a ballot therein be so required or
     demanded, a declaration by the chairman that the vote upon the
     question has been carried or carried by a particular majority or
     not carried, and an entry to that effect in the minutes of the
     meeting, shall be prima facie evidence of the fact without proof
     of the number or proportion of the votes recorded in favour of
     or against the question.

     The result of the vote so taken and declared shall be
     the decision of the Corporation on the question.

     A demand for a ballot may be withdrawn at any time
     prior to the taking of the ballot.

6.18 Ballots
     If a ballot is required by the chairman of the meeting
     or is demanded and the demand is not withdrawn, a ballot upon
     the question shall be taken in such a manner as the chairman of
     the meeting directs.

6.19 Personal Representative
     If the shareholder of record is deceased, his personal
     representative, upon filing with the secretary of the meeting
     sufficient proof of his appointment, shall be entitled to
     exercise the same voting rights at any meeting of shareholders
     as the shareholder of record would have been entitled to
     exercise if he were living and for the purposes of the meeting
     shall be considered a shareholder. If there is more than one
     personal representative, the provisions regarding joint
     shareholders shall apply.

6.20 Adjournment
     The chairman of a meeting of shareholders may, with
     the consent of the meeting and subject to such conditions as the
     meeting may decide, adjourn the meeting from time to time and
     from place to place.

7. SHARES

7.01 Allotment
     Subject to any unanimous shareholders agreement, the
     board may from time to time issue or grant options to purchase
     the whole or any part of the authorized and unissued shares of
     the Corporation at such time and to such persons and for such
     consideration as the board shall determine, provided that no
     share shall be issued until it is fully paid as prescribed by
     the Act.

7.02 Commissions and Discounts
     The board may, at any time after the approval of this
     by-law by the shareholders, and from time to time thereafter,
     authorize the payment of commissions or the allowance of
     discounts to persons in consideration of their subscribing or
     agreeing to subscribe, whether absolutely or conditionally, for
     such shares, but no commission or discount shall exceed 25 per
     cent of the amount of the subscription price.

7.03 Lien for Indebtedness
     Subject to the Act, the Corporation has a lien on
     shares registered in the name of a shareholder or his legal
     representative for any debt of the shareholder to the Corporation.

     The Corporation may enforce the lien by:

7.03.1 in the case of redeemable shares, redeeming
     the shares at their redemption price; and
7.03.2 in the case of all other shares, by
     purchasing such shares at their book value
     for cancellation or for re-sale;

     and by applying the value of such shares so determined to the
     debt of the shareholder.
     
     In enforcing the lien as aforesaid, the Corporation
     shall not be obliged to redeem or purchase all of the shares of
     that class, but only the shares subject to the lien.

     In electing to enforce the lien in this manner, the
     Corporation shall not prejudice or surrender any other rights of
     enforcement of the lien which may in law be available to it or
     any other remedy available to the Corporation for collection of
     the debt or any part thereof.

7.04 Share Certificates
     Every holder of one or more shares of the Corporation
     is entitled, at his option, to a share certificate, or to a
     non-transferable written acknowledgment of his right to obtain
     a share certificate, stating the number and class or a series of
     shares held by him as shown on the records of the Corporation.

     Share certificates and acknowledgments of a
     shareholder's rights to a share certificate shall be in such
     form as the board shall from time to time approve.

     The share certificate shall be signed manually by at
     least one director or officer of the Corporation or by or on
     behalf of the registrar or transfer agent and any additional
     signatures required on the share certificate may be printed or
     otherwise mechanically reproduced thereon and such share
     certificates need not be under the corporate seal; provided,
     that unless the board otherwise orders, certificates
     representing shares in respect of which a registrar or transfer
     agent (which terms shall include a branch registrar and/or
     transfer agent) has been appointed shall not be valid if issued
     during such appointment unless countersigned by or on behalf of
     such registrar and/or transfer agent. The corporate seal of the
     Corporation and the signature of one of the signing officers or,
     in the case of share certificates which are not valid unless
     countersigned by or on behalf of a registrar and/or transfer
     agent, the signatures of both officers may be printed, engraved,
     lithographed or otherwise mechanically reproduced upon share
     certificates and every such share signature shall for all
     purposes be deemed to be the signature of the officer whose
     signature it reproduces and shall be binding upon the
     Corporation. A share certificate executed as aforesaid shall be
     valid notwithstanding that one or both of the officers whose
     signature (whether manual or facsimile) appears thereon no
     longer holds office at the date of issue or delivery of the
     certificate.

7.05 Replacement of Share Certificates
     The board or any officer or agent assigned by the
     board may in its or his discretion direct the issue of a new
     share certificate in lieu of and upon cancellation of a share
     certificate that has been mutilated or in substitution for a
     share certificate that has been lost, apparently destroyed or
     wrongfully taken on payment of such fee, not exceeding $3.00,
     and on such terms as to indemnity, reimbursement of expenses and
     evidence of loss and of title as the board may from time to time
     prescribe, whether generally or in any particular case.

7.06 Transfer Agent and Registrar
     The board may from time to time appoint a registrar to
     maintain the securities register and a transfer agent to
     maintain the register of transfers and may also appoint one or
     more branch registrars to maintain branch security registers and
     one or more branch transfer agents to maintain branch registers
     of transfers, but one person may be appointed both registrar and
     transfer agent.

     The board may at appointment any time terminate any such appointment.

7.07 Registrars and Transfer Agents
     Subject to the provisions of the Act, no transfer of
     shares shall be registered in a register of transfers or branch
     register of transfers except on the surrender of the certificate
     representing such shares with a transfer endorsed thereon or
     delivered therewith duly executed by the registered holder or by
     his attorney or successor duly appointed, together with such
     assurance or evidence of signature, identification and authority
     to transfer as the board may from time to time prescribe, and
     upon payment of all applicable taxes, compliance with such
     restrictions on transfer as are authorized by the articles and
     satisfaction of any lien referred to herein.
     
7.08 Non-recognition of Trusts
     The Corporation shall be entitled to treat the
     registered holder of any share as the absolute owner thereof and
     accordingly shall not, except as ordered by a court of competent
     jurisdiction or as required by statute, be bound to see to the
     execution of any trust, whether express, implied or
     constructive, in respect of any share or to recognize any claim
     to or interest in such share on the part of any person, other
     than the registered holder thereof.

7.09 Joint Shareholders
     If two or more persons are registered as joint holders
     of any share, the Corporation shall not be bound to issue more
     than one certificate in respect thereof, and delivery of such
     certificate to one of such persons shall be sufficient delivery
     to all of them.

     Any one of such persons may give effectual receipt for
     the certificate issued in respect thereof or for any dividends,
     bonus, return of capital or other money payable or warrant
     issuable in respect of such share.
     
7.10 Deceased Shareholders
     In the event of the death of a holder, or one of the
     joint holders, of any share, the Corporation shall not be
     required to make any entry in the register of shareholders in
     respect thereof or to make payment of any dividends thereon
     except upon production of all such documents as may be required
     by law and upon compliance with the reasonable requirements of
     the Corporation and its transfer agent.

8. DIVIDENDS

8.01 Declaration
     Subject to the Act and the articles, the board may
     declare and the Corporation may pay a dividend to the
     shareholders according to their respective rights in the
     Corporation.

     Such a dividend may be paid by issuing fully paid
     shares of the Corporation or may be paid in money or property.

8.02 Payment
     A dividend payable in cash shall be paid by cheque
     drawn on the Corporation's bankers or one of them to the order
     of each registered holder of shares of the class in respect of
     which it has been declared, and mailed by ordinary mail postage
     prepaid to such registered holder at his last address appearing
     on the records of the Corporation. In the case of joint holders,
     the cheque shall, unless such joint holders otherwise direct, be
     made payable to the order of all of such joint holders and, if
     more than one address appears on the books of the Corporation in
     respect of such joint holding, the cheque shall be mailed to the
     first address so appearing. The mailing of such cheque as
     aforesaid shall satisfy and discharge all liability for the
     dividend to the extent of the sum represented thereby, unless
     such cheque be not paid on presentation.

8.03 Non-Receipt of Cheque
     In the event of the non-receipt of any cheque for a
     dividend by the person to whom it is so sent as aforesaid, the
     Corporation, on proof of such non-receipt and upon satisfactory
     indemnity being given to it, shall issue to such person a
     replacement cheque for a like amount.

8.04 Record Date for Dividends and Rights
     The board may fix in advance a date as a record date
     for the determination of the persons entitled to receive payment
     of any dividend or to receive any warrant or other evidence of
     right to subscribe for securities of the Corporation. In every
     such case, only such persons as shall be shareholders of record
     at the close of business on the record date so fixed shall be
     entitled to receive payment of such dividend or to receive such
     warrant or other evidence of such right notwithstanding the
     transfer or issue of any shares after the record date so fixed.

8.05 Purchase of Business as of Past Date
     Where any business is purchased by the Corporation as
     from a past date (whether such date be before or after the
     incorporation of the Corporation) upon terms that the
     Corporation shall as from that date take profits or losses as
     the case may be shall, at the discretion of the directors be
     credited or debited wholly or in part to revenue account, and in
     that case the amount so credited or debited shall, for the
     purpose of ascertaining the fund available for dividends, be
     treated as a profit or loss arising from the business of the
     Corporation.

8.06 Unclaimed Dividends
     Any dividend unclaimed after a period of six years
     from the date on which the same has been declared to be payable
     shall be forfeited and shall revert to the Corporation.

     The foregoing By-law No. l of the Corporation, being a by-law
     relating generally to the regulation of the business and affairs
     of the Corporation, is hereby passed by the sole director of the
     Corporation as evidenced by his signature hereto.

     DATED  26th day of July, 1995.

     /s/ Robert Stikeman

     The foregoing By-law No. 1 of the Corporation, being a by-law
     relating generally to the regulation of the business and affairs
     of the Corporation, is hereby confirmed by the sole shareholder
     of the Corporation entitled to vote at a meeting of
     shareholders, as evidenced by its signature hereto.

     DATED the 26th day of July, 1995.

     International Heritage, Inc.

     PER /s/ Stanley Van Etten
     President & CEO
     
     
                            BY-LAW NO. 2

     A By-law respecting the borrowing of money and the issuing of securities
     by:
                   INTERNATIONAL HERITAGE OF CANADA, INC.

     1.  Without limiting the borrowing powers of the Corporation as
     set forth in the Business Corporations Act, R.S.O. 1990, c.
     B16, the directors of the Corporation may, from time to
     time, without the authorization of the shareholders:
                    
     1.01 borrow money upon the credit of the Corporation;
                    
     1.02 issue, re-issue, sell or pledge obligations of the
     Corporation, including without limitation, bonds,
     debentures, notes or other similar obligations of the
     Corporation whether secured or unsecured;
                    
     1.03 give a guarantee on behalf of the Corporation to
     secure performance of any present or future
     indebtedness, liability or obligation of any person;
     and
                    
     1.04 charge, mortgage, hypothecate, pledge or otherwise
     create a security interest in all or any currently
     owned or subsequently acquired real or personal,
     movable or immovable, tangible or intangible property
     of the Corporation, including, without limitation,
     book debts, rights, powers, franchises and
     undertakings, to secure any present or future
     indebtedness, liabilities or other obligations of the
     Corporation.
     
     2. Nothing in this by-law limits or restricts the borrowing of
     money by the Corporation on bills of exchange or promissory
     notes made, drawn, accepted or endorsed by or on behalf of
     the Corporation.

     3. The directors may, from time to time, by resolution
     delegate any or all of the powers referred to in this
     by-law to a director, a committee of directors or one or
     more officers of the Corporation.

     The foregoing By-law No. 2 of the Corporation, being a by-law
     relating generally to the regulation of the business and affairs
     of the Corporation, is hereby passed by the sole director of the
     Corporation as evidenced by his signature hereto.

	     DATED the 26th day of July, 1995

             /s/ Robert Stikeman
                                             
     The foregoing By-law No. 2 of the Corporation, being a by-law
     relating generally to the regulation of the business and affairs
     of the Corporation, is hereby confirmed by the sole shareholder
     of the Corporation entitled to vote at a meeting of
     shareholders, as evidenced by its signature hereto.

              DATED the 26th day of July, 1995.

              International Heritage, Inc.

              Per: /s/ Stanley Van Etten

Exhibit 21.2





			CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS'

	We consent to the inclusion in this registration statement on
        Form S-1 (File No. 333-5268) of our independent auditors'
        reports dated August 24, 1996, on our audits of the consolidated
	financial statements and consolidated balance sheet and pro
        forma information of International Heritage, Inc. and Subsidary.
	We also consent to the reference to our Firm under the heading
        "Experts".  
	
        /s/ Eilers, Jones, Brown, & McLeod, CPA, PA

	August 5, 1996

Exhibit 23.1




© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission